Sony Camcorder PDW 530 User Manual

PROFESSIONAL DISC CAMCORDER  
PDW-510/510P  
PDW-530/530P  
OPERATION MANUAL [English]  
1st Edition (Revised 1)  
radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in  
accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful  
interference to radio communications.  
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur  
in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause  
harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can  
be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is  
encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of  
the following measures;  
For the customers in the USA and Canada  
• RECYCLING LITHIUM-ION BATTERIES  
Lithium-Ion batteries are recyclable.  
You can help preserve our environment  
by returning your used rechargeable  
batteries to the collection and recycling  
location nearest you.  
For more information regarding recycling of rechargeable  
batteries, call toll free 1-800-822-8837, or visit  
http://www.rbrc.org/  
– Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
– Increase the separation between the equipment and  
receiver.  
– Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different  
from that to which the receiver is connected.  
– Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for  
help.  
Caution: Do not handle damaged or leaking lithium-ion  
batteries.  
• RECYCLING NICKEL METAL HYDRIDE BATTERIES  
You are cautioned that any changes or modifications not  
expressly approved in this manual could void your authority to  
operate this equipment.  
Nickel metal hydride batteries are  
recyclable.  
You can help preserve our environment  
by returning your used rechargeable  
batteries to the collection and recycling  
location nearest you.  
The shielded interface cable recommended in this manual  
must be used with this equipment in order to comply with the  
limits for a digital device pursuant to Subpart B of Part 15 of  
FCC Rules.  
For more information regarding recycling of rechargeable  
batteries, call toll free1-800-822-8837, or visit  
http://www.rbrc.org/  
For the customers in the USA  
This product contains mercury. Disposal of this product may  
be regulated if sold in the USA. For disposal or recycling  
information, please contact your local authorities or the  
Electronics Industries Alliance (www.eiae.org http://  
www.eiae.org ).  
Caution: Do not handle damaged or leaking lithium-ion  
batteries.  
For the customers in Europe  
This product with the CE marking complies with the EMC  
Directive (89/336/EEC) issued by the Commission of the  
European Community.  
Compliance with these directives implies conformity to the  
following European standards:  
• EN55103-1: Electromagnetic Interference (Emission)  
• EN55103-2: Electromagnetic Susceptibility (Immunity)  
This product is intended for use in the following  
Electromagnetic Environment(s):  
E1 (residential), E2 (commercial and light industrial), E3  
(urban outdoors) and E4 (controlled EMC environment, ex. TV  
studio).  
For the customers in Taiwan only  
3
ATTENTION  
AVERTISSEMENT  
Comme le rayon laser utilisé dans ce Camescope de disques  
pour professionnels est dangereux pour les yeux, ne pas  
essayer de démonter le coffret. Faire effectuer l’entretien  
uniquement par un personnel qualifié.  
Afin d’éviter tout risque d’incendie ou  
d’électrocution, ne pas exposer cet  
appareil à la pluie ou à l’humidité.  
ATTENTION  
L’emploi d’instruments optiques avec ce produit augmentera  
les risques pour les yeux.  
Afin d’écarter tout risque d’électrocution,  
garder le coffret fermé. Ne confier  
l’entretien de l’appareil qu’à un personnel  
qualifié.  
ATTENTION  
L’emploi de commandes ou ajustements ou l’exécution de  
procédures autres que celles spécifiées ici peut provoquer  
une exposition dangereuse au rayonnement.  
Pour les utilisateurs aux Etats-Unis et au Canada.  
• RECYCLAGE DES ACCUMULATEURS AUX IONS DE  
LITHIUM  
Les accumulateurs aux ions de lithium  
sont recyclables.  
Vous pouvez contribuer à préserver  
l’environnement en rapportant les piles  
usées dans un point de collection et  
recyclage le plus proche.  
Cet camescope de disques pour professionnels est classé  
PRODUIT LASER DE CLASSE 1.  
Propriétés de la diode laser  
Longueur d’onde: 403 à 410 nm  
Durée d’émission: Continue  
Puissance de sortie laser: 65 mW (maxi de crête  
d’impulsion), 35 mW (maxi d’ondes entretenues)  
Pour plus d’informations sur le recyclage des  
accumulateurs, téléphonez au numéro gratuit  
1-800-822-8837 (Etats-Unis et Canada uniquement), ou  
visitez http://www.rbrc.org/  
Avertissment: Ne pas utiliser des accumulateurs aux ions  
de lithium qui sont endommagés ou qui fuient.  
Cette étiquette est placée à  
l’intérieur du panneau  
extérieur de l’appareil.  
• RECYCLAGE DES ACCUMULATEURS À HYDRURE  
MÉTALLIQUE DE NICKEL  
Les accumulateurs à hydrure métallique  
de nickel sont recyclables.  
Vous pouvez contribuer à préserver  
l’environnement en rapportant les piles  
usées dans un point de collection et  
recyclage le plus proche.  
Pour plus d’informations sur le recyclage des  
accumulateurs, téléphonez au numéro gratuit  
1-800-822-8837 (Etats-Unis et Canada uniquement), ou  
visitez http://www.rbrc.org/  
Avertissment: Ne pas utiliser des accumulateurs aux ions  
de lithium qui sont endommagés ou qui fuient.  
Pour les clients européens  
Ce produit portant la marque CE est conforme à la Directive  
sur la compatibilité électromagnétique (EMC) (89/336/CEE)  
émise par la Commission de la Communauté européenne.  
La conformité à cette directive implique la conformité aux  
normes européennes suivantes :  
EN55103-1 : Interférences électromagnétiques (émission)  
EN55103-2 : Sensibilité électromagnétique (immunité)  
Ce produit est prévu pour être utilisé dans les environnements  
électromagnétiques suivants :  
E1 (résidentiel), E2 (commercial et industrie légère),  
E3 (urbain extérieur) et E4 (environnement EMC contrôlé, ex.  
studio de télévision).  
4
VORSICHT  
WARNUNG  
Die Laserstrahlung im Innern ist augenschädlich. Deshalb den  
Professional Disc Camcorder nicht öffnen/zerlegen.  
Wartungsarbeiten ausschließlich qualifiziertem Fachpersonal  
überlassen.  
Um Feuergefahr und die Gefahr eines  
elektrischen Schlages zu vermeiden, darf  
das Gerät weder Regen noch Feuchtigkeit  
ausgesetzt werden.  
VORSICHT  
Der Einsatz von optischen Hilfen verstärkt die Gefahr von  
Augenschäden.  
Um einen elektrischen Schlag zu  
vermeiden, darf das Gehäuse nicht  
geöffnet werden. Überlassen Sie  
Wartungsarbeiten stets nur qualifiziertem  
Fachpersonal.  
VORSICHT  
Bei Betätigung von Bedien- und Einstellteilen oder  
Ausführung von Bedienvorgängen, die nicht ausdrücklich in  
dieser Bedienungsanleitung aufgeführt sind, droht u.U. die  
Einwirkung gefährlicher Laserstrahlung.  
GEFAHR  
Bei geöffnetem Laufwerk und beschädigter oder deaktivierter  
Verriegelung tritt ein unsichtbarer Laserstrahl aus.  
Direkter Kontark mit dem Laserstrahl ist unbedingt zu  
vermeiden.  
Für Kunden in Europa  
Dieses Produkt besitzt die CE-Kennzeichnung und erfüllt die  
EMV-Richtlinie (89/336/EWG) der EG-Kommission.  
Angewandte Normen:  
• EN55103-1: Elektromagnetische Verträglichkeit  
(Störaussendung)  
• EN55103-2: Elektromagnetische Verträglichkeit  
(Störfestigkeit),  
für die folgenden elektromagnetischen Umgebungen:  
E1 (Wohnbereich), E2 (kommerzieller und in beschränktem  
Maße industrieller Bereich), E3 (Stadtbereich im Freien) und  
E4 (kontrollierter EMV-Bereich, z.B. Fernsehstudio).  
Dieses Gerät ist als CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT eingestuft.  
Eigenschaften der Laserdiode  
Wellenlänge: 403 bis 410 nm  
Emissionsdauer. Ununterbrochen  
Laser-Ausgangsleistung: 65 mW (max. Impulsspitze), 35  
mW (max. Dauerstrich)  
Dieser Aufkleber befindet  
sich hinter der  
Außenabdeckung des  
Geräts.  
5
CAUTELA  
ATTENZIONE  
Poiché il raggio laser impiegato in questo camcorder di dischi  
professionale è dannoso alla vista, non tentare di smontare il  
rivestimento. Per la manutenzione rivolgersi esclusivamente a  
personale qualificato.  
Per evitare il pericolo di incendi o scosse  
elettriche, non esporre l’apparecchio alla  
pioggia o all’umidità.  
CAUTELA  
L’uso di strumenti ottici con questo prodotto aumenta il rischio  
per la vista.  
Per evitare scosse elettriche, non aprire  
l’apparecchio.  
Per le riparazioni, rivolgersi solo a  
personale qualificato.  
CAUTELA  
L’uso di comandi o regolazioni o l’esecuzione di procedimenti  
diversi da quelli specificati in questo manuale possono  
causare esposizione a radiazioni pericolose.  
Per i clienti in Europa  
Questo prodotto recante il marchio CE è conforme sia alla  
direttiva sulla compatibilità elettromagnetica (EMC) (89/336/  
CEE) emesse dalla Commissione della Comunità Europea.  
La conformità a queste direttive implica la conformità alle  
seguenti normative europee:  
EN55103-1: Interferenza elettromagnetica (Emissione)  
EN55103-2: Sensibilità ai disturbi elettromagnetici (Immunità)  
Questo prodotto è destinato all’uso nei seguenti ambienti  
elettromagnetici:  
Questo camcorder di dischi professionale è classificato come  
PRODOTTO LASER CLASSE 1.  
E1 (residenziali), E2 (commerciali e industriali leggeri), E3  
(esterni urbani) e E4 (ambienti EMC controllati, ad esempio  
studi televisivi).  
Proprietà del laser a diodo  
Lunghezza d’onda: da 403 a 410 nm  
Durata emissione: Continua  
Potenza d’emissione del laser: 65 mW (mass. a picco di  
impulso), 35 mW (mass. di CW)  
Questa etichetta si trova  
all’interno del pannello  
esterno dell’unità.  
6
CAUTION  
ADVERTENCIA  
Como el rayo láser utilizado en este grabador de discos  
profesional es peligroso para los ojos, no trate de desarmar la  
caja. Solicite el servicio sólo al personal cualificado.  
Para evitar el riesgo de incendios o  
electrocución, no exponga la unidad a la  
lluvia ni a la humedad.  
CAUTION  
El uso de instrumentos ópticos con este producto aumentará  
el peligro a los ojos.  
Para evitar descargas eléctricas, no abra el  
aparato. Solicite asistencia técnica  
únicamente a personal especializado.  
CAUTION  
La utilización de controles o ajustes, o la realización de  
procedimientos no especificados aquí pueden resultar en la  
exposición a radiación peligrosa.  
Para los clientes de Europa  
Este producto cumple con las directivas de compatibilidad  
electromagnética (89/336/CEE) de la Comisión Europea.  
El cumplimiento de estas directivas implica la conformidad  
con los siguientes estándares europeos:  
• EN55103-1: Interferencia electromagnética (Emisión)  
• EN55103-2: Susceptibilidad electromagnética (Inmunidad)  
Este producto está ha sido diseñado para utilizarse en los  
entornos electromagnéticos siguientes:  
E1 (zona residencial), E2 (zona comercial e industrial ligera),  
E3 (exteriores urbanos), y E4 (entorno con EMC controlada,  
p. ej., estudio de televisión).  
Este grabador de discos profesional está clasificado como  
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT.  
Propiedades del diodo láser  
Longitud de onda: 403 a 410 nm  
Duración de la emisión: Continua  
Potencia de salida láser: 65 mW (máx. de pico de pulso),  
35 mW (máx. de onda continua)  
Esta etiqueta se encuentra  
en el interior del panel  
exterior de la unidad.  
7
8
Table of Contents  
Does Not End Normally (Salvage  
3-2-4 Starting a Shoot with a Few Seconds of  
Function)..........................................50  
3-2-5 Time-Lapse Video (Interval Rec  
3-2-7 Auto Clip List Recoding for Automatic  
58  
1-1-1 Principal Differences Between the  
1-1-3 Features of the Optical Disc Drive  
3-3-2 Checking the Last Two Seconds of the  
3-3-3 Checking the Recording on the Color  
3-4 Recording Video Signals from External  
3-4-1 Recording a DV Stream From External  
3-4-2 Recording Analog Composite Signals  
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback  
2-9 Warnings and Indications on the LCDs  
4-3-3 Loading a Clip List From Disc Into the  
3-1-1 Discs Used for Recording and Playback  
Table of Contents  
9
4-4 Using the PDZ-1 Proxy Browsing  
7-2-1 Layout of the Status Display on the  
7-2-3 Display Modes and Setting Change  
Messages........................................115  
7-2-6 Recording Shot Data Superimposed on  
7-2-8 Displaying the Status Confirmation  
7-2-9 Confirming the Image of the Return  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
5-1 Setting the Recording Format (PDW-  
5-3-2 Selecting the Shutter Mode and Shutter  
Speed................................................81  
5-4 Changing the Reference Value for  
5-5-1 Manually Adjusting the Audio Levels of  
7-3-1 Setting Gain Values for the GAIN  
7-3-3 Setting the Color Temperature Manually  
CH1/CH2 Connectors......................86  
5-5-2 Manually Adjusting the Audio Level of  
5-5-3 Recording Audio on Channels 3 and 4  
7-3-4 Specifying an Offset for the Auto White  
7-3-5 Assigning Functions to ASSIGN 1/2/3/4  
7-3-6 Setting the Date/Time of the Internal  
7-4 Resetting USER Menu Settings to the  
5-6-2 Saving the Actual Time in the Time  
8-1 Saving and Loading User Files to and  
10  
Table of Contents  
8-1-2 Saving User Menu Data to the “Memory  
8-1-3 Loading saved data from a “Memory  
10-1 Testing the Camcorder Before  
8-2-3 Resetting the Settings of the Camcorder  
Reference File................................144  
8-3 Jumping to a File-Related Menu Page  
9-1-2 Avoiding Breaks in Operation Due to an  
exhausted Battery...........................148  
9-1-4 Using the Anton Bauer Ultralight  
System............................................148  
9-2-2 Adjusting the Viewfinder Focus and  
9-2-5 Using the BKW-401 Viewfinder  
9-5-3 Attaching a UHF Portable Tuner (for a  
9-5-4 Connecting Line Input Audio  
9-8 Adjusting the Shoulder Pad Position..  
9-9 Putting on the Rain Cover (Not  
9-10 Connecting the Remote Control Unit  
Table of Contents  
11  
Overview  
1
Chapter  
1-1-1 Principal Differences Between  
the PDW-510/510P and PDW-  
530/530P  
1-1 Features  
1)  
The PDW-510/510P/530/530P is a camcorder for ENG  
2)  
2
There are the following differences between the PDW-  
510/510P and PDW-530/530P in the specifications of  
recording format, internal optical filters, and so on.  
and EFP , in which a color video camera using / -inch  
3
high-definition CCDs of a 16:9 aspect ratio and a  
Professional Disc drive are combined integrally. The  
camera’s CCDs have approximately 1,000,000 picture  
elements (pixels) (the number of effective pixels:  
approximately 500,000).  
PDW-510/510P recording format and internal optical  
filters  
In addition to the well-established high image quality and  
resistance to vibration, dust, and moisture of the Betacam  
SP/SX camcorders, this unit adds a range of new  
functionality exploiting the capabilities of optical discs.  
Recording DVCAM  
Video  
25 Mbps  
DVCAM format  
format  
compatible  
recording  
1)  
Audio  
16 bits, 48 kHz,  
4 channels  
1) ENG: Electronic News Gathering  
2) EFP: Electronic Field Production  
Recording 85 minutes  
time  
Optical  
filters  
Single integrated filter system for CC (color  
correction) and ND (neutral density)  
PDW-530/530P recording format and internal optical  
filters  
Recording DVCAM  
format compatible  
recording  
Video  
Audio  
25 Mbps  
DVCAM format  
16 bits, 48 kHz,  
4 channels  
Recording 85 minutes  
time  
2)  
MPEG IMX Video  
compatible  
recording  
MPEG IMX format  
(4:2:2 high image  
quality video  
recording using  
MPEG2 intra  
frames)  
3)  
Audio  
16 bits or 24 bits  
48 kHz sampling,  
4 channels  
,
Recording 50 Mbps: 45 minutes  
time  
40 Mbps: 55 minutes  
30 Mbps: 68 minutes  
12  
1-1 Features  
         
• The TURBO GAIN button enables an instantaneous  
boost of the video gain to the maximum 48 dB.  
Optical  
filters  
Separate CC filters and ND filters; two filters  
can be used simultaneously  
1) ATW: Auto Tracing White balance  
2) TruEye: “TruEye” is a registered trademark of Sony Corporation.  
1) DVCAM is a trademark of Sony Corporation.  
2) MPEG IMX is a trademark of Sony Corporation.  
3) For analog audio input, the effective bit length is maximum 20 bits.  
Freeze mix function  
The following characteristics are common to the PDW-  
510/510P and PDW-530/530P.  
This allows a still image from the previously captured  
video to be aligned with the video output from the camera.  
Thus you can adjust the camera position to get exactly the  
same framing for new shooting.  
1-1-2 Camera Features  
Wide range of menu settings  
The menus provide the following operations, among  
others.  
• Status display, message, and marker display settings  
• Camera adjustment settings  
• Switch function assignment  
• “Memory Stick” operations  
You can also assign any settings to the USER menu, to  
create customized menus.  
2
/ -inch Power HAD EX CCDs  
3
2
The three high sensitivity, low smear / -inch Power  
HAD EX CCDs provide high image quality which is at  
the top of its class for a standard definition camcorder.  
• The unit is switchable between a 16:9 aspect ratio wide  
image and 4:3 standard aspect ratio.  
3
1)  
• You can select an interlaced scan mode or progressive  
2)  
scan mode (30 fps (frames per second) for the PDW-  
510/530, 25 fps for the PDW-510P/530P).  
• With the optional CBK-FC01 Pull Down Board  
installed, a 24 fps progressive scan video can be  
recorded subjected to pull-down, providing imaging  
quality close to that of film. (PDW-510/530 only)  
3)  
Saving and recalling settings in a “Memory  
Stick”  
Using an optional “Memory Stick” , you can save menu  
1)  
1) Abbreviation of “Power Hole-Accumulated Diode.” “Power HAD” is a  
registered trademark of Sony Corporation.  
2) More precisely, 29.97 fps  
settings for particular shooting conditions, for recall as  
required.  
3) More precisely, 23.98 fps  
1) “Memory Stick” is a trademark of Sony Corporation.  
Camera signal processing for high quality  
video  
• The 12-bit A/D converter provides high image quality,  
stability, and reliability.  
High-functionality viewfinder  
The 2-inch monochrome viewfinder allows accurate  
focusing.  
The switch settings, automatic black balance and white  
balance items, status, warnings and so on appear on the  
viewfinder screen.  
• The high-performance electronic shutter allows you to  
1)  
select extended clear scan mode (ECS ) and high  
2)  
vertical resolution mode (EVS ), to obtain clear, high-  
quality video.  
1-1-3 Features of the Optical Disc  
Drive (VDR)  
1) ECS: Extended Clear Scan  
2) EVS: Super Enhanced Vertical Definition System  
Shooting functions to cope with different  
Recording and playback in clip units  
Each time you start and stop recording, this creates an  
independent clip.  
shooting conditions  
• A slow shutter function (up to / second) is provided as  
1
2
a standard feature. This allows noiseless shooting under  
very poor lighting conditions and a variety of expressive  
possibilities, such as shots of flowing streams which are  
smoothed out by afterimages.  
• During recording, material is always written to unused  
parts of the disc. Therefore, even when playing back  
between shooting sessions, there is no danger of  
inadvertently overwriting the previous recording.  
• Immediately after recording, you can delete clips you  
decide not to keep, allowing efficient use of the available  
disc capacity.  
• During playback, you can check the recorded video and  
audio by viewing thumbnail images of clips on the disc  
and jumping instantly to the first frames of other clips.  
• You can easily recall sets of adjustment values from  
memory, to match the particular lighting conditions.  
1)  
• The ATW function provides automatic white balance  
adjustment in response to changing lighting conditions.  
TM 2)  
• The TruEye  
process yields distortion-free video,  
even with high intensity colors.  
1-1 Features  
13  
     
1)  
• The i.LINK (FAM (File Access Mode)) function  
Thumbnail search  
allows you to transfer clip files by connecting a  
computer, or by connecting the unit to a network with the  
CBK-NC01 Network Adaptor (option).  
Thumbnail images of the clips on the disc can be displayed  
on the LCD panel and in the viewfinder by pressing the  
THUMBNAIL button. They can also be shown in external  
video output.  
1) i.LINK is a trademark of Sony Corporation.  
You can check the content of a clip simply by moving the  
cursor to its thumbnail and pressing the play button.  
Picture cache recording  
Video and audio for a maximum of 10 seconds is always  
held in memory, so that when you start recording, it is  
possible to record from just before the REC START button  
was pressed.  
Scene selection  
You can create and play back clip lists of selected clips  
from the disc, arranged in any order.  
One disc can store up to 99 clip lists.  
Clip lists make it simple to perform offline editing in the  
field for later use with full-scale nonlinear editing systems  
(XPRI , etc.).  
Time-lapse video (intermittent recording)  
function  
You can record video intermittently, capturing any number  
of frames at any desired time interval.  
1)  
1) XPRI is a trademark of Sony Corporation.  
High reliability under tough operating  
conditions  
With resistance to vibration and dust comparable to tape  
based camcorders, this unit can be relied on just like a  
conventional unit.  
Proxy AV data  
• Proxy AV data is low-resolution data with a video  
bandwidth of 1.5 Mbps and an audio bandwidth of 64  
Kbps per channel. This unit records proxy AV data on  
the Professional Disc whenever MPEG IMX or  
DVCAM format data is recorded on the main channel.  
• Proxy AV data is much smaller in size than the full-  
resolution IMX or DVCAM data. It can be transferred  
quickly over computer networks, easily edited in the  
field with laptop computers, and readily used in a wide  
variety of applications, such as content management on  
small-scale servers.  
1-1-4 Input and Outputs  
Range of audio inputs and outputs  
• A super-cardioid directional monaural microphone with  
external power supply is supplied as standard  
equipment. By changing the connector (service  
component replacement), a stereo microphone can be  
fitted.  
• The optional slot-in type WRR-855A/855B UHF  
Synthesized Tuner Unit can be installed in the unit.  
• The two AUDIO IN connectors (XLR type, 3-pin) on the  
rear panel of the unit can be switched to line input,  
microphone input, or + 48V external power, and also to  
AES/EBU digital audio inputs (maximum 24 bits).  
• When audio cables are connected to the two AUDIO IN  
connectors (XLR type, 3-pin) on the rear panel of the  
unit, an automatic detection function forces the  
recording of the audio input signals from these  
connectors as channels 1 and 2.  
Wide range of metadata recording  
In addition to video and audio, various types of additional  
information can be recorded on the Professional Disc as  
metadata.  
• Essence marks can be added to mark important locations  
in the video and audio data.  
Essence marks can be added manually at any frame by  
pressing the lens RET button or an assignable button.  
They can also be added automatically at locations where  
there is a sudden change in luminance or audio input  
above a specified threshold.  
• The supplied logging software can be used to add titles,  
comments, and other text data to clips.  
• Computer-readable text files can be recorded on the  
Professional Disc to enable systematic content  
management.  
1)  
• The AUDIO OUT connectors (XLR type, 5-pin) provide  
two channels of audio output.  
The ability to search metadata for the required audio and  
video scenes brings greater efficiency to various stages of  
the video production process, such as editing, and  
archiving.  
(i.LINK) connector  
The i.LINK connector of this unit supports the following  
two functions.  
1) Professional Disc is a trademark of Sony Corporation.  
Input and output of DV streams (AV/C (Audio/  
Video Control) mode)  
DV streams can be output from this unit and recorded on  
1)  
standard DV equipment.  
14  
1-1 Features  
     
In the same way, the output from external DV devices  
(VTRs, nonlinear editors, etc.) can be input to this unit and  
recorded on Professional Discs.  
2.5-inch color LCD panel  
The side of the unit has an LCD that can be switched to  
show the following images and data.  
• Status information, including audio level meters and  
time code  
• Thumbnails of the video recorded on the Professional  
Disc  
• A playback image of the video recorded on the  
Professional Disc  
• The camera image  
2)  
DV-compliant nonlinear editors may also be connected.  
1) In the case of the PDW-530/530P, DV stream output is also possible when  
the unit is set to IMX recording mode. Audio data is recorded after  
conversion according to the specifications of this unit.  
2) In the case of the PDW-530/530P, this is possible only when the unit is set  
to DVCAM recording mode.  
Computer access to files (File Access Mode)  
1)  
Use of application software which supports the XDCAM  
seriesenables random access to video, audio, and metadata  
files on Professional Discs, with the ability to display file  
lists and perform file-based reads and writes.  
Files can be transferred at high speed, and thumbnail lists  
of disc contents can be viewed on computer screens.  
Monochrome LCD panel  
Even when this unit is powered off, the time code,  
remaining disc capacity, battery capacity, and other status  
information appears on the monochrome LCD. (This  
requires either a battery or a DC power supply connected.)  
1) Such software includes the supplied PDZ-1 Proxy Browsing Software and  
the XPRI series.  
Instant operation assignable switches  
Two switches provided on the side panel and on the top of  
the grip, respectively, can be assigned to any functions, by  
a menu operation.  
Furthermore, the TURBO GAIN button can also be used as  
an assignable switch.  
Remote control connectors  
By connecting an optional RM-B150/B750 or similar  
remote control unit, you can control the shooting functions  
of this unit externally.  
Function extension interface  
• Installing the optional CBK-SD01 SDI Output Board  
enables SDI signal output from the VIDEO OUT  
connectors.  
• By installing the optional CBK-SC01 Analog Composite  
Input Board, a composite video signal input to the  
GENLOCK connector can be recorded on this unit.  
• An extension connector can be attached to the battery  
attachment on the rear panel, to allow various camera  
adapters to be fitted.  
Alarm function  
If a fault is detected on the optical disc drive, or if the disc  
or battery capacity is low, notication is provided by  
warning indicators and audible alarms.  
SMPTE (PDW-510/530)/EBU (PDW-510P/  
530P) color bars, and 1 kHz reference  
signal output  
Adjustment of a color monitor or external audio device is  
easy. Color bars for an SNG uplink are also provided.  
1)  
Network connector (option)  
The optional CBK-NC01 Network Adaptor can be  
installed on this unit to enable connections to computers  
and networks. This makes it possible to transfer files at  
high speeds, and to display of lists of the video, audio, and  
metadata files stored on Professional Discs. Workflows  
can be improved by the ability to use FTP commands to  
transfer files to remote locations over networks.  
1) SNG: Satellite News Gathering  
Viewfinder height adjustable  
In addition to the front to rear and left to right directions,  
the viewfinder can be adjusted vertically in two steps.  
1)  
Supports SNMP for maintenance and  
1-1-5 Other Functions  
service (option)  
The SNMP-compliant Sony Remote Maintenance and  
Monitoring Software can be used when the optional CBK-  
NC01 Network Adaptor is installed on this unit. Via a  
TCP/IP network connection, this software can monitor the  
hardware status of this unit in real time and record  
monitoring logs. This allows you to analyze the problem  
immediately and take the necessary steps whenever a  
hardware failure is detected.  
Usability-oriented design  
• There is more space around the rear panel connectors  
than on previous models, making cable connections and  
switch operations easier.  
• The adjustment range of the shoulder pad in the front to  
rear direction is increased, making it easier to ensure  
proper balance when using the unit.  
1) To be supported shortly.  
1-1 Features  
15  
         
1-2 Example of System Configuration  
The diagram below shows a typical configuration of the  
camcorder for ENG and EFP.  
For more information about the fittings, connections, or  
use of additional equipment and accessories, see Chapter  
9 as well as the operation manuals for the connected  
equipment.  
Viewfinder-related equipment  
AC power supply  
Name / Purpose Magnification Part No.  
Product  
Model name  
AC-550/550CE  
AC-DN10  
Fog-proof filter  
Lens assembly  
Lens assembly  
Lens assembly  
1-547-341-11  
AC Adaptor  
AC Adaptor  
–2.8 D to +2.0 D A-8262-537-A  
–3.6 D to –0.8 D A-8262-538-A  
–3.6 D to +0.4 D A-8267-737-A  
–2.4 D to +0.5 D A-8314-798-A  
Battery  
Product  
Model name  
Lens assembly  
(3 × magnification)  
Battery Charger BC-M150/M50  
1)  
BP-GL65/GL95/  
L60S/M100  
Battery Pack  
Connection through i.LINK interface  
1) BP-L40/M50 cannot be used.  
Devices with a DV connector (DSR-DU1 etc.)  
Camera adaptor  
Extension board  
Product  
Model name  
Product  
Model name  
CBK-SD01  
Input of audio channels CA-701  
3/4 and SDI output  
SDI Output Board  
Composite Input Board CBK-SC01  
CCZ (26-pin) output/  
analog composite/SDI  
input  
CA-702/702P  
2)  
Pull Down Board  
CBK-FC01  
Network Adaptor  
CBK-NC01  
2) For PDW-510/530 only  
Audio signal source  
“Memory Stick”  
External microphone ECM-672 or similar  
microphone  
RM-B150/B750 Remote  
Control Unit  
CAC-12 Microphone Holder  
Audio equipment  
Video monitor for color image  
check during shooting  
WRR-862 UHF Portable Tuner  
WRR-855 series UHF Synthesized Tuner Unit  
CCXA-53 audio cable  
XLR 5-pin connector for stereo  
microphone (service part)  
DMX-P01 Portable Digital Mixer  
16  
1-2 Example of System Configuration  
   
1-3 Precautions  
1-4 Using the CD-ROM  
Manual  
Use and Storage  
Do not subject the unit to severe shocks  
The internal mechanism may be damaged or the body  
warped.  
The supplied CR-ROM includes versions of the Operation  
Manual for the PDW-510/510P/530/530P in English,  
Japanese, French, German, Italian, Spanish, and Chinese.  
After use  
Always turn off the power.  
1-4-1 CD-ROM System  
Requirements  
Before storing the unit for a long period  
Remove the battery pack.  
The following are required to access the supplied CD-  
ROM disc.  
Use and storage locations  
• Computer: PC with Intel Pentium CPU  
- Installed memory: 64 MB or more  
- CD-ROM drive: ×8 or faster  
• Monitor: Monitor supporting resolution of 800 × 600 or  
higher  
• Operating system: Microsoft Windows Millennium  
Edition, Windows 2000 Service Pack 2, Windows XP  
Professional or Windows XP Home Edition  
Store in a level, ventilated place. Avoid using or storing the  
unit in the following places.  
• Places subject to temperature extremes  
• Very damp places  
• Places subject to severe vibration  
• Near strong magnetic fields  
• In direct sunlight or close to heaters for extended periods  
To prevent electromagnetic interference from  
portable communications devices  
The use of portable telephones and other communications  
devices near this unit can result in malfunctions and  
interference with audio and video signals.  
When these requirements are not met, access to the CD-  
ROM disc may be slow, or not possible at all.  
1-4-2 Preparations  
It is recommended that the portable communications  
devices near this unit be powered off.  
One of the following programs must be installed on your  
computer in order to use the operation manuals contained  
on the CD-ROM disc.  
• Adobe Acrobat Reader Version 4.0 or higher  
• Adobe Reader Version 6.0 or higher  
Note on laser beams  
Laser beams may damage the CCDs. If you shoot a scene  
that includes a laser beam, be careful not to let the laser  
beam be directed into the lens of the camera.  
Use at a high temperature  
If the unit is used at a high temperature, white flecks may  
appear on the screen.  
Note  
If Adobe Reader is not installed, you can download it from  
the following URL:  
http://www.adobe.com/  
About the LCD panels  
LCD panels are manufactured with extremely high-  
precision technology that yields effective pixel rates of  
99.99% or higher. However, very rarely, one or more  
pixels may be permanently dark or permanently lit in  
white, red, blue, or green.  
1-4-3 Reading the CD-ROM Manual  
To read the operation manual contained on the CD-ROM  
disc, do the following.  
This phenomenon is not a malfunction. Such pixels have  
no effect on the recorded data, and the unit may be used  
with confidence even if they are present.  
1
2
Insert the CD-ROM disc in your CD-ROM drive.  
A cover page appears automatically in your browser.  
If it does not appear automatically in the browser,  
double-click the index.htm file on the CD-ROM disc.  
Select and click the operation manual that you want to  
read.  
This opens the PDF file of the operation manual.  
1-3 Precautions / 1-4 Using the CD-ROM Manual  
17  
           
Note  
If you lose the CD-ROM disc or become unable to  
read its content, for example because of a hardware  
failure, you can do one of the following.  
• You can purchase a new CD-ROM disc to replace one  
that has been lost or damaged. Contact your Sony service  
representative.  
• You can purchase printed versions of the operation  
manuals (English version). Contact your Sony service  
representative.  
When ordering, be sure to specify the part number of the  
manual you want.  
Part No.  
Models covered  
3-805-948-0X  
PDW-510/510P/530/530P  
Intel and Pentium are registered trademarks of Intel Corporation or its  
subsidiaries in the United States and other countries.  
Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft  
Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.  
Adobe, Acrobat, and Adobe Reader are trademarks of Adobe Systems  
Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries.  
18  
1-4 Using the CD-ROM Manual  
Locations and Functions  
of Parts and Controls  
2
Chapter  
2-1 Power Supply  
1 Battery attachment  
2 DC IN connector  
3 POWER switch  
4 LIGHT switch  
a Battery attachment  
d LIGHT switch  
This determines how a video light connected to the LIGHT  
connector is turned on and off.  
AUTO: When the switch on the video light is in the on  
position, putting the camcorder in recording mode  
turns the video light on automatically. When using the  
auto interval recording mode, the video light is  
automatically turned on immediately before recording  
starts.  
Attach a BP-GL65/GL95/L60S/M100 battery pack.  
Furthermore, by attaching an AC-DN10 AC Adaptor, you  
can operate the camcorder from AC power.  
Note  
For your safety, and to ensure proper operation of the unit,  
Sony recommends the use of the following battery packs:  
BP-GL65, BP-GL95, BP-L60S, and BP-M100.  
MANUAL: You can turn the video light on or off  
manually, using its own switch.  
b DC IN connector (XLR type, 4-pin, male)  
To operate the camcorder using an AC power supply,  
connect an AC-550/550CE AC Adaptor with the DC  
output cable supplied with the adaptor.  
Note  
To ensure proper operation of the video light with the unit,  
Sony recommends the use of the following battery packs:  
BP-GL65, BP-GL95, BP-L60S, and BP-M100.  
c POWER switch  
This switch turns the main power supply on and off.  
2-1 Power Supply  
19  
                 
2-2 Accessory Attachments  
1 Shoulder strap posts  
2 Light shoe  
3 LIGHT connector  
4 Lens mount  
5 Lens locking lever  
6 Lens mount cap  
7 LENS connector  
8 Tripod mount  
9 Shoulder pad  
Lens cable clamp  
a Shoulder strap posts  
Attach the supplied shoulder strap to these posts.  
h Tripod mount  
When using the camcorder on a tripod, attach the tripod  
adaptor (option).  
i Shoulder pad  
You can move the shoulder pad forwards or backwards by  
raising up the shoulder pad locking lever. Do this to ensure  
the best balance when shooting with the camcorder on  
your shoulder.  
b Light shoe  
Attach an optional accessory such as a video light to this  
shoe.  
c LIGHT connector (2-pin, female)  
Connect the cable of an Anton Bauer Ultralight System  
attached to the light shoe. The system operates with lights  
powered by 12 V, with a maximum power consumption of  
50 W.  
d Lens mount (special bayonet mount)  
Use this for mounting the lens.  
e Lens locking lever  
After inserting the lens in the lens mount, rotate the lens  
mount ring with this lever to lock the lens in position.  
f Lens mount cap  
Remove this cap by pushing up the lens locking lever.  
When no lens is mounted, keep this cap fitted for  
protection from dust.  
g LENS connector (12-pin)  
Fit the lens cable to this connector. Contact your Sony  
representative for more information about the lens you can  
use.  
20  
2-2 Accessory Attachments  
                     
2-3 Audio Functions  
8 Built-in speaker  
1 Microphone  
2 MIC IN connector  
4 EARPHONE jack (rear, stereo)  
7 ALARM volume control  
3 MIC LEVEL control  
6 MONITOR volume control  
5 MONITOR switch and CH-1/2 / CH-3/4 switch  
4 EARPHONE jack (front, monaural)  
Audio functions (1)  
1) E-E: Abbreviation of “Electric-to-Electric.” In E-E mode, video and audio  
signals input to the camcorder are output after passing through internal  
electric circuits only. This can be used to check input signals.  
a Microphone  
This is a super-cardioid directional monaural microphone  
with an external power supply (+48 V) system.  
e MONITOR switch and CH-1/2 / CH-3/4 switch  
These switches together determine the channel selection  
for audio monitor output.  
b MIC IN (microphone input) connector (XLR type,  
3-pin, female)  
Connect the supplied microphone to this connector. A  
microphone other than the supplied one may also be  
connected as long as it can operate with the power (+48 V)  
supplied from this connector.  
MONITOR switch  
By fitting a 5-pin connector (service part number: A-1053-  
453-A), you can also use a stereo microphone.  
CH-1/2 / CH-3/4 switch  
c MIC (microphone) LEVEL control  
This control adjusts the audio level of the microphone  
connected to the MIC IN connector.  
MONITOR switch and CH-1/2 / CH-3/4 switch  
d EARPHONE jack (front) (monaural, minijack) /  
EARPHONE jack (rear) (monaural/stereo  
switchable, minijack)  
CH-1/2 / CH-3/4 switch:  
This determines the pair of audio channels selected with  
the MONITOR switch.  
1)  
You can monitor the E-E sound during recording and  
CH-1/2 position: channels 1 and 2  
CH-3/4 position: channels 3 and 4  
The signals output from the AUDIO OUT connector and  
EARPHONE jacks also depend on the setting of this  
switch.  
playback sound during playback. Plugging an earphone  
into the jack automatically cuts off the built-in speaker.  
When an alarm is indicated, you can hear the alarm sound  
through the earphone.  
You can use the rear EARPHONE jack for stereo output,  
by setting the HEADPHONE OUT item in the AUDIO-1  
page of the MAINTENANCE menu to “STREO”. You can  
also connect a monaural earphone to the front jack and a  
monaural/stereo earphone set to the rear jack  
simultaneously.  
MONITOR switch:  
This selects the audio monitor channels output to the  
monaural earphone or speaker, depending on the setting of  
the CH-1/2 / CH-3/4 switch.  
2-3 Audio Functions  
21  
               
CH-1/2CH-3/4 MONITOR Audio output  
switch  
position  
switch  
position  
CH-1/2  
CH-1  
MIX  
Audio channel 1  
Mix sound of channels 1 and 2  
Audio channel 2  
Minimum  
Maximum  
CH-2  
CH-3  
MIX  
CH-3/4  
Audio channel 3  
ALARM volume control  
Mix sound of channels 3 and 4  
Audio channel 4  
CH-4  
h Built-in speaker  
The speaker can be used to monitor E-E sound during  
recording, and playback sound during playback. The  
speaker also sounds alarms to reinforce visual warnings.  
The output level of the speaker can be lowered by  
changing the setting of the SP ATT LEVEL item on the  
AUDIO-1 page of the MAINTENANCE menu.  
If you connect an earphone to the EARPHONE jack, the  
speaker is automatically muted.  
f MONITOR volume control  
This control adjusts the speaker or earphone volume for  
sounds other than the alarm sound. At the minimum  
position, no sound can be heard.  
g ALARM volume control  
This control adjusts the speaker or earphone alarm volume.  
At the minimum position, no sound can be heard.  
However, if in the AUDIO-1 page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu the MIN ALARM VOL item is  
set to “SET”, the alarm tone is audible even when this  
volume control is at the minimum position.  
information about alarms.  
THUMBNAIL  
SEL/SET  
9 LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) controls  
ESSENCE MARK  
S.SEL  
SUB CLIP  
0 AUDIO SELECT CH-1/CH-2 switches  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
qa AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 / CH-3/CH-4 switches  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
qs LINE / AES/EBU / MIC selectors  
qd +48V/OFF switches  
qf AUDIO OUT connector  
qg AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors  
qh DC OUT 12V connector  
Audio functions (2)  
i LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) (audio channel-1 and  
channel-2 recording level) controls  
These controls adjust the audio levels of channels 1 and 2  
when the AUDIO SELECT switches are set to MANUAL.  
22  
2-3 Audio Functions  
       
j AUDIO SELECT CH-1/CH-2 (audio channel-1  
and channel-2 adjustment method selection)  
switches  
These switches select the audio level adjustment method  
for each of audio channels 1 and 2.  
AUTO: Select this setting for automatic adjustment.  
MANUAL: Select this setting for manual adjustment.  
n AUDIO OUT (audio output) connector (XLR type,  
5-pin, male)  
This connector outputs the audio signals recorded on audio  
channels 1 and 2 or audio channels 3 and 4.  
The MONITOR CH-1/2 / CH-3/4 switches allow you to  
select the audio signal to be monitored.  
o AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 (audio channel-1 and  
channel-2 input) connectors (XLR type, 3-pin,  
female)  
k AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 / CH-3/CH-4 (audio input  
selection) switches  
These are audio input connectors for channels 1 and 2 to  
which you can connect audio equipment or a microphone.  
When the LINE / AES/EBU / MIC selector is set to AES/  
EBU, the CH1 connector is used for channel-1 and -2  
inputs, and the CH2 connector, for channel-3 and -4 inputs.  
AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 switches  
These switches select the audio input signals to be  
recorded on audio channels 1 and 2.  
FRONT: The input signal source is the microphone  
connected to the MIC IN connector.  
REAR: The input signal source is the audio equipment  
connected to the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors.  
WIRELESS: The input signal source is a WRR-855A/  
855B UHF Synthesized Tuner Unit (option).  
p DC OUT 12 V (DC power output) connector (4-pin,  
female)  
This connector supplies power for a WRR-862 UHF  
Portable Tuner (option). Do not connect any equipment  
other than the UHF portable tuner.  
AUDIO IN CH-3/CH-4 switches  
These switches select the audio input signals to be  
recorded on audio channels 3 and 4.  
F (front): The input signal source is the microphone  
connected to the MIC IN connector.  
R (rear): The input signal source is the audio equipment  
connected to the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors.  
W (wireless): The input signal source is a WRR-855A/  
855B UHF Synthesized Tuner Unit.  
With a CA-701 Camera Adaptor (option) connected to the  
camcorder, you can record separate sounds on audio  
channels 3 and 4.  
l LINE /AES/EBU / MIC selectors  
These select the audio source of the audio input signals  
input to the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors.  
LINE: Line input audio equipment  
AES/EBU: AES/EBU format audio signal  
MIC: Microphone input  
Note  
When these switches are in the MIC position, and the  
+48V switch described below is on, if you inadvertently  
connect any audio device other than a microphone to the  
AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors, the device may be  
damaged.  
m +48V/OFF switches  
Select either of the following positions for the  
microphones to be connected.  
+48V: For a microphone to use an external power supply  
OFF: For a microphone to use an internal power supply  
2-3 Audio Functions  
23  
             
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback Functions  
7 Viewfinder  
8 Diopter adjustment ring  
Eyecup  
1 Tally indicator  
2 BRIGHT control  
3 CONTRAST control  
4 PEAKING control  
5 ZEBRA switch  
6 TALLY switch  
0 Viewfinder left-right positioning ring  
qa Camera operator tally indicator  
9 Viewfinder front-rear positioning lever  
qs Viewfinder stopper  
qd LOCK knob  
Shooting and recording/playback functions (1)  
1)  
a Tally indicator  
ON: The zebra pattern is displayed and stays.  
OFF: No zebra pattern is displayed.  
Setting the TALLY switch to HIGH or LOW enables this  
indicator. The indicator lights during recording on the  
VDR (video disc recorder). Like the REC indicator in the  
viewfinder, it flashes to indicate a problem. You can set the  
indicator brightness with the TALLY switch.  
MOMENT: The zebra pattern is displayed and stays for 5  
to 6 seconds.  
The zebra pattern is factory set to indicate picture areas  
where the video level is approximately 70%.You can use  
the setup menu to change the setting so that areas where  
the video level is 100% and above are also displayed at the  
same time.  
b BRIGHT (brightness) control  
This control adjusts the picture brightness on the  
viewfinder screen. It has no effect on the camera output  
signal.  
For information about how to change the zebra pattern  
setting in the setup menu, see 7-2-5 “Setting the  
c CONTRAST control  
This control adjusts the picture contrast on the viewfinder  
screen. It has no effect on the camera output signal.  
1) The zebra pattern aids in manual iris adjustment by indicating areas of the  
picture where the video level is approximately 70% and 100% and above.  
d PEAKING control  
f TALLY switch  
This control adjusts the sharpness of the picture on the  
viewfinder screen to make focusing easier. It has no effect  
on the camera output signal.  
This switch controls the tally indicator, setting its  
brightness (HIGH or LOW) or turning it off.  
HIGH: The tally indicator brightness is high.  
OFF: The tally indicator is disabled.  
LOW: The tally indicator brightness is low.  
e ZEBRA switch  
This switch controls the zebra pattern on the viewfinder  
screen.  
24  
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback Functions  
               
g Viewfinder  
j Viewfinder left-right positioning ring  
Loosen this ring to move the viewfinder sideways.  
The viewfinder lets you view the image in black and white  
while shooting, recording or playing back. It also displays  
various warnings and messages related to the settings or  
operating conditions of the camcorder, a zebra pattern,  
k Camera operator tally indicator  
This indicator lights while the camcorder is recording.  
Slide the window open when you shoot with your eye  
away from the viewfinder. This indicator flashes when the  
battery level is running low or the disc is almost full.  
1)  
2)  
safety zone marker , and center marker  
.
1) The safety zone marker is a rectangle indicating the effective picture area.  
2) The center marker indicates the center of the picture with a crosshair.  
l Viewfinder stopper  
Pull up this stopper to detach the viewfinder from the  
camera.  
h Diopter adjustment ring  
Use this ring to adjust the viewfinder image for your  
vision.  
m LOCK knob  
To adjust the viewfinder position in the front-rear  
direction, loosen this knob and the viewfinder front-rear  
positioning lever. After adjustment, retighten this knob  
and the viewfinder front-rear positioning lever.  
i Viewfinder front-rear positioning lever  
To adjust the viewfinder position in the front-rear  
direction, loosen this lever and the LOCK knob. After  
adjustment, retighten this lever and the LOCK knob.  
ws ASSIGN 3/4 switches  
wa TURBO GAIN button  
qf FILTER selector  
qg ASSIGN. 1/2 switches  
qh SHUTTER selector  
w; WHITE BAL switch  
ql OUTPUT/DCC selector  
qk GAIN selector  
qj AUTO W/B BAL switch  
Shooting and recording/playback functions (2)  
n FILTER selector  
For the PDW-510/510P  
Use this selector to select the most appropriate filter to  
match the light source illuminating the subject.  
When this selector is used with the display mode set to 3,  
the new setting appears on the viewfinder screen for about  
3 seconds. (e.g.: FILTER: 3)  
The PDW-510/510P has one switchable filter, and the  
PDW-530/530P has two switchable filters.  
The relationships between the selector settings and filter  
selections as well as examples of filters for different  
shooting conditions are as follows.  
FILTER selector setting and filter selection  
FILTER selector setting  
Filter selection  
1
2
3200 K  
1
5600 K + / ND  
8
3
4
5600 K  
1
5600 K + / ND  
64  
Examples of shooting conditions and appropriate filters  
Shooting condition  
Sunrise and sunset; inside studio  
Clear skies  
Filter  
1 (3200 K)  
1
2 (5600 K + / ND)  
8
Cloudy or raining  
3 (5600 K)  
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback Functions  
25  
         
Examples of shooting conditions and appropriate filters  
For details about the shutter speed and mode settings, see  
Shooting condition  
Filter  
1
Very bright conditions such as snow, at  
high altitudes, or at the seashore  
4 (5600 K + / ND)  
q AUTO W/B BAL (automatic white/black balance  
adjustment) switch  
64  
This switch activates the white balance and black balance  
automatic adjustment functions.  
For the PDW-530/530P  
FILTER selector (outer knob) setting and CC filter  
selection  
WHITE: Automatic adjustment of the white balance. If  
the WHITE BAL switch is set to A or B, the white  
balance setting is stored in the corresponding memory.  
On the PDW-530/530P models with two switchable  
filters, the memory stores a separate white balance  
setting for each CC filter setting.  
FILTER selector (outer knob) setting CC filter selection  
1)  
A
Cross filter  
3200 K  
B
C
D
BLACK: Automatic adjustment of the black set and black  
balance.  
4300 K  
6300 K  
1) A type of special effect filter. Generates a cross of light on a highlighted  
portion.  
r GAIN selector  
This selector switches the gain of the video amplifier to  
match the lighting conditions during shooting. The gains  
corresponding to the L, M, and H settings can be selected  
from the setup menu. The factory settings are L = 0 dB, M  
= 9 dB, and H = 18 dB.  
When this selector is adjusted, the new setting appears on  
the setting change/adjustment progress message display  
area of the viewfinder screen for about 3 seconds.  
FILTER selector (inner knob) setting and ND filter  
selection  
FILTER selector (inner knob) setting ND filter selection  
1
2
Clear  
1
/4 ND  
1
3
4
/16 ND  
1
For details about setting the gain values, see 7-3-1  
/64 ND  
Examples of shooting conditions and appropriate filters  
Shooting condition  
CC filter  
ND filter  
s OUTPUT/DCC (output signal/dynamic contrast  
control) selector  
This selector switches the video signal that is output to the  
VDR, viewfinder, and video monitor, between the  
following two.  
Sunrise and sunset; inside B (3200 K)  
studio  
1 (clear)  
1
Clear skies  
C (4300 K) or  
D (6300 K)  
2 ( /4 ND) or 3  
1/  
( 16 ND)  
BARS: Outputs the color bar signal.  
CAM: Outputs the video signal from the camera. When  
Cloudy or raining  
D (6300 K)  
1 (clear) or 2  
( /4 ND)  
1
1)  
this is selected, you can switch DCC on and off with  
this selector.  
1
Very bright conditions such C (4300 K) or  
as snow, at high altitudes, D (6300 K)  
or at the seashore  
3 ( /16 ND) or  
1
4 ( /64 ND)  
1) DCC (Dynamic Contrast Control)  
Against a very bright background with the iris opening adjusted to the  
subject, objects in the background will be lost in the glare. The DCC  
function will suppress the high intensity and restore much of the lost detail  
and is particularly effective in the following cases.  
• Shooting people in the shade on a sunny day  
o ASSIGN. 1/2 switches  
You can assign the desired functions to each of the  
ASSIGN. 1 switch (push button) and ASSIGN. 2 switch  
(sliding) on the FUNCTION 1 page of the USER menu.  
• Shooting a subject indoors, against a background through a window  
• Any high contrast scene  
p SHUTTER selector  
Set this selector to ON to use the electronic shutter. Push it  
down to SELECT to switch the shutter speed or mode  
setting within the range previously set with the setup  
menu.  
When this selector is operated, the new setting appears on  
the setting change/adjustment progress message display  
area for about 3 seconds.  
26  
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback Functions  
         
switch and the FILTER selector.  
BARS, DCC OFF  
You can use the AUTO W/B BAL switch even when  
A color bar signal is output and the  
DCC circuit does not operate. For  
example, use the setting for the  
following purposes.  
• Adjusting the video monitor  
• Recording the color bar signal  
1)  
ATW is in use.  
B (ATW): When this switch is set to B and on the  
FUNCTION 2 page of the OPERATION menu,  
“WHITE B CH” is set to “ATW” , ATW is activated.  
1)  
1) ATW (Auto Tracing White Balance)  
The white balance of the picture being shot is adjusted automatically for  
varying lighting conditions.  
When this switch is adjusted, the new setting appears on  
the setting change/adjustment progress message display  
area of the viewfinder screen for about 3 seconds.  
CAM, DCC OFF  
The video signal from the camera is  
output, and the DCC circuit does not  
operate.  
You can assign the ATW ON/OFF function to the  
ASSIGN 1 switch (push button) on the FUNCTION 1 page  
of the USER menu.  
CAM, DCC ON  
The video signal from the camera is  
output, and the DCC circuit operates.  
OUTPUT/DCC selector  
u TURBO GAIN button  
t WHITE BAL (white balance memory) switch  
This switch controls the white balance setting.  
PRST (preset): Adjusts the color temperature  
corresponding to the position of the FILTER selector.  
Use the PRST setting when you have no time to adjust  
the white balance.  
When shooting under extremely poor lighting conditions,  
press the button once to boost the video gain to the value  
preset on the GAIN SW page of the USER menu (up to  
48 dB). To stop boosting the gain, press the button once  
more.  
A or B: When the AUTO W/B BAL switch is pushed to  
WHT, the white balance is automatically adjusted  
according to the current position of the FILTER  
selector, and the adjusted value is stored in either  
memory A or memory B. (There are two memories for  
each CC filter, allowing a total of eight adjustments to  
be stored.) When this switch is set to A or B, the  
camcorder automatically adjusts itself to the stored  
value corresponding to the current settings of this  
v ASSIGN 3/4 switches  
You can assign the desired functions to each of the  
ASSIGN 3 switch and ASSIGN 4 switch on the  
FUNCTION 1 page of the USER menu.  
wf REMOTE connector  
wg GENLOCK IN connector  
wd VIDEO OUT connector  
wh TEST OUT connector  
wj  
DV IN/OUT S400 connector  
Shooting and recording/playback functions (3)  
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback Functions  
27  
     
w VIDEO OUT connector (BNC type)  
wj  
(i.LINK) DV IN/OUT S400 connector (6-pin,  
This connector outputs a composite video signal for a  
video monitor. With a video monitor connected to this  
connector, you can monitor the picture being shot by the  
camera or the picture played back by the VDR. To choose  
between the composite video signal output and SDI signal  
output, use the menu. When synchronizing the time code  
of an external VDR with that of the camcorder, connect  
this connector to the GENLOCK IN connector of the  
external VDR.  
By installing the CBK-SD01 extension board (not  
supplied), you can output an SDI signal (supporting  
embedded audio and the EDH function) from this  
connector.  
IEEE1394 compliant)  
Connect to a device supporting the DV format or a  
computer, using a i.LINK cable.  
Notes  
• If video and audio signals are not output to an external  
device connected to the i.LINK DV IN/OUT S400  
connector, try disconnecting the i.LINK cable and then  
reconnecting it, making sure that it is firmly seated.  
• When you connect this unit to an external device with a  
6-pin i.LINK connector, always power this unit off and  
disconnect the DC cable from the DC IN connector, or  
remove the battery pack, before connecting or  
disconnecting the i.LINK cable.  
If you connect or disconnect the i.LINK cable while  
power is being supplied to this unit, high voltage (8 to 40  
V) can flow into this unit from the i.LINK connector of  
the connected equipment, possibly damaging this unit.  
• When you connect this unit to an external device with a  
6-pin i.LINK connector, always connect the 6-pin  
i.LINK connector on the external device first.  
For details on how to select the output signal, see 7-3-2  
x REMOTE connector (8-pin)  
Connect the RM-B150/B750 Remote Control Unit, which  
makes it possible to control the VDR and camera remotely.  
y GENLOCK IN connector (BNC type)  
• This connector inputs a reference signal when the  
camera is to be genlocked or when time code is to be  
synchronized with external equipment. Use the  
MAINTENANCE menu to adjust the genlock H-phase  
(phase of horizontal sync signal) and the sub-carrier  
phase.  
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
• This connector also inputs a return video signal. You can  
display the return video signal in the viewfinder screen  
while holding the RET button down with “RETURN  
VIDEO” set to “ON” on the GENLOCK page of the  
OPERATION menu.  
• This connector also inputs an external analog composite  
video signal.  
When the CBK-SC01 extension board is installed, you  
can record the external analog composite video signal  
input to this connector.  
z TEST OUT connector (BNC type)  
This connector outputs the video signal for a video  
monitor. The output signal can be selected from composite  
or RGB. The factory setting is composite, and the setting  
returns to composite whenever the unit is powered on.  
Depending on internal board and menu settings, menus,  
time code, and shot data can be superimposed on the image  
on the monitor. Like the VIDEO OUT connector, this  
connector can also be used to synchronize the time code of  
an external VTR with the time code of the camcorder.  
For details on how to select the test output signal, refer to  
the Maintenance Manual.  
28  
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback Functions  
         
wk REC START button  
wl VDR SAVE/STBY connector  
e; EJECT button and indicator  
ea F REV button and indicator  
es PLAY/PAUSE button and indicator  
ed F FWD button and indicator  
ef NEXT button  
E
S
U
A
/P  
Y
A
L
P
NEXT  
V
E
R
P
eg STOP button  
eh PREV button  
Shooting and recording/playback functions (4)  
wk REC START button  
es PLAY/PAUSE button and indicator  
Press this button to start recording. Press it again to stop  
recording. The effect is exactly the same as that of the VTR  
button on the lens.  
Press this to view a playback image using the viewfinder  
screen or a color video monitor. The indicator lights during  
playback.  
When the REC SWITCH function is assigned to the  
ASSIGN 1, 3 or 4 switch (push button), you can use the  
switch as the REC START button.  
During playback, pressing this button pauses the playback,  
showing a still image. At this time, the indicator flashes.  
This camcorder is capable of color-image search at  
approximately four-times normal playback speed, making  
it easy to check recorded material. To use the color-image  
search, press the F REV button or F FWD button during  
playback. When the buttons are pressed, the PLAY  
indicator and the F REV or F FWD indicator light.  
wl VDR SAVE/STBY (standby) switch  
This switch controls the VDR power mode during pauses  
in recording.  
SAVE: Power saving mode. Although an internal  
operating sound is recorded as noise when you start  
recording, power consumption in this mode is less than  
in standby mode, so that battery life is extended. When  
the switch is set to SAVE, the SAVE indicator in the  
viewfinder lights.  
ed F FWD (fast forward) button and indicator  
Plays back at high speed in the forward direction. The  
indicator lights during high-speed playback in the forward  
direction.  
STBY: Standby mode. Recording starts as soon as you  
press the REC START button.  
ef NEXT button  
This jumps to the beginning of the next clip, and pauses.  
During the jump, the F FWD indicator flashes.  
Pressing this button together with the F FWD button jumps  
to the last frame of the last clip recorded on the disc.  
e; EJECT button and indicator  
Press this button to eject or load a disc. The indicator  
flashes while the disc is being ejected.  
ea F REV (fast reverse) button and indicator  
Plays back at high speed in the reverse direction. The  
indicator lights during high-speed playback in the reverse  
direction.  
eg STOP button  
Press this button to stop disc playback.  
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback Functions  
29  
               
eh PREV button  
This jumps to the beginning of the current clip, and pauses.  
During the jump, the F REV indicator flashes.Pressing this  
button together with the F REV button jumps to the first  
frame of the first clip recorded on the disc.  
30  
2-4 Shooting and Recording/Playback Functions  
 
2-5 Output Video Operating Section  
1 SEL/SET dial  
2 THUMBNAIL button  
THUMBNAIL  
3 Thumbnail indicator  
SEL/SET  
ESSENCE MARK  
S.SEL  
SUB CLIP  
4 Sub clip indicator  
5 SUB CLIP button  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
6 SHIFT button  
Output video operating section  
a SEL/SET (select/set) dial  
e SUB CLIP button  
When thumbnails (each representing a clip) are shown on  
the color LCD, you can select a particular thumbnail with  
this dial.  
Turning the dial upward moves the cursor to the left, and  
when it reaches the left edge, to the rightmost position in  
the row above. Turning the dial downward moves the  
cursor to the right, and when it reaches the right edge, to  
the leftmost position in the row below. After selecting the  
desired thumbnail with the cursor, press the dial in to  
confirm.  
Press this to play back according to a clip list.  
You can play back a particular clip or sequential clips, or  
carry out a search of the selected clip list.  
When no clip list is selected, pressing this button has no  
effect, and the operation is invalid.  
To carry out operations such as saving, recalling, or  
deleting a clip list, hold down the SHIFT button and press  
this button.  
f SHIFT button  
To carry out a scene selection setting, hold down the  
SHIFT button, and press in this dial.  
Use this in combination with other buttons.  
b THUMBNAIL button  
To carry out a search using thumbnails, or to create a clip  
list, press this button.  
Pressing it switches from the whole-screen display to a  
thumbnail display. Press once more to return to the whole-  
screen display.  
To search thumbnails by essence marks, hold down the  
SHIFT button and press this button.  
c Thumbnail indicator  
This lights when thumbnails are shown.  
d Sub clip indicator  
This lights when playing back following a clip list.  
2-5 Output Video Operating Section  
31  
                 
2-6 Menu Operating Section  
2 STATUS ON/SEL / OFF switch  
3 MENU ON/OFF switch  
MENU  
4 CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch  
5 “Memory Stick” compartment  
Cover  
1 MENU knob  
a MENU knob  
Use this knob to change the page selection or a setting  
c MENU ON/OFF switch  
To use this switch, open the cover.  
within the menu.  
This switch is used to display the menu on the viewfinder  
screen or the test signal screen.  
Press: If you press this knob when the arrow (b) is placed  
at the page title on the menu, the arrow changes to a  
question mark (?) and you can change the page by  
turning this knob.  
When the arrow mark is placed at a position other than  
the page title, you can change the setting of the current  
item by pressing and turning this knob.  
Turn: Turn this knob to change the page or change item  
settings.  
Closing the cover automatically sets this switch to OFF.  
ON: Displays the menu on the viewfinder screen or the test  
signal screen, at the last accessed page. When the  
menu is used for the first time, the first page is  
displayed.  
OFF: Removes the menu from the viewfinder screen or  
the test signal screen.  
d CANCEL/PRST (preset) / ESCAPE switch  
To enable this switch, set the MENU ON/OFF switch to  
ON.  
b STATUS ON/SEL / OFF (menu display on/page  
selection/display off) switch  
To enable this switch, set the MENU ON/OFF switch to  
OFF.  
Closing the cover automatically sets the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
Closing the cover automatically sets the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
CANCEL/PRST: Pushing this switch up to this position  
displays the message to confirm whether the previous  
settings are cancelled or settings are reset to their  
initial values, depending on the menu operating  
condition.  
ON/SEL: Each time this switch is pushed upward, a  
window to confirm the menu settings and status of the  
camcorder appears on the viewfinder screen. The  
window consists of three pages, which are switched  
each time the switch is pushed upward. Each page is  
displayed for about 10 seconds.  
Pushing this switch up to this position again cancels  
the previous settings or resets the settings to their  
initial values.  
OFF: To clear the page immediately after display, push  
this switch down to the OFF position.  
ESCAPE: Use this switch when the menu page, which has  
a hierarchical structure, is opened. Each time the  
switch is pushed to this position, the page returns to  
one stage higher in the hierarchy.  
You can select the pages to be displayed on the menu.  
32  
2-6 Menu Operating Section  
           
e “Memory Stick” compartment  
“Memory Stick”  
Access indicator  
Label  
“Memory Stick”  
How to insert a “Memory Stick”  
Open the lid of the menu operating section, and insert a  
“Memory Stick”, with the notch facing downward, in the  
direction shown by the arrow, so that it clicks into place.  
To remove a “Memory Stick”, first press it in to release the  
lock, then withdraw.  
The “Memory Stick” access indicator lights when the  
“Memory Stick” is being accessed (for reading or writing).  
For details about types of “Memory Stick”, see “About a  
Notes  
• Do not insert/remove a “Memory Stick” while the  
“Memory Stick” access indicator is lit or flashing. Doing  
so may cause a loss of data.  
• This device uses only a standard “Memory Stick”. It is  
not possible to use the type of “MagicGate Memory  
Stick” equipped with MagicGate copyright protection  
technology, or a “Memory Stick PRO”.  
2-6 Menu Operating Section  
33  
   
2-7 Time Code System  
1 TC IN connector  
2 TC OUT connector  
3 GENLOCK IN connector  
Time code functions (1)  
a TC IN (time code input) connector (BNC type)  
To synchronize the time code of this unit to an external  
time code, input the reference time code to this connector.  
b TC OUT (time code output) connector (BNC type)  
To synchronize the time code of an external VTR to that of  
the camcorder, connect this connector to the reference time  
code input connector of the external VTR.  
c GENLOCK IN connector (BNC type)  
• This connector inputs a reference signal when the  
camera is to be genlocked or when the time code is to be  
synchronized with external equipment. Use the  
MAINTENANCE menu to adjust the genlock H-phase  
(phase of horizontal sync signal) and the sub-carrier  
phase.  
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
• This connector also inputs a return video signal.  
You can display the return video signal in the viewfinder  
screen while holding the RET button down with  
“RETURN VIDEO” set to “ON” on the GENLOCK  
page of the OPERATION menu.  
• This connector also inputs an external analog composite  
video signal.  
When the CBK-SC01 extension board is installed, you  
can record the external analog composite video signal  
input to this connector.  
34  
2-7 Time Code System  
         
4 DISPLAY switch  
5 RESET button  
6 HOLD button  
THUMBNAIL  
SEL/SET  
S.SEL  
ESSENCE MARK  
SUB CLIP  
7 SEL/SET dial  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
8 PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK switch  
9 F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch  
Time code functions (2)  
d DISPLAY switch  
Turning the dial upward increases the value of the flashing  
digit, and turning it downward decreases the value.  
This cycles the data displayed in the counter display  
through the sequence COUNTER, TC, and U-BIT.  
COUNTER: Display the elapsed recording/playback time  
(hours, minutes, seconds, frames).  
h PRESET/REGEN (regeneration)/CLOCK switch  
This switch selects whether to set a new time code or to  
follow the already recorded time code.  
TC: Display time code.  
U-BIT: Display user bit data.  
PRESET: Records time code with a preset initial value.  
REGEN: Records time code continuous with the existing  
time code recorded on the disc. Regardless of the  
setting of the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch, the  
e RESET button  
camcorder operates in R-RUN mode.  
Pressing this button resets the time data displayed on the  
counter display section to “00:00:00:00” or the user bit  
data to “00000000.”  
CLOCK: Records time code synchronized to the internal  
clock. Regardless of the setting of the F-RUN/SET/R-  
RUN switch, the camcorder operates in F-RUN mode.  
f HOLD (display hold) button  
i F-RUN/SET/R-RUN (free run/set/recording run)  
switch  
This switch selects the operating mode for the internal time  
Pressing this button instantly freezes the time data  
displayed in the counter display section. (The time code  
generator continues running.) Pressing this button again  
releases the hold. You can use this button, for example, to  
determine the exact time of a particular shot.  
When the HOLD button is activated, the time data is  
displayed in the following format:  
code generator.  
F-RUN: Time code keeps advancing, regardless of the  
operating state of the VDR. Use this setting when  
aligning the time code with real time or when  
synchronizing the time code with an external time  
code.  
SET: Set the switch to this position to set the time code or  
user bits.  
R-RUN: The time code value advances only during  
recording. Use this setting to have a consecutive time  
code on the disc.  
For details of the counter display, see 2-9 “Warnings and  
g SEL/SET (select/set) dial  
To set a time code, user bit, or real time value, press this  
dial so that the digit you want to change flashes.  
2-7 Time Code System  
35  
         
2-8 Warnings and Indications  
Besides the viewfinder, speaker and earphones, the  
indicators and displays described in this section also  
provide you with information such as the operating state of  
the camcorder and warnings.  
1 Tally indicator  
2 DISPLAY switch  
3 TALLY switch  
4 Back tally indicator  
5 Back tally switch  
8 Color LCD  
9 WARNING indicator  
q; ACCESS indicator  
6 Monochrome LCD  
qa Rear tally indicator  
7 DISP SEL switch  
qs LCD switch  
Warning and indication functions  
a Tally indicator  
Note  
Setting the TALLY switch on the viewfinder to HIGH or  
LOW enables this indicator. It lights when the VDR starts  
recording. Like the REC indicator in the viewfinder, it also  
flashes to provide warnings. The brightness of this  
indicator when it is lit can be switched with the TALLY  
switch.  
Setting the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON displays the  
menu on the viewfinder screen even if the DISPLAY  
switch is set to OFF.  
c TALLY switch  
This switch controls the tally indicator as follows.  
HIGH: The tally indicator brightness is high.  
OFF: The tally indicator is disabled.  
LOW: The tally indicator brightness is low.  
b DISPLAY switch  
This switches the indications on the viewfinder screen on  
or off.  
ON: The indications appear on the viewfinder screen.  
OFF: The indications do not appear on the viewfinder  
screen.  
d Back tally indicator  
When the back tally switch is set to ON, this indicator has  
the same function as the tally indicator.  
36  
2-8 Warnings and Indications  
           
e Back tally switch  
This switch enables or disables the back tally and rear tally  
indicators.  
ON: The back tally and rear tally indicators are enabled.  
OFF: The back tally and rear tally indicators are disabled.  
f Monochrome LCD  
This shows the remaining battery capacity, remaining disc  
capacity, time data, and so on.  
g DISP SEL (display selection) switch  
This switches the display in the color LCD.  
CHAR: Display video with superimposed text. With the  
MENU ON/OFF switch set to OFF, also display  
camcorder status indications similar to those displayed  
MONI: Display video without superimposed text.  
STATUS: Display counter, warnings, and audio levels.  
h Color LCD  
This displays VDR-related warnings, remaining battery  
capacity, remaining disc capacity, audio levels, time data,  
and so on.  
i WARNING indicator  
This indicator lights up or flashes when there is a fault in  
the VDR.  
j ACCESS indicator  
This lights when data is written to or read from the disc.  
k Rear tally indicator  
When the back tally switch is set to ON, this indicator has  
the same function as the tally indicator.  
l LCD switch  
This controls the color LCD.  
OFF: The color LCD is turned off.  
L: The color LCD is adjusted for viewing indoors.  
H: The color LCD is adjusted for viewing outdoors.  
2-8 Warnings and Indications  
37  
               
2-9 Warnings and Indications on the LCDs  
2-9-1 Monochrome LCD  
Disc status and battery status  
Time code display  
Disc status indicator  
Lights when the time code or real time is  
displayed.  
Time counter display: Shows the time  
code, user bits, and real time.  
Full capacity is available.  
Close to full state: “DISC” flashes.  
Full (disc must be replaced):  
“DISC” and “E” flash.  
1)  
Lights when the HOLD button is pressed.  
1) When the HOLD button is pressed to hold the time code value,  
the time code is displayed in the format shown below. When  
the HOLD button is pressed again to release the hold, the time  
code is displayed in the normal format  
Battery status indicator  
Time code display on the monochrome LCD  
Fully charged  
Nearly dead: “BATT” flashes.  
Dead battery (battery must be  
charged): “BATT” and “E” flash.  
Display of remaining disc capacity and remaining battery capacity on  
the monochrome LCD  
38  
2-9 Warnings and Indications on the LCDs  
             
2-9-2 Color LCD  
Disc status, battery status and audio level  
VDR operation status and status  
indicators  
Disc status indicator  
Full capacity is available.  
Close to full state: “DISC” flashes.  
Full (disc must be replaced): “DISC” and “E” flash.  
Formats of video and audio  
signals to be redorded.  
Warning display area  
This shows a message if a recording fault or  
condensation is detected.  
Audio level meters  
VDR operation and status indicators on the color LCD  
Battery status indicator  
Fully charged  
Nearly dead: “BATT” flashes.  
Dead battery (battery must be charged): “BATT”  
and “E” flash.  
Display of remaining disc capacity, remaining battery capacity, and  
audio levels on the color LCD  
2-9 Warnings and Indications on the LCDs  
39  
           
Time code display  
2-10 Indicators in the  
Viewfinder  
Lights when VITC is selected for the time code.  
Lights in playback mode.  
Lights in non-drop frame  
mode. (PDW-510/530 only)  
Several indicators are provided above and below the  
viewfinder screen to indicate the current state and  
adjustments of the camera.  
Lights when the camcorder is  
synchronized with an external time code.  
1 TALLY indicator  
Lights when the time code  
generator is on hold.  
2 REC (recording) indicator  
3 BATT (battery) indicator  
Viewfinder screen  
4
(warning) indicator  
5 Spare indicator  
6 SAVE indicator  
1)  
Lights when the HOLD button is pressed  
Indicators on the viewfinder  
Lights when the time code or real time is displayed.  
a TALLY (green tallly) indicator  
This indicator lights when the camcorder is in Picture Cash  
mode. Also, this indicator lights when a green tally signal  
is received from the camera control unit.  
Time counter display: Shows the time code, user  
bit data, and real time.  
1) When the HOLD button is pressed to hold the time code value,  
the time code is displayed in the format shown below. When the  
HOLD button is pressed again to release the hold, the time code  
is displayed in the normal format.  
b REC (recording, red tally) indicator  
This indicator lights red when recording starts and remains  
lit during recording. It also lights when a red tally signal is  
received from the camera control unit and flashes to give a  
warning.  
Time code display on the color LCD  
c BATT (battery) indicator  
This indicator starts flashing when the battery connected to  
the camcorder is nearly exhausted, and stays lit when the  
battery is completely exhausted.  
The battery power level at which the indicator starts  
flashing can be set on the BATTERY page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu.  
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
d
(warning) indicator  
This indicator lights when any of the following conditions  
occurs with the corresponding item set to ON on the “!”  
LED page of the USER menu.  
• The gain is set to other than 0 dB.  
• The SHUTTER selector is set to ON.  
• The WHITE BAL switch is set to PRST.  
• ATW is enabled.  
40  
2-10 Indicators in the Viewfinder  
       
• The lens extender is used.  
• The FILTER selector is set to other than ND:1/CC:B.  
• The reference value of auto iris adjustment is not the  
standard value.  
e Spare indicator  
This is a spare indicator. A menu operation makes it  
possible to use this as a REC indicator.  
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
f SAVE indicator  
This indicator lights when the VDR SAVE/STBY switch  
is set to SAVE, putting the VDR into power save mode.  
2-10 Indicators in the Viewfinder  
41  
Recording and Playback  
3
Chapter  
• Do not leave cartridges where dust may be able to gain  
ingress.  
• Store cartridges in their cases.  
3-1 Handling Discs  
Care of the discs  
• Remove dust and dirt on the outside of a cartridge using  
a soft dry cloth.  
• If condensation forms, allow ample time to dry before  
use.  
3-1-1 Discs Used for Recording and  
Playback  
This camcorder uses the following disc for recording and  
playback:  
3-1-3 Write-Protecting Discs  
PFD23 Professional Disc (capacity 23.3 GB)  
To protect the content recorded on the disc from accidental  
erasure, move the write-protect tab on the lower surface of  
the disc in the direction of the arrow, as shown in the  
following figure.  
Note  
It is not possible to use the following discs for recording or  
playback:  
• Blu-ray Disc  
• Professional Disc for Data  
Lower surface of the disc  
Write-protect tab  
3-1-2 Notes on Handling  
Handling  
The Professional Disc is housed in a cartridge, and is  
designed to allow handling free of risk from dust or  
fingerprints. However, if the cartridge is subjected to a  
severe shock, for example by dropping it, this can result in  
damage or scratching of the disc. If the disc is scratched, it  
may be impossible to record video/audio, or to play back  
the content recorded on the disc. The discs should be  
handled and stored carefully.  
E
V
A
S
Slide in the direction of the arrow  
• Do not touch the surface of the disc itself within the  
cartridge.  
Write-protect tab settings  
• Deliberately opening the shutter may cause damage.  
• Do not disassemble the cartridge.  
SAVE  
SAVE  
Recording enabled  
Recording disabled  
• The supplied adhesive labels are recommended for  
indexing discs. Apply the label in the correct position.  
Storage  
• Do not store discs where they may be subjected to direct  
sunlight, or in other places where the temperature or  
humidity is high.  
42  
3-1 Handling Discs  
                       
3-1-4 Loading and Unloading a Disc  
Insert the disc.  
Loading a disc  
Proceed as follows.  
V indication on  
the outside  
1
Turn on the POWER switch.  
Push and  
close the lid.  
The disc is loaded.  
POWER switch  
HUMID indicator  
Note  
To insert the disc correctly, make sure that the  
camcorder is in the upright position (the grip upside,  
the bottom downside).  
Note  
Unloading a disc  
If there is condensation inside the VDR section, the  
message “HUMID” appears in the viewfinder screen  
and the color LCD. If this happens, wait until the  
indicator goes off before going on to step 2.  
With the power supply on, press the EJECT button to open  
the disc compartment lid and eject the disc. Then remove  
the disc. If you are not going to insert another disc, close  
the disc compartment lid.  
2
Press the EJECT button.  
Unloading a disc when the power supply is off  
If the battery is exhausted, it is not possible to remove the  
disc by pressing the EJECT button. In such cases, use the  
following emergency procedure to remove the disc  
manually.  
This opens the lid of the disc compartment.  
EJECT button  
1
2
Turn off the POWER switch.  
Carry out the operation shown in the following figure.  
Lid of the disc  
compartment  
3
Insert the disc in the V direction, and close the disc  
compartment lid manually.  
3-1 Handling Discs  
43  
   
1 Open this rubber cover.  
2 Using a screwdriver or  
similar implement, slide  
the black metal plate  
visible inside, in the  
direction of the rear of the  
camcorder.  
The disc compartment lid  
opens. A red Phillips  
screw is visible inside the  
rubber cap.  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“MAINTENANCE”, and press the MENU knob.  
3 Insert a screwdriver into  
the Phillips screw, and  
turn counterclockwise  
(the direction shown on  
the rubber cap).  
This ejects the disc.  
4 Close the rubber cover  
firmly.  
If this is the first time the MAINTENANCE menu has  
been displayed, the CONTENTS page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu appears. If the menu has been  
used before, the last accessed page appears.  
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “DISC”, and press the  
MENU knob to display the DISC page.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the DISC page appears, then press the MENU  
knob to select the page.  
M19 DISC  
TOP  
DELETE LAST CLIP:  
DELETE ALL CLIPS:  
EXEC  
EXEC  
QUICK FORMAT  
:
EXEC  
Unloading a disc manually when the power supply is off  
You need not return the screw to its original position after  
taking out the disc. Turning on the power makes the disc  
compartment mechanism operable again.  
4
5
Press the MENU knob, then turn it to move the b mark  
to “QUICK FORMAT”, and press the MENU knob  
again.  
3-1-5 Formatting a Disc  
The message “EXECUTE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
Using a new disc  
An unused disc requires no formatting operation. The disc  
is automatically formatted so that it is ready to use when  
loaded into this unit.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “YES”,  
and press the MENU knob again.  
Formatting is completed and the message  
“COMPLETE” appears.  
Using a disc on which material is recorded  
To format a recorded disc, load the disc into the unit then  
do as follows.  
3-1-6 Handling of Discs When  
Recording Does Not End  
Normally (Salvage Function)  
Note  
Recording processing does not end normally if, for  
example, the battery pack is removed during recording, or  
if the power cord is disconnected during recording.  
Because the file system is not updated, video and audio  
data recorded in real time is not recognized as files and clip  
contents recorded up to that point are lost.  
When a recorded disc is formatted, all the data on the disc  
is erased.  
1
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch from OFF to ON.  
The TOP menu appears.  
44  
3-1 Handling Discs  
         
However, this unit has a salvage function which can hold  
losses to the minimum by reconstructing clips on such  
discs.  
Note that no recorded clip contents are lost when the  
POWER switch is turned off and when battery exhaustion  
is detected, because the unit does not enter power saving  
mode until after the end of recording processing.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to YES,  
then press the MENU knob.  
Salvage processing starts, and the message  
“EXECUTING.” appears.  
A results message appears when the processing  
finishes.  
• If the salvage succeeded, the message  
“COMPLETED.” appears.  
• If the salvage failed, the message  
“INCOMPLETED.” appears. Clips for which  
recording did not end normally are lost.  
Notes  
• Do not disconnect the battery pack or power cord until  
recording processing has finished and the ACCESS  
indicator has gone out.  
• This function salvages as much recorded material as  
possible after an unforeseen accident, but 100%  
restoration cannot be guaranteed.  
• Even when this function is used, it is not possible to  
recover data from immediately before the interruption of  
recording. The amount of data lost is as follows.  
- Quick salvage: From 2 to 4 seconds of data before the  
interruption of recording.  
To exit without salvaging  
Select NO in step 2 to exit without performing salvage  
processing.  
However, the status of the disc does not change. Salvage is  
still required to recover the clips for which recording did  
not end normally. The salvage message will appear again  
when that disc is inserted again, or when the camcorder is  
powered on again.  
- Full salvage: From 4 to 6 seconds of data before the  
interruption of recording.  
More data may be lost when functions such as Picture  
Cache and Interval Rec are being used.  
Note  
If salvage processing is not done, sections which were  
recorded normally can be played back, but no new  
recording can be done on the disc.  
Quick salvage  
When the unit is powered on again after a recording  
interruption due to a power interruption, with the disc still  
loaded in the unit, clips are reconstructed on the basis of  
backup data stored in nonvolatile memory and markers  
recorded on the disc.  
Processing time is about 5 seconds.  
Full salvage  
When recording on an XDCAM device is interrupted  
because of a power interruption, and a disc is manually  
ejected from that device with the power off, clips are  
reconstructed on the basis of markers recorded on the disc  
when the disc is loaded in this unit. Therefore, processing  
takes longer than for a quick salvage (about 30 seconds,  
although it depends on the state of the disc).  
Proceed as follows to perform a full salvage.  
1
Insert the disc on which recording did not end  
normally.  
The following salvage message appears.  
SALVAGE  
TO RECORD ON THE  
DISC, IT IS NECESSARY  
TO EXECUTE SALVAGE.  
SALVAGE OK?  
YES NO  
3-1 Handling Discs  
45  
   
1
Attach a fully charged battery pack.  
Turn on the POWER switch.  
3-2 Recording  
2
3
3-2-1 Basic Procedures  
Set the DISP SEL switch to STATUS, and check on  
the color LCD that the following conditions are met.  
This section describes the basic procedures for shooting  
and recording.  
Before a shooting session, ensure that the camcorder is  
functioning properly.  
• The HUMID indicator is not showing.  
If it is, wait until it disappears.  
• The battery status indicator (x) shows at least five  
segments.  
If it does not, replace the battery pack with a fully  
charged one.  
Recording format settings (PDW-530/530P  
only)  
With the PDW-530/530P you can select the recording  
formats for each of video and audio.  
Note that it is not possible to use different recording  
formats on a single disc.  
4
5
Check that there are no obstructions such as cables  
near the disc compartment lid. Then press the EJECT  
button to open the disc compartment lid.  
After checking that the disc is not write-protected (see  
page 42), load it and close the disc compartment lid.  
Be sure to select the same format as the existing recording  
if you use a disc on which material is recorded, or  
otherwise use a different disc.  
Basic procedure for shooting: from  
adjusting the black balance and white  
balance to stopping recording  
For details of the setting operations, see 5-1-1 “Setting the  
Switch settings  
After turning on the power and loading a disc, set the  
switches and selectors as shown below and begin  
operation.  
Thumbnail image setting  
As required, you can select the frame to display as the  
thumbnail image of a clip.  
(The factory default setting is to display the first frame in  
the clip as the thumbnail image.)  
DISPLAY: ON  
AUDIO SELECT  
CH-1/CH-2: AUTO  
more information about how to make this setting.  
Iris: Automatic  
Zoom: Automatic  
Basic procedure for shooting: from turning  
on the camcorder to loading a disc  
OUTPUT/DCC: CAM, DCC ON  
Proceed as follows.  
F-RUN/SET/R-RUN: F-RUN or R-RUN  
(set as needed)  
4
5
1
Switch and selector settings before shooting  
Shooting  
Proceed as follows.  
3
2
Basic procedure for shooting: from power supply to disc loading  
46  
3-2 Recording  
                 
1,2  
2
3,5  
During recording, the REC indicator lights in the  
viewfinder. Perform zooming and focus control, if  
necessary.  
Note  
During recording (while the ACCESS indicator is lit)  
do not remove the battery pack. If you do, the internal  
processing for recording may not finish properly,  
which may cause the last few seconds of recording to  
be lost.  
4
5,6  
Basic procedure for shooting: from adjusting the black balance and  
white balance to stopping recording  
1
Push the AUTO W/B BAL switch to BLK to adjust the  
black balance.  
6
7
To stop recording, press the REC START button or the  
VTR button on the lens again.  
For details of black balance adjustment, see 5-2-1  
The REC indicator in the viewfinder goes off.  
The material recorded from step 5 to step 6 is saved as  
a single clip.  
2
Select the CC filter and ND filter to match the lighting  
conditions, and adjust the white balance.  
When the white balance settings are already in  
memory  
Set the WHITE BAL switch to A or B.  
To play back the recorded clip  
Press the PREV button, then press the PLAY/PAUSE  
button to play from the beginning of the clip.  
When the white balance setting is not in memory  
and you do not have enough time to adjust the  
white balance  
Set the WHITE BAL switch to PRST.  
This automatically adjusts the white balance as  
follows, depending on the setting of the FILTER knob.  
• For the PDW-530/530P:  
Repeat steps 5 and 6 as required for shooting.  
Each time you repeat steps 5 and 6 , successive clips  
are recorded on the disc.  
Clip 1  
Clip 2  
Clip 3  
B: 3200 K, C: 4300 K, D: 6300 K  
• For the PDW-510/510P:  
1: 3200 K, 3: 5600 K  
REC  
START  
REC REC  
STOP START  
REC REC  
STOP START  
REC  
STOP  
Notes  
3
4
Aim the camera at the subject and adjust the focus and  
zoom.  
• It is not possible to record a clip shorter than 2 seconds.  
If you stop recording within 2 seconds of starting, this  
results in a 2-second clip.  
If you stop recording and restart within 2 seconds of the  
original start, this creates a single continuous clip from  
the original start time.  
If necessary, set the electronic shutter for an  
appropriate mode and speed.  
• The maximum number of clips that can be recorded on a  
single disc is 300. If an attempt is made to record more  
than 300 clips, the error message “DISC FULL!”  
appears, even if there is free capacity on the disc.  
5
To start recording, press the REC START button or  
the VTR button on the lens.  
Playback control buttons  
If the recording start/stop function is assigned to the  
ASSIGN 1/3/4 switch, this switch functions as REC  
START button.  
During recording, the playback control buttons (EJECT, F  
REV, F FWD, NEXT, PREV, PLAY/PAUSE, STOP)  
have no effect.  
3-2 Recording  
47  
6
By repeating steps 4 and 5, you can delete a number of  
clips in sequence from the last recorded clip.  
3-2-2 Deleting Clips  
With this camcorder you can delete clips one at a time, in  
sequence from the last recorded clip, or you can delete all  
clips in a single operation.  
Clip 1  
Clip 2  
Clip 3  
To delete the last recorded clip  
Clips can be deleted in the sequence 3 t 2 t 1.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch from OFF to ON.  
To delete all clips within the disc  
Proceed as follows.  
The TOP menu appears.  
1
On the DISC page (see the previous item), move the b  
mark to “DELETE ALL CLIPS”, and press the MENU  
knob.  
The message “EXECUTE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
2
To execute deleting, turn the MENU knob to move the  
b mark to “YES”, and press the MENU knob.  
This deletes all clips within the disc.  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“MAINTENANCE”, and press the MENU knob.  
3-2-3 Recording Essence Marks  
If this is the first time the MAINTENANCE menu has  
been displayed, the CONTENTS page of the menu  
appears. If the menu has been used before, the last  
accessed page appears.  
Shot marks and other essence marks can be recorded on the  
disc.  
Recording essence marks for scenes containing important  
images and sounds enables quick access to the marked  
points. This increases editing efficiency.  
Some essence marks are recorded automatically, for  
example when recording starts and when the flash  
operates. Others are recorded manually.  
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “DISC”, and press the  
MENU knob.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the DISC page appears, then press the MENU  
knob to select the page.  
To specify essence marks to be recorded on the  
disc  
Proceed as follows.  
M19 DISC  
TOP  
DELETE LAST CLIP:  
DELETE ALL CLIPS:  
EXEC  
EXEC  
QUICK FORMAT  
:
EXEC  
MENU knob  
MENU ON/OFF  
switch  
4
5
Press the MENU knob, then turn it to move the b mark  
to “DELETE LAST CLIP”, and press the MENU knob  
again.  
1
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch from OFF to ON.  
The message “EXECUTE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
The TOP menu appears.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “YES”,  
and press the MENU knob again.  
The last recorded clip is deleted.  
48  
3-2 Recording  
             
M10 ESSENCE MARK  
TOP  
SHOT MARK 1  
SHOT MARK 2  
:
:
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
10  
OVER AUDIO LIMIT :  
GAIN CHG. MARK  
FILTER CHG. MARK :  
SHUTTER CHG. MARK:  
WHITE CHG. MARK  
FLASH MARK  
FLASH MARK LEVEL :  
INDEX PIC. POS.  
:
:
:
:
0SEC  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
6
7
Press the MENU knob.  
“MAINTENANCE”.  
The b mark to the left of “SHOT MARK 1” changes  
to a z mark and the z mark to the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
Press the MENU knob.  
If this is the first time the MAINTENANCE menu has  
been displayed, the CONTENTS page of the menu  
appears. If the menu has been used before, the last  
accessed page appears.  
If you want to record the essence mark, turn the  
MENU knob to display “ON”. If you do not want to  
record it, turn the MENU knob to display “OFF”.  
4
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “ESSENCE MARK”,  
then press the MENU knob.  
8
9
Press the MENU knob.  
Repeat steps 5 to 8 to set the remaining essence marks.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the ESSENCE page appears, then press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
10When FLASH MARK is “ON”, use the FLASH  
MARK LEVEL item to set the threshold brightness  
value (in the range 1 to 20) for essence mark  
recording.  
?M10 ESSENCE MARK  
TOP  
SHOT MARK 1  
SHOT MARK 2  
:
:
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
10  
11Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF to end the  
OVER AUDIO LIMIT :  
GAIN CHG. MARK  
FILTER CHG. MARK :  
SHUTTER CHG. MARK:  
WHITE CHG. MARK  
FLASH MARK  
FLASH MARK LEVEL :  
INDEX PIC. POS.  
menu operation.  
:
Recording a SHOT MARK 1 essence mark  
Press the RET button once.  
“ShotMark1” appears on the viewfinder screen for about  
one second near the time code display.  
:
:
:
0SEC  
If SHOT MARK 1 recording has been assigned to one of  
the assignable switches, you can also use that switch to  
record a SHOT MARK 1 essence mark.  
The items show the following types of essence marks.  
SHOT MARK 1/2: Recorded manually.  
OVER AUDIO LIMIT: Recorded when the audio  
level exceeds 0 dBFS.  
4 Switches” (page 125) for more information about how to  
make assignments.  
GAIN CHG. MARK: Recorded when the gain value  
is changed.  
FILTER CHG. MARK: Recorded when the filter is  
changed.  
SHUTTER CHG. MARK: Recorded when the  
shutter speed is changed.  
WHITE CHG. MARK: Recorded when the white  
balance is changed.  
FLASH MARK: Recorded when a sudden brightness  
change occurs as when the flash operates or when  
the camcorder in recording mode is suddenly  
moved into an indoor space from a bright outdoor  
space.  
Note  
The lens RET button cannot be used to record SHOT  
MARK 1 or SHOT MARK 2 essence marks if the  
camcorder has been set up to allow you to check return  
video signals in the viewfinder (see page 121).  
Recording a SHOT MARK 2 essence mark  
Press the RET button twice in quick succession during  
recording or playback.  
“ShotMark2” appears in the viewfinder screen for about  
one second near the time code display.  
If SHOT MARK 2 recording has been assigned to one of  
the assignable switches, you can also use that switch to  
record a SHOT MARK 2 essence mark.  
5
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “SHOT  
MARK 1”.  
3-2 Recording  
49  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob until the FUNCTION 1 page  
appears.  
3-2-4 Starting a Shoot with a Few  
Seconds of Pre-Stored Picture  
Data (Picture Cache Function)  
? 03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
The camcorder has a large capacity internal memory, in  
which you can cache the last few seconds (maximum 12  
seconds) of captured video and audio, so that recording  
starts from a point just before you press the REC START  
button or VTR button on the lens.  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
OFF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC:  
Setting the Picture Cache time/Picture  
Cache mode  
To record in Picture Cache mode, you need to turn on  
Picture Cache mode and set the picture data storage time  
(Picture Cache time) using the USER menu.  
Press the MENU knob.  
A b mark appears on the left of the currently selected  
item and a z mark appears on the left of the setting.  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
The Picture Cache time determines the number of seconds  
recorded from the Picture Cache, counting back from the  
time when you press the REC START button or the VTR  
button on the lens to start recording. However, the number  
of seconds actually recorded from the Picture Cache may  
be shorter immediately after the setting of the VDR SAVE/  
STBY switch is changed, and in the special situations  
explained in the following notes.  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
OFF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC:  
4
5
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“CACHE/INTVAL REC”.  
Notes  
Press the MENU knob.  
• The contents of picture cache memory are unstable for a  
short time immediately after you select Picture Cache  
mode or change the Picture Cache time. Therefore, if  
you put the unit into recording mode by pressing the  
REC START button or the VTR button on the lens  
immediately after such operation, pictures just before  
such operation cannot be recorded.  
• During playback or recording review, no data is saved to  
the picture cache memory. Thus it is not possible to use  
this function to rerecord the last few seconds of material  
from playback or recording review.  
The b mark on the left of “CACHE/INTVAL REC”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
OFF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC:  
To turn Picture Cache mode on, proceed as follows.  
6
Turn the MENU knob until “CACHE” appears.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the setting changes in  
the following sequence: OFF y CACHE y A. INT  
y M. INT.  
When “CACHE” appears, the camcorder is in Picture  
Cache mode, where picture, sound, and time code are  
constantly saved in memory. The TALLY indicator  
(green) is on while picture data is being stored in  
memory.  
MENU knob  
MENU ON/OFF  
switch  
1
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
50  
3-2 Recording  
     
For detailed information on the ASSIGN 1/2/3/4 switches,  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
Notes  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: CACHE  
CACHE REC TIME 0-2s  
• You can change the Picture Cache mode menu settings  
while recording; any changes that you make, however,  
do not take effect until after the recording operation is  
completed.  
:
• In Picture Cache mode, the internal time code generator  
operating mode is always F-RUN regardless of the  
setting of the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch.  
7
8
Press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
Camcorder operations in Picture Cache mode  
The recording procedure in Picture Cache time is basically  
the same as that for normal recording. However, note the  
following differences.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the bmark to “CACHE  
REC TIME”.  
• When you record in Picture Cache mode, the picture you  
are shooting now is recorded to disc after the picture data  
stored in memory (equal to the Picture Cache time) is  
recorded to disc. For this reason, disc access may  
continue for a short time after you press the REC  
START button to stop recording. During this time, the  
playback control buttons are disabled, as in recording  
mode. Also, if you press the REC START button or the  
VTR button on the lens to restart recording during this  
time, a separate clip is recorded.  
• When you press the REC START button or the VTR  
button on the lens to restart recording during disc access,  
the start point of the recorded clip may be later than the  
Picture Cache time, especially when there are a large  
number of clips recorded on the disc. In Picture Cache  
mode, you should avoid stop and start recording  
operations in quick succession.  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: CACHE  
CACHE REC TIME 0-2s  
:
9
Press the MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of “CACHE REC TIME”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
10Turn the MENU knob until the desired Picture Cache  
time appears.  
• The time disc access stops after the REC START button  
is pressed equals the Picture Cache time. However, if  
you start recording within the Picture Cache time  
immediately after selecting Picture Cache mode,  
changing the Picture Cache time or performing playback  
or recording review, the picture data for the duration of  
the Picture Cache time will not be stored in memory.  
Thus, the time disc access stops after the STOP button is  
pressed becomes shorter than the Picture Cache time.  
• In Picture Cache mode, time code setting cannot be  
made by setting the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to SET.  
To make time code settings, first exit Picture Cache  
mode.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the Picture Cache time  
changes in the following sequence: 0-2s y 2-4s y  
4-6s y 6-8s y 8-10s y 10-12s.  
11Press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
12To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
The menu disappears, and the display indicating the  
current status of the camcorder appears along the top  
and bottom of the screen.  
When power is lost during recording  
• When the power is turned off during recording, the  
camcorder will switch itself off after disc access has  
continued for a few seconds to record the picture in the  
instant of power off.  
• If you remove the battery, pull out the DC cable, or cut  
power to the AC adaptor during recording, video and  
audio stored in memory will be lost without being  
recorded to the disc. For this reason, make sure you do  
not change the battery while recording.  
Settings made in Picture Cache mode are maintained until  
changed.  
You can turn Picture Cache mode on and off by assigning  
the Picture Cache ON/OFF function to one of the  
assignable switches (ASSIGN 1/2/3/4 and TURBO GAIN  
buttons), and pressing the switch.  
3-2 Recording  
51  
3-2-5 Time-Lapse Video (Interval  
Rec Function)  
Using the memory in the camcorder, you can capture time-  
lapse video. There are two modes for this function, which  
is known as “Interval Rec.”  
Auto Interval Rec mode  
In Auto Interval Rec mode, pictures are automatically  
shot a frame at a time at the specified interval and stored  
in memory. To use this function you must set the total  
time for shooting (TAKE TOTAL TIME) and the length  
of time for recording on the disc (REC TIME).  
Manual Interval Rec mode  
A specified number of frames (NUMBER OF FRAME)  
is recorded when you press the REC START button or  
the lens VTR button.  
MENU ON/OFF switch  
MENU knob  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob until the FUNCTION 1 page  
appears.  
There are two Manual Interval Rec modes: a single shot  
mode in which recording is done once with each press of  
the button, and a consecutive mode in which recording is  
done repeatedly at a specified interval after the button is  
pressed.  
? 03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
OFF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC:  
A pre-lighting function is available in Auto Interval Rec  
mode and the consecutive mode of Manual Interval Rec  
mode. This function automatically turns on the light before  
recording starts, which allows you to record pictures under  
stable light and color temperature conditions.  
3
Press the MENU knob.  
A b mark appears on the left of the currently selected  
Note  
item and a z mark appears on the left of the setting.  
The camcorder cannot be put into Interval Rec mode when  
the scanning mode is 24P (with the CBK-FC01 expansion  
board (see page 130) installed).  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
Auto Interval Rec mode settings and  
shooting  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
OFF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC:  
To make settings before shooting  
To record in Auto Interval Rec mode, you need to turn on  
Auto Interval Rec and set the total time from start to finish  
of shooting (TAKE TOTAL TIME) and the length of time  
for recording on the disc (REC TIME), using the USER  
menu.  
4
5
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“CACHE/INTVAL REC”.  
Press the MENU knob.  
Notes  
The b mark on the left of “CACHE/INTVAL REC”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
• To make settings for Auto Interval Rec mode, set  
“TAKE TOTAL TIME” first, then “REC TIME”.  
• To turn on the light automatically before starting to  
record, set the LIGHT switch to AUTO.  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
To turn on Auto Interval Rec mode, proceed as follows.  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
OFF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC:  
52  
3-2 Recording  
             
6
Turn the MENU knob until A. INT appears.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the setting changes in  
the following sequence: OFF y CACHE y A. INT  
y M. INT.  
When A. INT appears, the camcorder is in Auto  
Interval Rec mode. The TALLY indicator (green) in  
the viewfinder flashes (one flash/second) while the  
camcorder is in this mode. Also, TAKE TOTAL  
TIME, REC TIME and PRE-LIGHTING appear.  
12Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “REC  
TIME”.  
? 03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
DF/NDF  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: A.INT  
TAKE TOTAL TIME :  
:
20M  
5SEC  
OFF  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
REC TIME  
PRE-LIGHTING  
:
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: A.INT  
13Press the MENU knob.  
TAKE TOTAL TIME :  
:
5MIN  
5SEC  
OFF  
REC TIME  
PRE-LIGHTING  
:
The b mark on the left of “REC TIME” changes to a  
z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
7
8
Press the MENU knob.  
14Turn the MENU knob until the desired time to be  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
recorded on the disc appears.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the setting of REC  
TIME changes in the following sequence: 5SEC y  
10SEC y 15SEC y 20SEC y 30SEC y  
40SEC y 50SEC y 1MIN y 2MIN y  
.......85MIN.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “TAKE  
? 03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
Here SEC means seconds (5SEC is 5 seconds) and  
MIN means minutes (1MIN is one minute).  
You cannot set a REC TIME that is more than one  
thirtieth of TAKE TOTAL TIME.  
For example: When TAKE TOTAL TIME is set to 1H,  
the maximum value of REC TIME is 2 MIN. (60  
minutes divided by 30 gives 2 minutes.)  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: A.INT  
TAKE TOTAL TIME :  
:
5MIN  
5SEC  
OFF  
REC TIME  
PRE-LIGHTING  
:
9
Press the MENU knob.  
15Press the MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of “TAKE TOTAL TIME”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
16Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “PRE-  
10Turn the MENU knob until the desired setting of  
LIGHTING”.  
“TAKE TOTAL TIME” appears.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the setting of TAKE  
TOTAL TIME changes in the following sequence:  
5MIN y 10MIN y 15MIN y 20MIN y  
30MIN y 40MIN y 50MIN y 1H y 2H y  
3H y 4H y 5H y 7H y 10H y 15H y 20H  
y 30H y 40H y 50H y 70H y 100H.  
? 03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: A.INT  
TAKE TOTAL TIME :  
:
20M  
5SEC  
OFF  
REC TIME  
PRE-LIGHTING  
:
Here MIN means minutes (5MIN is 5 minutes) and H  
means hours (1H is one hour).  
17Press the MENU knob.  
11Press the MENU knob.  
3-2 Recording  
53  
The b mark on the left of “PRE-LIGHTING” changes  
to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
The actual recording to disc begins when the  
camcorder has saved about ten seconds of video in  
memory, so disc access is intermittent.  
While recording in Auto Interval Rec mode, the  
TALLY indicator (green) in the viewfinder flashes (4  
flashes/second) and the message “AUTO INTERVAL  
**M**S” flashes on the viewfinder screen.  
When the camcorder is capturing the picture in  
memory, the REC indicator (red) in the viewfinder  
lights.  
18Turn the MENU knob until the desired time to turn on  
the light before starting to record appears.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the PRE-LIGHTING  
time changes in the following sequence: OFF y  
2SEC y 5SEC y 10SEC.  
After the length of time for recording on the disc (REC  
TIME) has elapsed, the camcorder automatically stops  
recording.  
Notes  
• Set the LIGHT switch on the camcorder to AUTO to  
turn on the light before recording.  
The light switch must also be set to ON. With these  
settings, the light turns on and off automatically.  
(However, the light remains on continuously if the  
off time is less than 5 seconds.)  
• When the LIGHT switch is set to MANUAL and the  
light switch is set to ON, the light remains on  
continuously.  
To continue auto interval recording  
Press the REC START button on the camcorder or the  
VTR button on the lens again.  
The camcorder starts recording in Auto Interval Rec mode  
again.  
To interrupt auto interval recording  
Press the REC START button or the VTR button on the  
lens. The camcorder stops recording.  
However, disc access may occur for recording picture data  
already stored in memory.  
19Press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
To end auto interval recording  
You can exit Auto Interval Rec mode using the following  
two methods:  
• Set the POWER switch to OFF.  
• Set CACHE/INTVAL REC to OFF on the FUNCTION  
1 page.  
20To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
The menu disappears from the screen and the message  
“AUTO INTERVAL **M**S” indicating Auto  
Interval Rec mode appears along the bottom of the  
screen.  
“**M**S” indicates the shooting interval. For  
example, the message “AUTO INTERVAL 00M04S”  
indicates that the shooting interval is four seconds.  
Time required for shooting and time required for  
recording on the disc  
Auto Interval Rec mode is effective for shooting objects  
that move very slowly. To use this function, you need to  
set the total time for shooting (TAKE TOTAL TIME) and  
the length of time for recording on the disc (REC TIME).  
The time required for shooting is the time required to  
capture the very slowly moving subject, and the camcorder  
must be arranged so that during this time the subject is  
always in the frame.  
Note  
The camcorder exits Auto Interval Rec mode whenever it  
is powered off. However, the TAKE TOTAL TIME and  
REC TIME settings are maintained. You do not need to set  
them again the next time you use Auto Interval Rec mode.  
The disc recording time indicates the running time of the  
completed recording. The camcorder calculates the time-  
lapse interval from these two times.  
To shoot and record in Auto Interval Rec mode  
Proceed as follows.  
Total time for shooting (TAKE TOTAL TIME)  
Shooting interval  
1
2
After performing the basic procedures for shooting  
and recording, following the instructions in 3-2-1  
“Basic Procedures” (page 46), secure the camcorder  
so that it will not move.  
Press the REC START button on the camcorder or the  
VTR button on the lens.  
The camcorder starts recording in Auto Interval Rec  
mode. When you use the PRE-LIGHTING function,  
recording starts after the light is switched on.  
Time for recording on the disc (REC TIME)  
54  
3-2 Recording  
     
Notes on Auto Interval Rec mode  
Note the following points.  
1
2
Carry out steps 1 to 5 of the procedure “To make  
INTVAL REC on the FUNCTION 1 page.  
i.LINK  
During interval recording, signal input/output through the  
i.LINK interface is impossible.  
Turn the MENU knob until “M. INT” appears.  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
Time code  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
In Auto Interval Rec mode, the internal time code  
generator runs in R-RUN mode regardless of how the F-  
RUN/SET/R-RUN switch is set.  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC:? M.INT  
NUMBER OF FRAME :  
TRIGGER INTERVAL:  
PRE-LIGHTING  
1
1SEC  
OFF  
Audio  
:
Audio signals are not recorded in Auto Interval Rec mode.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the setting changes in  
the following sequence: OFF y CACHE y A. INT  
y M. INT.  
Playback control buttons  
While recording in Auto Interval Rec mode, you cannot  
use the playback control buttons (EJECT, F REV, F FWD,  
NEXT, PREV, PLAY/PAUSE and STOP). To use these  
buttons, stop recording by pressing the REC START  
button or the VTR button on the lens.  
When M. INT appears, the camcorder is in Manual  
Interval Rec mode and the TALLY indicator (green) in  
the viewfinder flashes. “NUMBER OF FRAME” and  
“TRIGGER INTERVAL” appear. When TRIGGER  
INTERVAL is set to other than “M”, “PRE-  
LIGHTING” also appears.  
Menu operation  
While recording in Auto Interval Rec mode, you cannot  
change the settings of CACHE/INTVAL REC, TAKE  
TOTAL TIME and REC TIME. To change the settings,  
stop recording by pressing the REC START button or the  
VTR button on the lens.  
3
4
Press the MENU knob.  
The z mark on the left of “CACHE/INTVAL REC”  
changes to a b mark and the ? mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a z mark.  
When the camcorder power is switched off during  
recording in Auto Interval Rec mode  
• When you set the POWER switch to OFF, the camcorder  
will switch off by itself after disc access has continued  
for a few seconds to record the picture data stored in  
memory.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“NUMBER OF FRAME”.  
• If you remove the battery, unplug the DC cable, or cut  
power to the AC adaptor during auto interval recording,  
picture data stored before recording stops (a maximum  
of ten seconds) may be lost. Take care when changing  
the battery.  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: M.INT  
NUMBER OF FRAME :  
TRIGGER INTERVAL:  
1
1SEC  
OFF  
PRE-LIGHTING  
:
Manual Interval Rec mode settings and  
shooting  
Manual Interval Rec has the following two modes.  
Single shot mode: Each time the REC START button or  
VTR button on the lens is pressed, the camcorder  
captures to memory a single shot consisting of the  
specified number of video frames.  
Consecutive mode: Once the REC START button or VTR  
button on the lens is pressed, the camcorder captures  
consecutive shots to memory at the specified interval,  
with each shot consisting of the specified number of  
video frames.  
5
6
7
Press the MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of “NUMBER OF FRAME”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
Turn the MENU knob until the desired number of  
frames to be recorded in each shot appears.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the number changes in  
the following sequence: 1 y 2 y 4 y 8.  
To make settings before shooting  
Proceed as follows.  
Press the MENU knob.  
3-2 Recording  
55  
   
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
The b mark to the left of “PRE-LIGHTING” changes  
to a z mark, and the z mark to the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
8
9
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“TRIGGER INTERVAL”.  
14Turn the MENU knob to display the length of time to  
light before recording.  
Press the MENU knob.  
The setting changes in the following sequence: OFF  
The b mark on the left of “TRIGGER INTERVAL”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
y 2SEC y 5SEC y 10SEC.  
Notes  
• Set the LIGHT switch on the camcorder to AUTO to  
turn on the light before recording.  
The light switch must also be set to ON. With these  
settings, the light turns on and off automatically.  
However, the light remains on continuously if the  
off time is less than 5 seconds.  
• When the LIGHT switch is set to MANUAL and the  
light switch is set to ON, the light remains on  
continuously.  
10Turn the Menu knob to select the desired Manual  
Interval Rec mode.  
• To select the single shot mode (recording only one  
shot after one operation), set “TRIGGER  
INTERVAL” to “M”. In the viewfinder, the TALLY  
indicator (green) flashes twice per second.  
• To select the consecutive mode (recording shots  
repeatedly after one operation), set “TRIGGER  
INTERVAL” to the desired length of interval. In the  
viewfinder, the TALLY indicator (green) flashes  
once per second.  
15Press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
16To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
DF/NDF  
The menu disappears from the viewfinder screen and  
the following message appears along the bottom of the  
screen, indicating the current Manual Interval Rec  
mode.  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: M.INT  
NUMBER OF FRAME :  
TRIGGER INTERVAL:  
PRE-LIGHTING  
2
2SEC  
OFF  
:
In single shot mode: MANU INTERVAL *FRAME  
In consecutive mode: MANU INTERVAL *SEC  
*FRAME  
“*FRAME” means the number of frames and “*SEC”,  
the length of interval for the consecutive mode.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the setting changes in  
the following sequence: M y 1SEC y  
2SEC........12H y 24H.  
11Press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
Note  
The camcorder exits Manual Interval Rec mode whenever  
it is powered off. However, the NUMBER OF FRAME,  
TRIGGER INTERVAL and PRE-LIGHTING settings are  
maintained. You do not need to set them again the next  
time you use Manual Interval Rec mode.  
12If you selected the consecutive mode in step 10  
(anything other than “M”), turn the MENU knob to  
move the b mark to “PRE-LIGHTING”.  
To shoot and record in Manual Interval Rec mode  
03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
After making the required settings, proceed as follows.  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
1
2
After performing the basic procedure for shooting and  
recording following the instructions in 3-2-1 “Basic  
Procedures” (page 46), secure the camcorder so that it  
will not move.  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC: S.INT  
NUMBER OF FRAME :  
TRIGGER INTERVAL:  
2
1SEC  
OFF  
PRE-LIGHTING  
:
Press the REC START button on the camcorder or the  
VTR button on the lens.  
13Press the MENU knob.  
56  
3-2 Recording  
The camcorder starts recording in Manual Interval Rec  
mode. In the viewfinder, “MANU INTERVAL  
*FRAME” and the TALLY indicator (green) flash.  
• In the single shot mode, the TALLY indicator  
flashes twice per second.  
TRIGGER INTERVAL on the FUNCTION 1 page. To  
change these settings, stop recording by pressing the REC  
START button or the VTR button on the lens.  
When the camcorder power is switched off during  
recording in Manual Interval Rec mode  
• When you set the POWER switch to OFF, the camcorder  
will switch off by itself after disc access has continued  
for a few seconds to record the picture data stored in  
memory.  
• If you remove the battery, unplug the DC cable, or cut  
the power to the AC adaptor during manual interval  
recording, picture data stored before recording stops (a  
maximum of ten seconds) may be lost. Take care when  
changing the battery.  
• In the consecutive mode, the TALLY indicator  
flashes four times per second.  
To exit Manual Interval Rec mode  
Do one of the following.  
• In the single shot mode, press the EJECT button.  
• In the consecutive mode, press the camcorder REC  
START button or the lens VTR button to stop recording.  
• Set the camcorder POWER switch to OFF.  
After the camcorder has exited from Manual Interval Rec  
mode, it records picture data stored in memory to the disc.  
Notes on Manual Interval Rec mode  
Take note of the following points.  
3-2-6 Retaking the Most Recent Clip  
A retake function is available, making it easy to erase and  
retake the most recently recorded clip.  
To use the retake function, you need use the FUNCTION  
1 menu to assign it to one of the assignable switches  
(ASSIGN 1, ASSIGN 3, ASSIGN 4, or TURBO GAIN).  
i.LINK  
During interval recording, signal input/output through the  
i.LINK interface is impossible.  
Time code  
In Manual Interval Rec mode, the internal time code  
generator runs in R-RUN mode regardless of how the F-  
RUN/SET/R-RUN switch is set.  
For details about operation, see section 7-3-5 “Assigning  
Audio  
Example: After recording clip 3, you want to delete it and  
record a new clip 3 after clip 2.  
Audio signals are not recorded in Manual Interval Rec  
mode.  
Clip 1  
Clip 2  
Clip 3  
Playback control buttons  
New clip  
While recording in the single shot mode of Manual  
Interval Rec mode (the TALLY indicator (green) in the  
viewfinder flashes twice per second), you cannot use most  
of playback control buttons (F REV, F FWD, NEXT,  
PREV, PLAY/PAUSE, and STOP). To exit the single shot  
mode, press the EJECT button.  
To retake the most recent clip  
With recording paused or after the end of a preview (see  
page 60), proceed as follows.  
While recording in the consecutive mode of Manual  
Interval Rec mode (the TALLY indicator (green) flashes  
four times per second), you cannot use the disc control  
buttons (EJECT, F REV, F FWD, NEXT, PREV, PLAY/  
PAUSE and STOP). To use these buttons, stop recording  
by pressing the REC START button or the VTR button on  
the lens.  
1
Press the switch or button to which the retake function  
has been assigned.  
While the button is pressed, the last frame of the  
recorded clip and the message “PUSH RET FOR CLIP  
DELETE” appears.  
2
In this state, press the RET button.  
Menu operation  
The message “DELETING LAST CLIP” appears, and  
the processing for deleting the last recorded clip  
begins.  
When the deleting has finished, the message “LAST  
CLIP WAS DELETED” appears.  
In the single shot mode of Manual Interval Rec mode, you  
cannot change the settings of “CACHE/INTVAL REC”  
and “NUMBER OF FRAME” on the FUNCTION 1 page  
after the camcorder starts recording. To change the  
settings, stop recording by pressing the EJECT button or  
setting the POWER switch to OFF.  
While recording in the consecutive mode of Manual  
Interval Rec mode, you cannot change the settings of  
CACHE/INTVAL REC, NUMBER OF FRAME and  
Note  
If an operation (other than recording review) which is not  
a retake operation is carried out after the last clip has been  
3-2 Recording  
57  
   
recorded, the retake function does not work even when the  
camcorder is in the recording pause state.  
The number of the clip list loaded in the current clip list  
In this case, the message “RE-TAKE NOT ALLOWED!”  
appears. When you want to replace the last clip with a new  
out a retake operation, the last clip is deleted even if you  
do not carry out a recording operation afterwards.  
16:9  
E0004  
3-2-7 Auto Clip List Recoding for  
Automatic Inclusion of  
30  
18  
45-40  
Recorded Clips in Clip Lists  
Auto clip list recoding is a function for automatically  
including the clips generated by recording operations in a  
selected clip list. The updated clip list is saved to the disc.  
Proceed as follows.  
4
5
Press the REC START button or the VTR button on  
the lens to start recording, and press again to stop  
recording.  
A clip is generated automatically from the video and  
audio recorded in this interval, and added as a sub clip  
to the the currently loaded clip list. The updated list is  
also written to disc automatically.  
THUMBNAIL  
SEL/SET  
ESSENCE MARK  
S.SEL  
SUB CLIP  
Repeat the process of recording and stopping until you  
have included all the required clips.  
SUB CLIP  
button  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
To change target clip lists, carry out step 2 once more  
to load the desired clip list into the current clip list.  
To exit auto clip list coding mode  
Press the SUB CLIP button, turning off the sub clip  
indicator.  
1
2
Insert a disc.  
Load a clip list from the disc.  
• To create a new clip list, load a NEW FILE (empty)  
clip list.  
• To add clips to an existing clip list, load that clip list.  
Note  
Always load either a new or existing clip list from disc.  
3
Press the SUB CLIP button, turning on the sub clip  
indicator.  
The camcorder enters auto clip list recording mode.  
The viewfinder screen shows the number of the clip  
list loaded in the current clip list.  
58  
3-2 Recording  
   
Deteriorating playback conditions  
Deteriorating playback may be due to the following  
causes.  
• Scratches and dust on the disc surface  
This includes fingerprints, dust from the air, tar from  
cigarette smoke, and so on.  
3-3 Checking Recording  
and Playback  
Disc playback start position  
Scratches and soiling which occur before recording are  
not a problem because they are registered in advance as  
defects, and recording avoids them. However, scratches  
and soiling which occur after recording can lead to  
deteriorating playback conditions.  
Although this unit uses optical discs, it is designed to offer  
the most convenient features of tape playback by VTRs.  
One of these is the playback start position, which works in  
the same way as tape, as described below.  
• Aging of disc recording layers  
After playback stop  
The unit stops at the position where the STOP button was  
pressed.  
Over several decades, the recording layers of optical  
discs can age and cause deteriorating playback  
conditions.  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to resume playback at the  
stop position.  
You can use this function to check archival discs and  
other discs which have been stored for extended periods,  
so that you can take action before the deterioration  
progresses further.  
• Deteriorating laser diodes performance  
The performance of the laser diodes used in optical  
heads can worsen with age, leading to deteriorating  
playback conditions.  
After recording  
The unit stops at the position where recording ended.  
To play back a clip, press the PREV button to move to the  
start frame of any clip, or press the PREV button with the  
PLAY/PAUSE button held down to move to any position.  
You can use the digital clock to check the total optical  
output time of optical heads.  
After disc insertion  
The unit stops at the position of the disc when it was most  
recently ejected.  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to resume playback at the  
most recent position.  
Refer to the Maintenance Manual for an approximate  
guide to when it is time to replace optical heads.  
The playback position is saved to the disc when the disc is  
ejected, which allows playback to start at that position  
whenever it is loaded into any XDCAM player.  
To prevent playback conditions from  
deteriorating  
Pay attention to the following points when handling discs.  
• Do not open disc cartridges and touch discs directly with  
your hands.  
• Do not store for long periods in locations which are  
dusty or exposed to air circulated by fans.  
• Do not store for long periods under high temperatures or  
in locations exposed to direct sunlight.  
Note  
The playback position is not recorded to the disc if the disc  
is set to REC INH.  
3-3-1 Normal Playback  
If playback conditions have deteriorated  
Read errors occur when playback conditions continue to  
deteriorate.  
When a read error occurs, the message “DISC DEFECT”  
appears, the video freezes, and audio is muted.  
If this happens, check the following points.  
Whether the disc displays the same playback condition  
on other XDCAM devices: If so, the surface of the  
disc may be dirty or scratched, or the performance of  
the recording layers on the disc may have worsened  
due to age. Do not use discs with these symptoms.  
Whether every disc inserted into an XDCAM device  
displays the same playback conditions: If so, the  
performance of the laser diodes may have deteriorated.  
Check the total optical output time.  
By pressing the PLAY/PAUSE button, you can review any  
length of recording on the viewfinder screen in black and  
white or in color on the color LCD. There are two other  
ways to review the recording.  
• Recording review: You can view the last two seconds of  
the recording on the viewfinder screen in black and  
white or in color on the color LCD.  
• Color playback: You can see the recording in color on a  
color video monitor without the need for any external  
adaptor.  
You may also view the picture during a fast forward or  
reverse search.  
the switches and controls used to select the audio output  
signal and to adjust the audio level.  
3-3 Checking Recording and Playback  
59  
       
3-3-2 Checking the Last Two  
Seconds of the Recording —  
Recording Review  
3-3-4 Thumbnail Search  
Cuing up a desired clip  
To display the thumbnail images of all clips on the disc,  
and cue up a desired clip, proceed as follows.  
If you press the RET button on the lens while recording is  
paused, the last two seconds of the recording is played  
back on the viewfinder screen and the color LCD. Use this  
function to check whether recording went smoothly. If you  
hold down the RET button, a low-speed reverse search  
begins at a position two seconds before the recording end  
position. When you release the RET button, the reverse  
search stops and playback in the forward direction begins.  
After playback, the camcorder is ready to start recording  
again.  
2,3  
1
THUMBNAIL  
Thumbnail  
SEL/SET  
indicator  
ESSENCE MARK  
S.SEL  
SUB CLIP  
Sub clip  
indicator  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
By assigning the the same function as that of the RET  
button on the lens to the ASSIGN 1/3/4 switch, you can use  
the switch in the same way as the lens RET button.  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
3
2
3-3-3 Checking the Recording on  
the Color Video Monitor —  
Playback in Color  
Connect a color video monitor to the VIDEO OUT  
connector of the camcorder. By pressing the PLAY/  
PAUSE button, you can view the recorded picture.  
When the CBK-SD01 SDI Output Board is installed, you  
can connect a color video monitor provided with an SDI  
input connector.  
1
With the sub clip indicator off, press the  
THUMBNAIL button, turning on the thumbnail  
indicator.  
The thumbnails of all clips on the disc appear.  
Notes  
PDW-510/510P/530/530P  
Color video monitor  
• If the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to ON, set it to  
OFF and press the THUMBNAIL button.  
• If you set the MENU ON/OFF to ON during  
thumbnail display, thumbnail display is cancelled  
and replaced with menu display.  
VIDEO IN  
connector  
1)  
2)  
SDI IN connector  
VIDEO OUT connector  
1) When VBS is selected as the output signal of the VIDEO OUT  
connector  
2) When SDI is selected as the output signal of the VIDEO OUT  
connector (only when the CBK-SD01 is installed)  
Color playback  
Note  
You can select either VBS or SDI as the output signal of  
the VIDEO OUT connector when the CBK-SD01 is  
installed.  
60  
3-3 Checking Recording and Playback  
           
Sixth clip is selected from  
a total of 143 clips.  
Title of currently selected clip  
2~5  
1
Thumbnail of currently selected clip  
(first frame or specified frame)  
1)  
THUMBNAIL  
SEL/SET  
S.SEL  
ESSENCE MARK  
SUB CLIP  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
5
4,5  
Recording date and time  
of selected clip  
Duration of selected clip or  
time code of first frame  
1
Hold down the SHIFT button, and press the  
THUMBNAIL button.  
1) The thumbnail frame can be specified by a menu selection  
when the clip is recorded.  
The essence mark selection screen appears.  
To switch between duration and timecode display  
in the thumbnail display  
Press the HOLD button. Each press of the HOLD  
button switches the display between duration ant time  
code.  
Notes  
• If the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to ON, set it to  
OFF and press the THUMBNAIL button.  
• If you set the MENU ON/OFF to ON during  
thumbnail display, thumbnail display is cancelled  
and replaced with menu display.  
To escape from the thumbnail display to the full-  
screen display  
Press the THUMBNAIL button, turning off the  
indicator.  
2
3
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
the desired clip.  
You can also select clips with the following  
operations.  
Press the PREV or NEXT button: Select the  
previous or next clip.  
Press the PREV or NEXT button with the F REV  
or F FWD button held down: Select the first or  
last clip.  
To escape from the essence mark selection screen to  
the previous screen  
Press the RESET button.  
To cue up the selected clip, press the SEL/SET dial or  
the MENU knob.  
2
3
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
the desired essence mark.  
To start playback from the selected clip, press the  
PLAY/PAUSE button.  
Press the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob.  
Cuing up a frame including an essence  
mark  
Proceed as follows.  
Thumbnails of the frames including the selected  
essence mark appear.  
3-3 Checking Recording and Playback  
61  
 
For the clip list loading operation, see 4-3-3 “Loading  
(The example shows the case  
where SHOT MARK1 is selected  
as the essence mark.)  
This indicates that the thumbnail  
images are the frames including  
the essence mark  
Sixth frame is selected  
from a total of 31  
SHOTMARK1 frames.  
2
3
Press the SUB CLIP button, turning it on.  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
(SHOTMARK1).  
Playback begins from the first sub clip in the current  
clip list.  
Note  
Depending on the length of sub clips in the clip list and  
their arrangement on the disc, playback may freeze  
momentarily between sub clips.  
Cuing up with sub clip thumbnails  
With the desired clip list loaded in the current clip list,  
proceed as follows.  
Currently selected  
SHOTMARK1 frame  
1
Press the SUB CLIP button and the THUMBNAIL  
button, turning on the indicators.  
Thumbnails of the first frames in the sub clips appear.  
Recording date and time  
of selected frame  
Notes  
• If the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to ON, set it to  
OFF and press the THUMBNAIL button.  
• If you set the MENU ON/OFF to ON during  
thumbnail display, thumbnail display is cancelled  
and replaced with menu display.  
4
5
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
the desired frame.  
You can also select frames with the following  
operations.  
Press the PREV or NEXT button: Select the  
previous or next frame.  
Press the PREV or NEXT button with the F REV  
or F FWD button held down: Select the first or  
last frame.  
Sixth frame is selected  
from a total of 34 sub clips.  
Title of the current clip list  
Total duration of sub clips in clip list  
Press the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to cue up  
the selected clip.  
To start playback from the selected frame, press the  
PLAY/PAUSE button.  
3-3-5 Clip List Playback  
You can play back clips in the order of clip lists created  
with the scene selection function (see page 66).  
Playing back in clip list order  
Proceed as follows.  
Currently selected sub clip  
1
If the clip list that you want to play exists on the disc,  
load it into the current clip list (see page 66).  
Recording date and time of  
selected sub clip  
Duration of selected  
sub clip  
62  
3-3 Checking Recording and Playback  
   
To escape from the thumbnail display to the full-  
screen display  
Press the THUMBNAIL button, turning it off.  
3-4 Recording Video  
Signals from  
2
3
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
the sub clip you want to cue up.  
External Equipment  
To cue up the selected sub clip, press the SEL/SET dial  
or the MENU knob.  
With this camcorder, you can select in the OPERATION  
menu whether to record the video captured by the camera,  
or whether to record a signal from an external video  
device.  
To start playback from the selected sub clip, press the  
PLAY/PAUSE button.  
If this switching function is assigned to the ASSIGN 2  
switch, regardless of the setting in the OPERATION  
menu, you can make the selection with the ASSIGN 2  
switch. While recording video from an external device, the  
indication “EXT” appears on the viewfinder screen.  
Notes  
• You can switch the signals to be recorded using the  
ASSIGN 2 switch or by a menu operation at any time  
while recording on the disc. However, the signals  
recorded at the point where the signal is switched may be  
distorted. If the camera/external switching function is  
assigned to the ASSIGN 2 switch, you cannot use the  
following menu operations to switch between camera  
and external source input.  
• Even when the REC VIDEO SOURCE item is set to  
“EXT”, if the external video signal is not input to the  
i.LINK DV IN/OUT S400 connector or the GENLOCK  
IN connector, the camcorder does not switch to EXT  
mode, and the pictures being shot by the camcorder are  
recorded on the disc.  
3-4-1 Recording a DV Stream From  
External Equipment  
Notes  
• As the i.LINK cable, use an S400-compliant cable which  
is as short as possible (up to 1.5 m (5 feet)). It may not  
be possible to establish a DV connection when a longer  
cable is used.  
• Recording a DV stream is possible only when the video  
recording format is DVCAM.  
If the currently set video recording format is other than  
DVCAM, change it to DVCAM referring to 5-1-1 “Setting  
Proceed as follows.  
3-4 Recording Video Signals from External Equipment  
63  
       
21 SOURCE SEL  
TOP  
REC VIDEO SOURCE:  
EXT REC CONTROL :  
CAM  
OFF  
DSABL  
PC REMOTE  
:
MENU knob  
MENU ON/OFF switch  
Item  
Description  
1
Holding down the MENU knob, set the MENU ON/  
OFF switch to ON.  
CAM  
Records the pictures being shot by the  
camcorder.  
The TOP menu appears.  
EXT  
Records video signals from the  
external equipment connected to the  
i.LINK DV IN/OUT or GENLOCK IN  
connector.  
The b mark on the left of “REC VIDEO SOURCE”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
6
7
Turn the MENU knob to display “EXT”.  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
21 SOURCE SEL  
TOP  
“OPERATION”.  
REC VIDEO SOURCE:  
EXT REC CONTROL :  
EXT  
OFF  
DSABL  
PC REMOTE  
:
Press the MENU knob.  
If this is the first time the OPERATION menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page of the OPERATION  
menu appears. If the menu has been used before, the  
last accessed page appears.  
Press the MENU knob.  
4
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “SOURCE SEL”, and  
press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the SOURCE SEL page appears, then press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
Notes  
• During i.LINK DV stream input, the image on the  
viewfinder screen and the color LCD may occasionally  
show an overlapped frame or skipped frame, but this  
does not affect the recording on the disc.  
• During i.LINK DV stream input, the audio within the  
DV stream is recorded as the audio input.  
• During i.LINK DV stream input, a black picture is  
shown on the viewfinder screen and on the color LCD,  
and nothing is recorded, if the DV device on the sending  
side of the i.LINK DV connection is also in a stream  
input state.  
21 SOURCE SEL  
TOP  
REC VIDEO SOURCE:  
EXT REC CONTROL :  
CAM  
OFF  
DSABL  
PC REMOTE  
:
5
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “REC  
VIDEO SOURCE”, then press the MENU knob.  
3-4-2 Recording Analog Composite  
Signals (with the CBK-SC01  
Installed)  
Installing the CBK-SC01 Composite Input Board in the  
camcorder enables you to record analog composite signals  
64  
3-4 Recording Video Signals from External Equipment  
     
from external equipment connected to the GENLOCK IN  
connector.  
3-5 Freezing a Picture  
During Playback  
Proceed as follows.  
1
Display the SOURCE SEL page on the screen.  
Viewing frozen pictures  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to start playback.  
21 SOURCE SEL  
TOP  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button again at the instant  
when you want to freeze the picture.  
REC VIDEO SOURCE:  
EXT REC CONTROL :  
PC REMOTE  
CAM  
OFF  
DSABL  
:
EXT VIDEO SOURCE: ILINK  
EXT OUTPUT DELAY: SYNC  
SET UP REMOVE 0.0%  
A frozen picture appears.  
:
The time code is displayed in the counter display and  
the PLAY/PAUSE indicator flashes (one flash/  
second).  
3
To restart playback, press the PLAY/PAUSE button  
once again.  
2
3
Move the b mark to “EXT VIDEO SOURCE”, and  
press the MENU knob.  
When remotely controlling the camcorder from  
an RM-B150/B750 remote control unit  
You can perform the same operation from the RM-B150/  
B750.  
Turn the MENU knob to display “CMPST”.  
This ends the setting.  
When you input analog composite signals to the  
GENLOCK IN connector of the camcorder, these  
signals are displayed on the viewfinder screen and the  
color LCD, and can be recorded on the disc.  
Note  
Even when the GENLOCK ON/OFF item is set to “OFF”  
on the GENLOCK page of the MAINTENANCE menu,  
the camcorder is automatically synchronized with the  
external reference video signal when the external video  
signal is input to the GENLOCK IN connector in EXT  
mode. When the setting is switched to CAM mode, or  
when no signals are input to the GENLOCK IN connector  
even in EXT mode, the camcorder is reset to the original  
setting.  
3-5 Freezing a Picture During Playback  
65  
   
Scene Selection  
4
Chapter  
Camcorder’s memory  
4-1 Overview  
Current clip list  
cClip list playback  
and thumbnail  
display  
Can be edited (adding and  
deleting, rearranging sub  
clips)  
Clip lists and sub clips  
Scene selection is a function which allows you to save,  
load, and edit clip lists consisting of clips recorded on disc,  
or parts of clips, arranged in any order. Clips or parts of  
clips which have been inserted into clip lists are called sub  
clips.  
SAVE  
m
M
LOAD  
Disc  
Clips recorded on disc  
E0001 (Clip list 1)  
E0002 (Clip list 2)  
E0003 (Clip list 3)  
:
:
Clip 1  
Clip 2  
Clip 3  
Clip 4  
E0099 (Clip list 99)  
m
Clip list example  
Clip 2  
Part of clip 4 Part of clip  
3
The current clip list is always the target of sub clip creation  
and editing.  
Sub clip 1  
Sub clip 2  
Sub clip 3  
Notes  
• Data in the camcorder’s memory is lost when the  
camcorder is powered off or the disc is ejected. After  
creating or editing a clip list, be sure to save it to disc.  
• The current clip list cannot be saved to disc when the  
disc’s write-protect tab is set to the recording disabled  
position.  
Clip lists on disc and the current clip list  
Up to 99 clip lists can be saved on disc. These clip lists can  
be loaded, one at a time, into the camcorder’s memory for  
playback and editing. Newly created clip lists are also  
saved in the camcorder’s memory.  
This manual refers to the clip list which is currently loaded  
into the camcorder’s memory as the “current clip list”.  
66  
4-1 Overview  
                   
4-2 Basic Operations  
4-2-1 Creating Clip Lists  
You can create a clip list by selecting a desired clip from  
the thumbnail display, and including it in the clip list as a  
sub clip.  
Note  
Up to 99 clip lists can be handled in the CLIP menu.  
2
3
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select the  
clip you want to include in the clip list.  
Including a clip selected from the  
thumbnail display in the clip list  
Proceed as follows.  
Hold down the SHIFT button, and press the SEL/SET  
dial.  
The scene selection window appears.  
2~4  
1
Thumbnail  
THUMBNAIL  
SEL/SET  
indicator  
ESSENCE MARK  
S.SEL  
Sub clip  
SUB CLIP  
indicator  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
3
2
REGEN  
CLOCK  
To escape from the scene selection window to the  
previous screen  
Press the RESET button.  
4
5
Press the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob.  
This adds the selected clip to the clip list as a sub clip.  
At the same time, this closes the scene selection  
window and returns to the original thumbnail display.  
1
With the sub clip indicator off, press the  
THUMBNAIL button, turning on the thumbnail  
indicator.  
Repeat steps 2 to 4 until all desired clips have been  
added to the clip list.  
The thumbnails of the clips on the disc appear.  
The scene selection window shows the thumbnails of  
the sub clips that have already been included in the clip  
list. The cursor within the window indicates the  
position in which the next sub clip will be included.  
Notes  
• If the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to ON, set it to  
OFF and press the THUMBNAIL button.  
• If you set the MENU ON/OFF to ON during  
thumbnail display, thumbnail display is cancelled  
and replaced with menu display.  
4-2 Basic Operations  
67  
     
Total duration of the sub  
clips in the current clip list  
SEL/SET dial  
THUMBNAIL  
button  
THUMBNAIL  
Thumbnail  
indicator  
SEL/SET  
S.SEL  
ESSENCE MARK  
SUB CLIP  
SUB CLIP button  
SHIFT button  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
MENU knob  
Cursor  
(Insertion position for the next  
sub clip to be included)  
Thumbnails of the sub clips already  
included in the current clip list  
To move the cursor within the scene selection  
window  
When the scene selection window appears as you carry  
out step 3, use the SEL/SET dial to move in the desired  
direction.  
Loading a clip list to edit from disc  
Proceed as follows.  
1
With the thumbnail indicator off, hold down the  
SHIFT button, and press the SUB CLIP button.  
6
When you have added all of the desired clips, save the  
current clip list to disc.  
The CLIP menu appears.  
Notes  
• If the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to ON, set it to  
OFF, then press the SUB CLIP button with the  
SHIFT button held down.  
Note  
• If you set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON while  
the CLIP menu is being displayed, thumbnail  
display is cancelled and replaced with menu display.  
Unless the current clip list has been saved to disc, its  
contents will be lost when the camcorder is powered  
off or the disc is ejected. After creating a clip list, be  
sure to save it.  
<CLIP MENU>  
LOAD  
SAVE  
DELETE  
CLEAR  
TC PRESET  
4-2-2 Editing Clip Lists  
You can carry out the following operations on sub clips  
within a clip list.  
• Moving sub clips (changing the sequence)  
• Trimming sub clips  
2
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to move the  
cursor to LOAD, and press the dial/knob.  
• Deleting sub clips  
For details of how to add sub clips, see the procedure in 4-  
A list of the clip lists on the disc appears.  
68  
4-2 Basic Operations  
   
Press the THUMBNAIL button, turning off the  
indicator.  
CLIP LIST LOAO ESC  
E0001 04/08/08 21:57  
E0002 04/08/24 11:15  
E0003 04/08/25 15:30  
E0004 NEW FILE  
E0005 NEW FILE  
E0006 NEW FILE  
E0007 NEW FILE  
E0008 NEW FILE  
E0009 NEW FILE  
E0010 NEW FILE  
3
4
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select the  
desired sub clip.  
Hold down the SHIFT button, and press the SEL/SET  
dial.  
The sub clip operation menu appears.  
3
4
5
Select the desired clip list (except for NEW FILE), and  
press the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob.  
The message “LOAD OK? YES b NO” appears.  
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to move the  
b mark to “YES” and press the dial/knob.  
The selected clip list is loaded into the current clip list.  
Hold down the SHIFT button and press the SUB CLIP  
button.  
CLIP menu operations end.  
To return to the thumbnail display without moving  
the sub clip  
Moving a sub clip  
Do either of the following.  
Proceed as follows.  
• Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
EXIT, and press the dial/knob.  
• Press the RESET button.  
1
2
Press the SUB CLIP button, turning on the indicator.  
Press the THUMBNAIL button, turning on the  
indicator.  
5
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
MOVE, and press the dial/ knob.  
Thumbnails of the sub clips within the current clip list  
appear.  
The sub clip movement screen appears. The sub clip  
selected in step 3 appears surrounded by a frame.  
Notes  
This shows that third sub clip is moved  
to the position of eighth sub clip.  
• If the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to ON, set it to  
OFF and press the THUMBNAIL button.  
• If you set the MENU ON/OFF to ON during  
thumbnail display, thumbnail display is cancelled  
and replaced with menu display.  
Cursor showing the position to which  
the selected sub clip is moved  
To escape from the sub clip movement screen to the  
previous screen  
Press the RESET button.  
To escape from the thumbnail display to the full-  
screen display  
4-2 Basic Operations  
69  
   
6
7
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to move the  
cursor to the position where you want to move the  
selected sub clip.  
4
At the point where you want to set the new IN point or  
OUT point, select the IN (when changing the IN point)  
or the OUT (when changing the OUT point), and press  
the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob.  
Note  
To change both the IN point and the OUT point,  
repeat steps 3 and 4.  
New sub clips are created if the IN and OUT points  
span several clips after the change. The number of new  
sub clips equals the number of clips.  
You can press the THUMBNAIL button to return to  
full-screen sub clip display, without moving a sub clip.  
Press the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob.  
The sub clip thumbnail display appears, and you can  
check the new position of the sub clip.  
To reset the IN point or OUT point, selecting IN or  
OUT, hold down the RESET button and press the  
SEL/SET dial.  
To cue up the IN point or OUT point, hold down the  
SHIFT button and press the NEXT or PREV button.  
Note  
You can press the THUMBNAIL button to return to  
full-screen sub clip display, without trimming a sub  
clip.  
5
When the new IN and/or OUT points are set, hold  
down the SHIFT button and press the SEL/SET dial.  
This carries out the trimming, and the screen returns to  
the sub clip thumbnail display.  
Trimming a sub clip  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Carry out steps 1 to 4 in the procedure, “Moving a sub  
clip” above.  
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
TRIM, and press the dial/knob.  
The first frame of the selected sub clip appears. In this  
state, you can carry out playback and search all clips  
on the disc.  
To cancel the trim operation  
Reset the IN point and the OUT point to return to the  
state before the sub clip trimming screen was  
displayed, then hold down the SHIFT button and press  
the SEL/SET dial.  
This cancels the trim, and the screen returns to the sub  
clip thumbnail display.  
Deleting a sub clip  
Proceed as follows.  
To cancel the trim and escape from the sub clip  
trim screen  
Hold down the SHIFT button and press the SEL/SET  
dial.  
1
2
Carry out steps 1 to 4 in the procedure, “Moving a sub  
3
Carry out playback and search to find the new location  
of the IN point or OUT point of the selected sub clip.  
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
DELETE, and press the dial/knob.  
70  
4-2 Basic Operations  
   
The sub clip deletion screen appears.  
4-3 Clip List Operations  
4-3-1 Displaying the CLIP Menu  
Proceed as follows.  
Note  
The CLIP menu can handle up to 99 clip lists.  
With the thumbnail indicator off, hold down the SHIFT  
button and press the SUB CLIP button.  
The CLIP menu appears.  
To cancel the deletion, and escape from the sub clip  
deletion screen  
Do either of the following.  
Notes  
• Select CANCEL, and press the SEL/SET dial or the  
MENU knob.  
• Press the RESET button.  
• If the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to ON, set it to OFF,  
then press the SUB CLIP button with the SHIFT button  
held down.  
The screen returns to the sub clip thumbnail display.  
• If you set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON while the  
CLIP menu is being displayed, thumbnail display is  
cancelled and replaced with menu display.  
3
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
OK, and press the dial/knob.  
<CLIP MENU>  
This deletes the sub clip, and the screen returns to the  
sub clip thumbnail display.  
LOAD  
SAVE  
DELETE  
CLEAR  
TC PRESET  
Use this menu to carry out the following operations.  
• Save the current clip list to disc.  
• Load a clip list on disc into the current clip list.  
• Delete a clip list from disc.  
• Clear the current clip list.  
• Set the start time code of the current clip list.  
4-3-2 Saving the Current Clip List to  
Disc  
Saving edited clip lists to disc  
The operations described above (moving, trimming, and  
deleting sub clips) are carried out on the current clip list.  
Execute the procedure in 4-3-2 “Saving the Current Clip  
List to Disc” (page 71) to save the current clip list to disc  
again as a clip list.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select  
SAVE in the CLIP menu, and press the dial/knob.  
A list of clip lists appears.  
“NEW FILE” is shown for lists which do not exist on  
the disc, having names only.  
Note  
Unless the current clip list has been saved to disc, its  
contents will be lost when the camcorder is powered off or  
the disc is ejected. After creating a clip list, be sure to save  
it.  
4-3 Clip List Operations  
71  
           
The message “LOAD OK? YES b NO” appears.  
CLIP LIST SAVE  
3
4
5
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to move the  
b mark to “YES” and press the dial/knob.  
E0001 04/08/08 21:57  
E0002 04/08/24 11:15  
E0003 04/08/25 15:30  
E0004 NEW FILE  
E0005 NEW FILE  
E0006 NEW FILE  
E0007 NEW FILE  
E0008 NEW FILE  
E0009 NEW FILE  
E0010 NEW FILE  
The selected clip list is loaded into the current clip list.  
Hold down the SHIFT button and press the SUB CLIP  
button.  
The date of creation or the title of each clip list is  
shown in the list of clip lists. To switch between the  
date and the title, hold down the SHIFT button and  
press the SEL/SET dial or the MENU button. (The  
date of creation is always shown for clip lists without  
titles.)  
CLIP menu operations end.  
To check the contents of the loaded clip list, press the  
SUB CLIP button and the THUMBNAIL button,  
turning on the indicators.  
Thumbnails of the sub clips in the clip list appear.  
2
3
4
Use the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to select the  
desired clip list name, and press the dial/knob.  
Notes  
• If the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to ON, set it to  
OFF and press the THUMBNAIL button.  
• If you set the MENU ON/OFF to ON during  
thumbnail display, thumbnail display is cancelled  
and replaced with menu display.  
• Unless the current clip list has been saved to disc, its  
contents will be lost when you load a new clip list  
from the disc.  
The message “SAVE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to move the  
b mark to “YES” and press the dial/knob.  
The current clip list is saved to disc.  
Hold down the SHIFT button and press the SUB CLIP  
button.  
CLIP menu operations end.  
4-3-4 Deleting Clip Lists From Disc  
Proceed as follows.  
4-3-3 Loading a Clip List From Disc  
Into the Current Clip List  
1
Select DELETE in the CLIP menu, and press the SEL/  
SET dial or the MENU knob.  
Proceed as follows.  
A list of clip lists appears.  
The date of creation or the title of each clip list is  
shown in the list of clip lists. To switch between the  
date and the title, hold down the SHIFT button and  
turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU button. (The date  
of creation is always shown for clip lists without  
titles.)  
1
In the CLIP menu, move the cursor to LOAD and press  
the SEL/SET dial or the Menu Knob.  
A list of clip lists appears.  
CLIP LIST LOAO ESC  
E0001 04/08/08 21:57  
E0002 04/08/24 11:15  
E0003 04/08/25 15:30  
E0004 NEW FILE  
E0005 NEW FILE  
E0006 NEW FILE  
E0007 NEW FILE  
E0008 NEW FILE  
E0009 NEW FILE  
E0010 NEW FILE  
2
3
4
Select the name of the clip list to delete and press the  
SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob.  
The message “DELETE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to move the  
b mark to “YES” and press the dial/knob.  
The date of creation or the title of each clip list is  
shown in the list of clip lists. To switch between the  
date and the title, hold down the SHIFT button and  
press the SEL/SET dial or the MENU button. (The  
date of creation is always shown for clip lists without  
titles.)  
The selected clip list is deleted from the disc.  
Hold down the SHIFT button and press the SUB CLIP  
button.  
CLIP menu operations end.  
2
Select the desired clip list and press the SEL/SET dial  
or the MENU knob.  
72  
4-3 Clip List Operations  
         
2
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the Menu knob to select the  
item (HOUR, MIN, SEC, or FRAME) which you want  
to set, then press the dial/knob.  
4-3-5 Clearing the Current Clip List  
Proceed as follows to clear the current clip list, leaving it  
with no clip list loaded.  
3
4
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the Menu knob until the  
desired value is displayed, then press the dial/knob.  
1
Select CLEAR in the CLIP menu, and press the SEL/  
SET dial or the MENU knob.  
After all items have been set, select OK, and press the  
SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob.  
The following screen display appears.  
The starting time code of the current clip list is set to  
the specified LTC value. The count starts from that  
value when playback starts.  
CLIP LIST CLEAR  
ESC  
CLEAR CLIP LIST : EXEC  
5
Hold down the SHIFT button and press the SUB CLIP  
button.  
CLIP menu operations end.  
2
3
Press the SEL/SET dial or the Menu knob.  
The message “EXECUTE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
Turn the SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob to move the  
b mark to “YES” and press the dial/knob.  
The current clip list is cleared, leaving it with no clip  
list loaded.  
4
Hold down the SHIFT button and press the SUB CLIP  
button.  
CLIP menu operations end.  
4-3-6 Setting the Start Time code of  
the Current Clip List  
The start time code (LTC) of the current clip list is set to  
00:00:00:00 when the camcorder is powered on and when  
a disc is inserted.  
You can set the start time code to any value. Proceed as  
follows.  
1
Select TC PRESET in the CLIP menu, and press the  
SEL/SET dial or the MENU knob.  
The following screen display appears.  
CLIP LIST TC PRS ESC  
HOUR  
MIN  
SEC  
:
:
:
:
00  
00  
00  
00  
FRAME  
OK  
4-3 Clip List Operations  
73  
       
4-4Using the PDZ-1 Proxy  
Browsing Software  
When a computer with the PDZ-1 Proxy Browsing  
Software installed is connected to this unit, you can  
transfer the proxy AV data and metadata files recorded on  
a disc to the computer. On the computer side, PDZ-1  
enables you to browse the proxy AV data, add or modify  
metadata (titles, comments, essence marks, etc.), or create  
a clip list.  
The modified metadata and the created clip list can then be  
written back to the disc loaded in this unit.  
System requirements  
The following are required to use PDZ-1.  
• Computer: PC with Intel Pentium III CPU, at least 1  
GHz  
Installed memory: at least 512 MB  
• Operating system: Microsoft Windows 2000 Service  
Pack 4 or higher, or Microsoft Windows XP  
Professional Service Pack 1 or higher  
• Web browser: Internet Explorer 6.0 Service Pack 1 or  
higher  
• DirectX: DirectX 8.1b or higher  
To install the PDZ-1  
Insert the supplied CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive of the  
computer and execute the Setup.exe file, then follow the  
installation instructions.  
For details, refer to the ReadMe file in the CD-ROM.  
Notes  
• Make sure that the hard disk drive on which the work  
folder to store the material transferred from this unit has  
adequate free space. The amount of proxy AV data  
transferred is about 1.4 GB per disc (when recording in  
the DVCAM format).  
• To transfer files between the computer and this unit  
requires this unit’s IP address and other network-related  
settings to be made.  
74  
4-4 Using the PDZ-1 Proxy Browsing Software  
         
Adjustments and  
Settings for Recording  
5
Chapter  
<TOP MENU>  
USER  
USER MENU CUSTOMIZE  
ALL  
OPERATION  
PAINT  
MAINTENANCE  
FILE  
DIAGNOSIS  
5-1 Setting the  
Recording Format  
(PDW-530/530P only)  
Before recording with the PDW-530/530P, it is necessary  
to set the recording format for each of video and audio.  
Video recording format: MPEG IMX 50 Mbps, 40 Mbps,  
30 Mbps, or DVCAM  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“MAINTENANCE”.  
Audio recording format: 16-bit/48 kHz or 24-bit/48 kHz  
<TOP MENU>  
USER  
USER MENU CUSTOMIZE  
ALL  
Note  
It is not possible to combine different recording formats on  
a single disc.  
OPERATION  
PAINT  
MAINTENANCE  
FILE  
DIAGNOSIS  
5-1-1 Setting the Video Recording  
Format  
4
5
Press the MENU knob.  
You can select the video recording format in a menu, from  
MPEG IMX 50 Mbps, MPEG IMX 40 Mbps, MPEG IMX  
30 Mbps, and DVCAM.  
The factory default selection is “IMX50”.  
Proceed as follows.  
If this is the first time the MAINTENANCE menu has  
been displayed, the CONTENTS page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu appears.  
If the menu has been used before, the last accessed  
page appears.  
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “VDR MODE”, and press  
the MENU knob to display the VDR MODE page.  
1
2
Turn on the POWER switch.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the VDR MODE page appears, then press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch from OFF to ON.  
The TOP menu appears.  
5-1 Setting the Recording Format (PDW-530/530P only)  
75  
             
For the operation, see the descriptions of steps 1 to 5  
M09 VDR MODE  
TOP  
REC TALLY BLINK :  
ON  
OFF  
SEL  
IH  
IMX50  
REC START/STOP  
MODE SELECT  
TIMER SET  
:
:
:
:
2
Press the MENU knob, then turn it to move the b mark  
to “AU DATA LEN (IMX)”, and press the MENU  
knob.  
REC FORMAT  
M06 AUDIO-2  
TOP  
6
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “REC  
FORMAT”, and press the MENU knob again.  
AU DATA LEN (IMX):?16bit  
AU REF LEVEL : -20db  
AU REF OUT 0db  
AU CH12 AGC MODE : MONO  
AU CH34 AGC MODE : MONO  
:
AU AGC SPEC  
AU LIMITER MODE  
AU LIMITER  
:
:
:
-6db  
OFF  
ON  
M09 VDR MODE  
TOP  
I.LINK AUDIO OUT :  
2CH  
REC TALLY BLINK :  
ON  
OFF  
SEL  
IH  
REC START/STOP  
MODE SELECT  
TIMER SET  
:
:
:
REC FORMAT  
:? IMX50  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to display the desired format,  
and press the MENU knob.  
Move the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF.  
This ends the menu operation.  
The b mark at the side of “REC FORMAT” changes  
to a z mark, and the z mark by “IMX50” changes to  
a ? mark.  
The above procedure completes the setting of the  
recording format.  
7
Turn the MENU knob to display the desired recording  
format.  
M09 VDR MODE  
TOP  
REC TALLY BLINK :  
ON  
OFF  
SEL  
IH  
REC START/STOP  
MODE SELECT  
TIMER SET  
:
:
:
REC FORMAT  
:? IMX40  
8
9
Press the MENU knob.  
This confirms the selection.  
Align the b mark with “TOP” at the top right of the  
menu page, and press the MENU knob.  
This returns to the TOP menu.  
5-1-2 Setting the Audio Recording  
Format  
On the PDW-530/530P, when the video recording format  
is IMX50/40/30, you can select the audio recording format  
in a menu, from 16-bit/48 kHz and 24-bit/48 kHz. The  
factory default selection is “16bit”.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
Display the AUDIO-2 page of the MAINTENANCE  
menu.  
76  
5-1 Setting the Recording Format (PDW-530/530P only)  
   
For details of manual black balance adjustment, refer to  
the Maintenance Manual.  
5-2 Adjusting the Black  
Balance and the  
White Balance  
To ensure excellent image quality when using this  
camcorder, conditions may require that both the black  
balance and the white balance be adjusted.  
OUTPUT/DCC switch  
AUTO W/B BAL switch  
Black balance adjustment  
The black balance will require adjustment in the following  
cases.  
To adjust the black balance, proceed as follows.  
• When the camcorder is used for the first time  
• When the camcorder has not been used for a long time  
• When the camcorder is used under conditions in which  
the surrounding temperature has changed greatly  
• When the GAIN selector (L/M/H) values have been  
changed by using the USER menu  
1
2
Set the OUTPUT/DCC switch to CAM.  
Push the AUTO W/B BAL switch to BLK and release  
the switch.  
The switch returns to the center position, and the  
adjustment is executed.  
During adjustment, the following message is displayed  
on the viewfinder screen.  
It is not usually necessary to adjust the black balance when  
using the camcorder after it has been off.  
White balance adjustment  
Always readjust the white balance when the lighting  
conditions change.  
Themessageschange  
in the following  
sequence :  
-BLACK SET-  
t
-BLACK BALANCE-  
ABB:EXECUTING  
-BLACK SET-  
Viewfinder screen displays  
If the black balance or white balance adjustment is started,  
messages that report on the progress and results are  
displayed on the viewfinder screen when the VF DISP  
MODE item is set to “2” or “3” on the VF DISP 1 page of  
the USER menu.  
The black balance adjustment ends in a few seconds  
with the message “ABB:OK” and the adjustment value  
is automatically stored in memory.  
Note  
Notes  
Black balance and white balance adjustment values that  
are automatically set by the camcorder and the various  
settings are stored in the camcorder memory and retained  
even when the power is turned off.  
• During the black balance adjustment, the iris is  
automatically closed.  
• During the black balance adjustment, the gain selection  
circuit is automatically activated so you may see  
flickering on the viewfinder screen, but this is not a fault.  
5-2-1 Adjusting the Black Balance  
If automatic black balance adjustment  
cannot be made  
If the black balance adjustment cannot be completed  
normally, an error message will appear for about 3 seconds  
on the viewfinder screen (in display mode 2 or 3).  
Possible messages are listed below.  
In automatic black balance mode, adjustments are  
performed in the following order: clamp level, black set,  
and black balance. Manual black balance adjustment can  
be selected from the setup menu.  
Note that the automatic black balance adjustment  
includes a function to correct for white flecks caused in  
the CCDs by cosmic rays, in addition to the normal  
black balance operation.  
5-2 Adjusting the Black Balance and the White Balance  
77  
     
Black balance adjustment error messages  
FILTER selector  
Error message Meaning  
ABB : NG  
IRIS NOT  
CLOSED  
The lens iris did not close; adjustment  
was impossible.  
ABB : NG  
TIME LIMIT  
Adjustment could not be completed  
within the standard number of attempts.  
ABB : NG  
R (or G or B) :  
OVERFLOW  
The difference between the reference  
value and the current value is so great  
that it exceeds the range. Adjustment  
was impossible.  
OUTPUT/DCC  
switch: CAM  
If any of the above error messages is displayed, retry the  
black balance adjustment.  
Keep pushing the AUTO W/B BAL to BLK until “-  
BLACK SET-” appears after “-BLACK BALANCE-”  
appears. If the error message occurs again, an internal  
check is necessary.  
WHITE BAL  
switch: A or B  
1)  
For information about this internal check, refer to the  
Maintenance Manual.  
GAIN selector: Set as low as  
possible.  
Note  
If the lens cable is not firmly connected to the LENS  
connector, it may not be possible to adjust the lens iris. If  
this happens, the black balance will be incorrect.  
1) White balance setting values are stored in memory B only  
when the WHITE SWITCH <B> item is set to “MEM” on  
the FUNCTION 2 page of the OPERATION menu.  
Black balance memory  
Values stored in memory are held until the black balance  
is next adjusted.  
If the setting of the GAIN selector or WHITE BAL  
switch is changed, a message reporting the new setting  
position appears for about 3 seconds in the setting  
change and adjustment progress message display area  
of the viewfinder screen.  
If a memory error occurs  
If the error message “: STORED DATA : NG” flashes on  
the viewfinder screen when the camcorder is turned on, the  
black balance and white balance memory contents have  
been lost.  
Adjust the black balance and white balance again. Contact  
your Sony representative if this message continues to  
appear even after the black balance and white balance have  
been adjusted again.  
2
Set the FILTER selector to suit the lighting conditions  
as follows.  
For the PDW-530/530P:  
FILTER selector (outer knob) setting and CC filter  
selection  
FILTER selector (outer knob) CC filter  
setting  
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
A
B
C
D
Cross filter  
3200 K  
5-2-2 Adjusting the White Balance  
To automatically adjust the white balance  
When you make automatic white balance adjustment, the  
adjustment value obtained is saved in memory.  
Proceed as follows.  
4300 K  
6300 K  
FILTER selector (inner knob) setting and ND filter  
selection  
FILTER selector (inner knob) ND filter  
setting  
1
2
Clear  
1
Set the switches and selectors as shown in the figure  
below.  
1
/ ND  
4
1
3
/
ND  
16  
78  
5-2 Adjusting the Black Balance and the White Balance  
     
FILTER selector (inner knob) setting and ND filter  
selection  
FILTER selector (inner knob) ND filter  
setting  
1
4
/
ND  
64  
For the PDW-510/510P:  
AUTO W/B BAL switch  
FILTER selector setting and filter selection  
The switch returns to the center position, and the  
adjustment is executed.  
FILTER selector setting  
Filter selection  
1
2
3200 K  
1
5600 K + / ND  
8
During adjustment, the message “WHITE : OP” is  
displayed on the viewfinder screen (in display mode 2  
or 3).  
3
4
5600 K  
1
5600 K + / ND  
64  
The white balance adjustment ends in about one  
second with the message shown in the following  
figure, and the adjustment setting is automatically  
stored in the memory (A or B) that was selected in step  
1.  
If the setting of the FILTER selector is changed, a  
message reporting the setting appears for about 3  
seconds in the setting change and adjustment progress  
message display area of the viewfinder screen (in  
display mode 3).  
3
Place a white test card under the same lighting  
conditions as for the subject to be shot and zoom up to  
it.  
Approximate color  
temperature of the  
subject  
AWB:OK  
. K  
Alternatively, any white object such as a cloth or a  
wall can be used.  
The absolute minimum white area is as follows.  
Rectangle centered on  
the screen. The lengths  
of the sides are 70% of  
the length and width of  
the screen.  
Note  
If the camera has a zoom lens with an automatic iris,  
the iris may hunt during the adjustment. To prevent  
1)  
this, adjust the iris gain knob (indicated as IG, IS, or S)  
on the lens.  
The white object must  
be within the rectangle  
and have an area of at  
least 10% of the screen.  
For details, refer to the lens operation manual.  
1)Hunting  
Note  
Repeated brightening and darkening of the image, resulting from  
repeated response to automatic iris control.  
Make sure there are not bright spots in the rectangle.  
4
5
Adjust the lens iris.  
If the automatic white balance adjustment  
cannot be made  
If the white balance adjustment cannot be completed  
normally, an error message will appear for about 3 seconds  
on the viewfinder screen.  
Manually adjusted lens: set the iris to an appropriate  
setting.  
Lens with automatic iris: set the automatic/manual  
switch on the lens to automatic.  
Possible messages are listed below.  
Push the AUTO W/B BAL switch to WHT and then  
release the switch.  
White balance adjustment error messages  
Error message  
Meaning  
WHITE : NG  
LOW LEVEL  
The white video level is too low.  
Either open the lens iris or increase  
the gain.  
5-2 Adjusting the Black Balance and the White Balance  
79  
If a memory error occurs  
Error message  
Meaning  
If the error message “: STORED DATA : NG” flashes on  
the viewfinder screen when the camcorder is turned on, the  
white balance and black balance memory contents have  
been lost.  
WHITE : NG  
COLOR TEMP HIGH  
The color temperature is too high.  
Select a suitable filter setting.  
WHITE : NG  
COLOR TEMP LOW  
The color temperature is too low.  
Select a suitable filter setting.  
Adjust the white balance and black balance again. Contact  
your Sony representative if this message continues to  
appear even after the white balance and black balance have  
been adjusted again.  
WHITE : NG  
TIME LIMIT  
Adjustment could not be completed  
within the standard number of  
attempts.  
WHITE : NG  
POOR WHITE AREA  
The white area could not be  
checked.  
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
WHITE : NG  
OVER LEVEL  
The white video level is too high.  
Either stop down the lens iris or  
change the ND filter.  
If any of the above error messages is displayed, retry the  
white balance adjustment. If the error message occurs  
again, an internal check is necessary.  
For information about this internal check, refer to the  
Maintenance Manual.  
If you have no time to adjust the white  
balance  
Set the WHITE BAL switch to PRST.  
The white balance is automatically set as follows,  
depending on the FILTER selector setting.  
• PDW-530/530P:  
B: 3200K, C: 4300 K, D: 6300K  
• PDW-510/510P:  
1: 3200 K, 3: 5600 K  
For details about setting the white balance manually, see  
White balance memory  
Values stored in memory are held until the white balance  
is next adjusted.  
There are two sets of white balance memories, A and B,  
and adjustments for each of the filters can be automatically  
stored in the memory corresponding to the setting (A or B)  
of the WHITE BAL switch. The camcorder has four built-  
in filters, so a total of eight (4 × 2) adjustments can be  
stored. The number of memories allocated to each of A and  
B can be limited to one by setting the WHT FILTER INH.  
item to “ON” on the FUNCTION 3 page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu. In this case, the memory  
contents are not linked to the filter settings.  
If the WHITE BAL switch is set to B, and on the  
FUNCTION 2 page of the OPERATION menu, the  
WHITE SWITCH <B> item is set to “ATW”, the ATW  
function is activated to automatically adjust the white  
balance of the picture being shot for varying lighting  
conditions.  
80  
5-2 Adjusting the Black Balance and the White Balance  
Shutter  
mode  
Shutter speed  
Application  
5-3 Setting the  
Electronic Shutter  
EVS  
Shutter speed currently  
Improved  
vertical  
resolution.  
However, the  
sensitivity and  
dynamicrange  
are reduced.  
(Enhanced selected in the Standard or  
Vertical  
definition  
System)  
ECS mode  
This section describes the shutter modes that can be used  
with the electronic shutter of the camcorder, and describes  
the procedure for selecting the shutter speed and shutter  
mode.  
1) Only when the CBK-FC01 is installed.  
2) The SLS mode can only be selected when the CCD scan mode(see page  
129) is set to “I (interlace scan)”.  
5-3-1 Shutter Modes  
Notes  
The shutter modes that can be used with the electronic  
shutter and the shutter speeds that can be selected are listed  
below.  
• Whatever the operating mode of the electronic shutter,  
the sensitivity of the CCD decreases with increasing  
shutter speed.  
• When the automatic iris is used, the iris opens wider as  
the shutter speed increases, thus reducing the depth of  
field.  
Selectable shutter modes and shutter speeds  
Shutter  
mode  
Shutter speed  
Application  
• Under artificial light, particularly fluorescent or mercury  
lamps, the light intensity may appear to be constant, but  
the red, green, and blue intensities are actually changing  
in synchronization with the frequency of the power  
supply causing flicker. Using an electronic shutter under  
such lighting could make the flicker even worse. Color  
flicker is particularly likely to happen when the power  
supply frequency is 60 Hz (with the PDW-510/530) or  
50 Hz (with the PDW-510P/530P). However, if the  
power frequency is 50 Hz (with the PDW-510/530) or 60  
Hz (with the PDW-510P/530P), setting the shutter speed  
to 1/100 or 1/60 can reduce this flicker.  
• When a bright object is shot in EVS mode or ECS mode  
in such a manner that it fills the screen, the upper edge of  
the picture may have poor quality because of an inherent  
characteristic of CCDs. Before using EVS mode or ECS  
mode, check the shooting conditions.  
Standard  
PDW-510/ Scan Mode:I  
For shooting  
fast-moving  
subjects with  
little blurring.  
530  
1/100, 1/125,  
1/250, 1/500,  
1/1000, 1/2000  
(sec.)  
Scan Mode:PsF  
1/40, 1/60, 1/120,  
1/125, 1/250,  
1/500, 1/1000,  
1/2000 (sec.)  
1)  
Scan Mode:24P  
1/32, 1/48, 1/96,  
1/125, 1/250,  
1/500, 1/1000,  
1/2000 (sec.):  
PDW-  
510P/  
530P  
Scan Mode:I  
1/60, 1/125,  
1/250, 1/500,  
1/1000, 1/2000  
(sec.)  
You can turn on or off the EVS mode on the SW STATUS  
page of the PAINT menu.  
Scan Mode:PsF  
1/33, 1/50, 1/100,  
1/125, 1/250,  
1/500, 1/1000,  
1/2000 (sec.)  
5-3-2 Selecting the Shutter Mode  
and Shutter Speed  
ECS  
PDW-510/ Scan Mode:I  
For obtaining  
images with  
no horizontal  
bands of noise  
when shooting  
subjects such  
as monitor  
(Extended 530  
Clear  
60.0 to 6000 Hz  
Scan Mode:PsF  
30.0 to 7000 Hz  
Use the SHUTTER selector to select a shutter mode or a  
standard-mode shutter speed. To set the shutter speed in  
ECS or SLS mode, with the SHUTTER selector set to ON  
and the ECS or SLS mode selected, use the MENU knob  
for adjustment.  
You can use the SHT ENABLE page of the OPERATION  
menu to narrow the range of choice in advance, or to select  
in advance whether or not you use ECS/SLS.  
Scan)  
1)  
Scan Mode:24P  
24.0 Hz to 5000  
Hz  
screens.  
PDW-  
Scan Mode:I  
510P/  
530P  
50.0 to 6000 Hz  
Scan Mode:PsF  
25.0 to 6000 Hz  
2)  
1 (1/30 sec for PDW-510/530, For shooting  
1/25 sec for PDW-510P/530P) subjects in low  
SLS  
(slow  
speed  
shutter)  
to 8, 16 frames (1/2 sec for  
PDW-510/530, 2/3 sec for  
PDW-510P/530P)  
level lighting  
conditions  
5-3 Setting the Electronic Shutter  
81  
             
Setting the shutter mode and standard-  
mode shutter speed  
Standard mode (with scan mode:I)  
Once the shutter speed is selected, it is retained even when  
the camcorder power is turned off.  
1
Follow the procedure described in 7-2-2 “Selecting the  
Display Items” (page 114) to set the VF DISPLAY  
MODE item to “2” or “3” on the VF DISP 1 page of  
the USER menu.  
SLS mode  
ECS mode  
1/100: for PDW-510/530  
1/60: for PDW-510P/530P  
2
Push the SHUTTER selector from ON to SELECT.  
Setting the shutter speed in ECS mode  
Proceed as follows.  
1 2  
Setting the shutter speed in ECS (Extended Clear Scan) mode  
SHUTTER selector  
1
Set the shutter speed mode to ECS.  
For the operation, see the previous item “Setting the  
The current shutter setting indication appears for about  
3 seconds in the setting change and adjustment  
progress message display area of the viewfinder  
screen.  
Examples: “: SS : 1/250”, “: SLS : 1/30 : 1FRAME”,  
“: ECS : 60.0 Hz”  
ECS:60.00Hz  
3
Before the shutter setting indication disappears, push  
the SHUTTER selector down to SELECT again and  
repeat this until the desired mode or speed appears.  
Pushing the SHUTTER selector down to SELECT  
repeatedly allows you to cycle through the settings of  
mode and speed preselected on the SHT ENABLE  
page of the OPERATION menu.  
Example of view finder screen display for ECS setting operation  
2
Turn the MENU knob clockwise or counterclockwise  
until the desired frequency appears.  
Note that all modes and all standard-mode speeds  
listed in the table on page 81 are preselected using the  
SHT ENABLE page of the OPERATION menu.  
By factory default, all available shutter modes and  
shutter speeds are displayed in the sequence shown in  
the following figure. (You can use the SHT ENABLE  
page of the OPERATION menu to make a setting so  
that only the desired (or most frequently used) modes  
and speeds are displayed.)  
speeds” (page 81) for the frequency range which can  
be changed.  
When the RM-B150 Remote Control Unit is  
connected  
You can set the shutter speed of ECS with the rotary  
encoder of the RM-B150.  
Setting the shutter speed in SLS mode  
Proceed as follows.  
82  
5-3 Setting the Electronic Shutter  
 
1 2  
MENU ON/OFF switch  
MENU knob  
Setting the shutter speed in SLS (Slow Speed Shutter) mode  
Changing the range of choice of shutter mode and speed settings  
1
Set the shutter speed mode to SLS.  
1
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON while holding  
down the MENU knob.  
The TOP menu appears.  
SLS: 1/30 : 1FRAME  
Example of viewfinder screen display for SLS setting operation  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
OPERATION.  
2
Turn the MENU knob until the desired number of  
frames appears.  
Press the MENU knob.  
The number of frames can be set to values in the range  
1 to 8, and 16. (1 frame nearly equals to 1/30 second  
(PDW-510/530) or 1/25 second (PDW-510P/530P)).  
If this is the first time the OPERATION menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page of the OPERATION  
menu appears. If the menu has been used before, the  
last accessed page appears.  
Changing the range of choice of shutter  
mode and speed settings  
You can reduce the time required to select the shutter mode  
and speed by narrowing the choice of settings in advance.  
This can be done by using the SHT ENABLE page of the  
OPERATION menu.  
4
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “SHT ENABLE”, then  
press the MENU knob to display the SHT ENABLE  
page.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the SHT ENABLE page appears, then press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
Proceed as follows.  
Note  
The settings selected on the SHT ENABLE page of the  
OPERATION menu become invalid when the RM-B150  
Remote Control Unit is connected to the camcorder.  
17 SHT ENABLE  
SHUTTER SLS  
SHUTTER ECS  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
SHUTTER 1/100  
SHUTTER 1/125  
SHUTTER 1/250  
SHUTTER 1/500  
SHUTTER 1/1000  
SHUTTER 1/2000  
(This menu display is for the PDW-510/530. For the  
PDW-510P/530P, “SHUTTER 1/60” is displayed  
instead of “SHUTTER 1/100”.)  
5-3 Setting the Electronic Shutter  
83  
5
6
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
shutter mode or shutter speed you want, then press the  
MENU knob.  
5-4 Changing the  
Reference Value for  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
Automatic Iris  
Adjustment  
Turn the MENU knob until “ON” appears, then press  
the MENU knob.  
The reference value for automatic iris adjustment can be  
changed to aid the shooting of clear pictures of back-lit  
subjects, or to prevent blown-out highlights. The reference  
value for the lens iris can be set within the following range  
with respect to the standard value.  
The z mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a b mark and the ? mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a z mark.  
To set another mode or speed, return to step 5.  
• 0.5: about 0.5 stop further open  
• 1: about 1 stop further open  
• –0.5: about 0.5 stop further closed  
Note that only the shutter speeds set to “ON” can be  
selected with the SHUTTER selector.  
• –1: about 1 stop further closed  
Also you can set the area where light detection occurs.  
7
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
Changing the reference value  
Proceed as follows.  
The menu disappears from the screen and the display  
indicating the current status of the camcorder appears  
along the top and bottom of the screen.  
1
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
If this is the first time the USER menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page of the USER menu  
appears. If the menu has been used before, the last  
accessed page appears.  
2
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to AUTO IRIS, then press  
the MENU knob to display the AUTO IRIS page.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the AUTO IRIS page appears, then press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “IRIS  
OVERRIDE”, then press the MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
Turn the MENU knob until “ON” appears, then press  
the MENU knob.  
84  
5-4 Changing the Reference Value for Automatic Iris Adjustment  
     
The z mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a b mark and the ? mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a z mark.  
The IRIS OVERRIDE item is set to “ON”.  
5
6
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF.  
The AUTO IRIS page disappears from the screen.  
Opening the lens iris  
Turn the MENU knob to change the reference value.  
Iris opened by 1 stop  
(two bars)  
Note  
Iris opened by 0.5 stop  
(one bar)  
Be sure to confirm that the current shutter mode is not  
ECS.  
The changed reference value is retained until the  
power of the camcorder is turned off.  
Even if the reference value is changed, it reverts to the  
standard value every time the power is turned on.  
Stopping down the lens iris  
Iris stopped down by 1 stop  
(two bars)  
Iris stopped down by 0.5 stop  
(one bar)  
To open the iris by 0.5 stop:  
Turn the MENU knob counterclockwise as seen from  
the front of the camera.  
One bar (s) appears in the upper part to the left of the  
F number in the iris indication.  
Adjusting the reference value for automatic iris adjustment  
When the RM-B150 Remote Control Unit is  
connected  
The IRIS control knob of the RM-B150 can be used for  
lens iris setting. In this case, the bar display (s) does not  
appear.  
To open the iris by 1 stop:  
Turn the MENU knob counterclockwise as seen from  
the front of the camera.  
Two bars (ss) appear in the upper part to the left of  
the F number in the iris indication.  
To stop down the iris by 0.5 stop:  
Turn the MENU knob clockwise as seen from the front  
of the camera.  
Selecting the automatic iris window  
Proceed as follows.  
One bar (s) appears in the lower part to the left of the  
F number in the iris indication.  
1
Follow the procedure of steps 1 and 2 described in the  
previous item “Changing the reference value” to  
display the AUTO IRIS page.  
To stop down the iris by 1 stop:  
Turn the MENU knob further clockwise as seen from  
the front of the camera.  
Two bars (ss) appear in the lower part to the left of  
the F number in the iris indication.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “IRIS  
WINDOW IND”, then press the MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of “IRIS WINDOW IND”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob until “ON” appears, then press  
the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
The currently selected auto iris window appears on the  
screen.  
If it is not necessary to display the auto iris window on  
the screen, set to “OFF”.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “IRIS  
WINDOW”, then press the MENU knob.  
5-4 Changing the Reference Value for Automatic Iris Adjustment  
85  
The b mark changes to a z mark and the z mark  
changes to a ? mark.  
5-5 Adjusting the Audio  
Level  
5
Turn the MENU knob until the desired auto iris  
window appears, then press the MENU knob.  
Setting the AUDIO SELECT CH-1/CH-2 switches to  
AUTO automatically adjusts the input levels of the audio  
signal to be recorded in audio channels 1 and 2. You can  
also adjust the audio level manually.  
The shaded parts indicate the area  
where light detection occurs.  
For the audio level of the signal to be recorded in  
audio channels 3 and 4  
The input levels for audio channels 3 and 4 are either  
automatically adjusted, or are fixed.  
Auto iris window  
The z mark on changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
5-5-1 Manually Adjusting the Audio  
Levels of the Audio Inputs  
From the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2  
Connectors  
If you select “VARIABLE”, the following items  
become effective and you can set the window of the  
desired size. Set each item to the desired size.  
Item  
Setting  
Proceed as follows to adjust the audio levels of the audio  
inputs from the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors, which  
are to be recorded in audio channels 1 and 2.  
IRIS VAR WIDTH The width of the window  
IRIS VAR  
HEIGHT  
The height of the window  
IRIS VAR H POS. The position of the window in the  
horizontal direction  
With the XLR connection automatic detection function  
being on, when a cable is connected to the AUDIO IN CH1  
or CH2 connector, the input from these connectors is  
automatically selected for audio recording. In this case,  
start the operation from step 2.  
IRIS VAR V POS. The position of the window in the  
vertical direction.  
6
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF or close the  
cover of the menu operating section.  
You can turn on and off the XLR connection automatic  
detection function on the AUDIO-1 page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu.  
The menu disappears from the screen and the display  
indicating the current status of the camcorder appears  
along the top and bottom of the screen.  
To counter problems with very bright  
highlights  
If the subject is too bright, the iris may close too much,  
leaving the overall image dark, or the highlights may be  
blown out. In such cases, setting the highlight clip function  
on reduces the luminance range, avoiding problems from  
the automatic iris correction.  
In the AUTO IRIS page of the USER menu, set the CLIP  
HIGH LIGHT item to “ON”.  
3
2
1
MIC LEVEL control  
Manual adjustment of the audio levels of channels 1 and 2  
86  
5-5 Adjusting the Audio Level  
       
1
To adjust the signal input to the AUDIO IN CH1 or  
AUDIO IN CH2 connector, set the AUDIO IN CH-1  
or AUDIO IN CH-2 switch to REAR. To adjust both  
input signals, set both switches to REAR.  
5-5-2 Manually Adjusting the Audio  
Level of the Front Microphone  
You can adjust the audio level input from the front  
microphone connected to the MIC IN connector, which is  
to be recorded on audio channels 1 and 2.  
2
3
Set the AUDIO SELECT switch(es) corresponding to  
the channel(s) selected in step 1 to MANUAL.  
With the LEVEL control for the channel selected in  
step 1, adjust so that the audio level meter shows up to  
–20 dB for a normal input volume.  
Note  
If the XLR connection automatic detection mode is on,  
when the cables are connected to the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2  
connectors, the camcorder detects the connection to the  
AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors. Thus, the AUDIO IN  
switches are internally reset to REAR and the audio signals  
input to the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors are  
automatically selected.  
The second bar from the top may turn on occasionally,  
but do not allow the top bar (0 dB) to go on. If it goes  
on, the audio level is too high.  
Before adjusting the audio level of the front microphone,  
confirm that no cables are connected to the AUDIO IN  
CH1/CH2 connectors. Alternatively, set the REAR XLR  
AUTO item to “OFF” on the AUDIO-1 page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu.  
All bars go on.  
These bars go on.  
Excessive input level  
Normal input level  
Correspondence between recording level  
adjustments and audio level controls  
In the AUDIO-3 page of the MAINTENANCE menu, you  
can select which audio level control controls the audio  
recording level of the input to each of the AUDIO IN CH1/  
CH2 connectors. The correspondence between the controls  
and the menu items and settings is as follows.  
2
Level to be Control  
adjusted  
Menu item Setting  
1
3
Channel-1 LEVEL (CH-1) control REAE1/  
SIDE1  
recording  
level  
(on the left)  
WRR  
LEVEL  
MIC LEVEL control  
FRONT  
F+S1  
1
Set either or both of the AUDIO IN switch(es) to  
FRONT as follows:  
LEVEL (CH-1) control  
is linked with MIC  
LEVEL control.  
When using the front microphone input for both  
channels 1 and 2: Set both AUDIO IN switches to  
FRONT.  
When using the front microphone input for either  
channel 1 or 2: Set the AUDIO IN switch for the  
desired channel to FRONT.  
Channel-2 LEVEL (CH-2) control REAE2/  
SIDE2  
recording  
level  
(on the right)  
WRR  
LEVEL  
MIC LEVEL control  
FRONT  
F+S2  
LEVEL (CH-2) control  
is linked with MIC  
LEVEL control.  
2
3
Set the AUDIO SELECT switch(es) for the desired  
channel(s) selected in step 1 to MANUAL.  
Note  
When you have operation of the LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2)  
controls and MIC LEVEL control linked together, if the  
MIC LEVEL control is set to 0, the audio signals on  
channels 1 and 2 cannot be recorded. Check the position of  
the MIC LEVEL control before adjusting the LEVEL  
(CH-1/CH-2) controls.  
Turn the MIC LEVEL control, and adjust so that the  
audio level meter shows up to –20 dB for a normal  
input volume.  
• The 10 bars from the bottom among 20 bars go on  
with the normal input volume.  
5-5 Adjusting the Audio Level  
87  
   
• The second top bar may turn on occasionally, but do  
not allow the top bar to go on. If it goes on, the audio  
level is too high.  
For fixed settings: select “OFF”.  
Note  
The type of audio recorded on audio channels 3 and 4 does  
not depend on the XLR connection automatic detection  
function. It is determined only by the switch settings.  
Correspondence between recording level  
adjustments and audio level controls  
In the AUDIO-3 page of the MAINTENANCE menu, you  
can select which audio level control controls the audio  
recording level of the front microphone input. The  
correspondence between the controls and the menu items  
and settings is as follows.  
F: The audio signal from the front microphone  
is recorded.  
R: The audio signal input to the AUDIO IN CH1  
connector is recorded.  
W:The audio signal of the wireless microphone  
is recorded.  
Level to be Control  
adjusted  
Menu item Setting  
F: Same as with the CH3 switch.  
R: The audio signal input to the AUDIO IN CH2  
connector is recorded.  
W:Same as with the CH3 switch.  
Channel-1 MIC LEVEL control  
MIC CH1  
LEVEL  
FRONT  
SIDE  
recording  
LEVEL (CH-1) control  
level  
(on the left)  
LEVEL (CH-1) control  
is linked with MIC  
LEVEL control.  
F+S1  
Audio signals to be recorded on audio channels 3 and 4  
Channel-2 MIC LEVEL control  
MIC CH2  
LEVEL  
FRONT  
SIDE2  
recording  
LEVEL (CH-2) control  
level  
(on the right)  
LEVEL (CH-2) control  
is linked with MIC  
LEVEL control.  
F+S1  
Note  
When you have operation of the MIC LEVEL control and  
LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) controls linked together, if the  
LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) controls are set to 0, the audio  
signals on channels 1 and 2 cannot be recorded. Check the  
position of the LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) controls before  
adjusting the MIC LEVEL control.  
5-5-3 Recording Audio on Channels  
3 and 4  
Selecting the recorded audio  
You can select the audio recorded on audio channels 3 and  
4 with the AUDIO IN CH-3/CH-4 switches, or you can  
have the selection made automatically, as follows.  
To automatically select the same audio as on  
channels 1 and 2  
In the AUDIO-1 page of the MAINTENANCE menu, set  
the AUDIO CH3/4 MODE item to “CH 1/2”.  
Adjusting the audio recording levels  
In the AUDIO-2 page of the MAINTENANCE menu, set  
the AU CH34 AGC MODE item as follows.  
For automatic adjustment: select “STREO” or  
“MONO”.  
88  
5-5 Adjusting the Audio Level  
 
Press the RESET button.  
5-6 Setting the Time  
Data  
5
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to F-RUN or R-  
RUN.  
F-RUN: Free run. The time code generator keeps  
running.  
R-RUN: Recording run. The time code generator runs  
only while recording.  
5-6-1 Setting the Time Code  
The time code setting range is from 00 : 00 : 00 : 00 to 23  
: 59 : 59 : 29 (hours : minutes : seconds : frames) for the  
PDW-510/530, and from 00 : 00 : 00 : 00 to 23 : 59 : 59 :  
24 for the PDW-510P/530P.  
To set the drop frame mode/non-drop frame  
mode (only for the PDW-510/530)  
You can select the drop frame (DF) mode or non-drop  
frame (NDF) mode on the FUNCTION 1 page of the  
USER menu or OPERATION menu or on the TIMECODE  
page of the MAINTENANCE menu.  
Note  
When the scan mode is 24P (with the CBK-FC01  
expansion board installed), the value of the least  
significant digit is limited to 0 or 5.  
Note  
When the scan mode is 24P (with the CBK-FC01  
expansion board installed), NDF is selected automatically,  
regardless of the menu setting.  
To set the time code, proceed as follows.  
To make the time code consecutive  
When the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch is set to R-RUN,  
recording a number of scenes on the disc normally  
produces consecutive time code. However, once you  
remove the disc and record on another disc, the time code  
will no longer be contiguous when you use again the  
original disc for recording. In this case, to make the time  
code consecutive, proceed as follows.  
1
RESET  
button  
1
2
Set the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK switch to REGEN.  
Press the RET button on the lens.  
THUMBNAIL  
SEL/SET  
ESSENCE MARK  
S.SEL  
SUB CLIP  
4
This reads the previous recording and synchronizes the  
internal time code generator, thus allowing the new  
time code recorded to follow on consecutively.  
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
2
3
5-6-2 Saving the Actual Time in the  
Time Code  
Setting the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK switch to CLOCK  
saves the actual time in the time code.  
Setting the time code  
When it is necessary to set the actual time, use the TIME/  
DATE page of the DIAGNOSIS menu.  
1
2
3
Set the DISPLAY switch to TC.  
Set the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK switch to PRESET.  
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to SET.  
The first (leftmost) digit of time code flashes.  
5-6-3 Setting the User Bits  
4
Use the SEL/SET dial to set the time code value.  
To change the value of the flashing digit, turn the dial,  
and to shift to the next digit, press the dial. Repeat this  
until all desired digits are set.  
By setting the user bits (up to 8 hexadecimal digits), you  
can record user information such as the date, time, or scene  
number on the time code track.  
To set the user bits, proceed as follows.  
To reset the time code value to 00:00:00:00  
5-6 Setting the Time Data  
89  
                 
regeneration of an external time code. You can also  
synchronize the time code generators of other camcorders/  
VTRs with the internal generator of this camcorder.  
Connections for time code  
synchronization  
Connect both the reference video signal and the external  
time code as illustrated below.  
1
RESET  
button  
Example 1: Synchronizing with an external time code  
THUMBNAIL  
SEL/SET  
S.SEL  
ESSENCE MARK  
SUB CLIP  
3
CLIP MENU  
SHIFT  
F-RUN  
SET  
R-RUN  
PRESET  
REGEN  
CLOCK  
1)  
GENLOCK IN  
Reference video signal  
2,4  
Setting the user bits  
TC IN  
External time code  
1
2
Set the DISPLAY switch to U-BIT.  
1) Set GENLOCK to ON on the GENLOCK page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu, if GENLOCK is set to OFF.  
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to SET.  
The first (leftmost) digit flashes.  
Example 2: Interconnecting a number of camcorders  
for time code synchronization  
3
Use the SEL/SET dial to set the user bit data.  
To change the value of the flashing digit, turn the dial,  
and to shift to the next digit, press the dial. Repeat this  
until all desired digits are set.  
TEST OUT  
TC OUT  
Hexadecimal digits A to F are displayed as follows:  
Reference camcorder  
Hexadecimal  
Display  
A
B
C
D
E
F
TC IN  
A
b
C
d
E
F
1)  
GENLOCK IN  
TC OUT  
To reset the user bit data to 00:00:00:00  
TEST OUT  
Press the RESET button.  
1)  
GENLOCK IN  
4
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to F-RUN or R-  
RUN, corresponding to the desired operating mode for  
the time code generator.  
TC IN  
TC OUT  
TEST OUT  
The set user bit data will be recorded for both LTC and  
VITC.  
To another camcorder to be synchronized  
To store the user bit setting in memory  
The user bit setting (apart from the real time) is  
automatically retained in memory even when the power is  
turned off.  
1) Set GENLOCK to ON on the GENLOCK page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu, if GENLOCK is set to OFF.  
Procedure for time code synchronization  
To synchronize the time code, proceed as follows.  
5-6-4 Synchronizing the Time Code  
You can synchronize the internal time code generator of  
this camcorder with an external generator for the  
90  
5-6 Setting the Time Data  
   
time code cannot be synchronized with the reference  
video signal. In this case, set the GENLOCK item to  
“ON” on the GENLOCK page of the MAINTENANCE  
menu.  
• When the scan mode is 24P (with the CBK-FC01  
expansion board installed), genlock is not established  
even if you connect an external reference time code  
during recording.  
4
3
1
2
User bit settings during time code  
synchronization  
When the time code is synchronized, only the time data is  
synchronized with the external time code value. Therefore,  
the user bits can have their own settings for each  
camcorder.  
You can also synchronize the user bits with external user  
bit data.  
5
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
To release the time code synchronization  
First disconnect the external time code, then set the F-  
RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to R-RUN.  
Synchronizing the time code  
To change the power supply from the battery  
pack to an external power supply during time  
code synchronization  
To maintain a continuous power supply, connect the  
external power supply to the DC IN connector before  
removing the battery pack. You may lose time code  
synchronization if you remove the battery pack first.  
1
2
3
4
5
Turn on the POWER switch.  
Set the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK switch to PRESET.  
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to F-RUN.  
Set the DISPLAY switch to TC.  
Camera synchronization during time code  
synchronization  
During time code synchronization, the camera is  
genlocked to the reference video signal input from the  
GENLOCK IN connector.  
Supply a time code signal and a reference video signal  
complying with the SMPTE (for PDW-510/530) or  
EBU (for PDW-510P/530P) standard and in proper  
phase relationship, to the TC IN connector and to the  
GENLOCK IN connector, respectively.  
This operation synchronizes the internal time code  
generator with the external time code. After about 10  
seconds, you can disconnect the external time code  
without losing the synchronization. However, there  
will be noise on the recorded image if you connect or  
disconnect the time code signal during recording.  
Notes  
• When you finish the above procedure, the internal time  
code is immediately synchronized with the external time  
code and the counter display will show the value of the  
external time code. However, wait for a few seconds  
until the sync generator stabilizes before recording.  
• If the frequency of the reference video signal is not the  
same as the frame frequency of the camcorder, the  
camera cannot be correctly genlocked. In such a case, the  
internal time code is not correctly synchronized with the  
external time code.  
• When the GENLOCK ON/OFF item is set to “OFF” on  
the GENLOCK page of the MAINTENANCE menu, the  
5-6 Setting the Time Data  
91  
?M10 ESSENCE MARK  
TOP  
5-7 Setting the  
Thumbnail Image  
SHOT MARK 1  
SHOT MARK 2  
:
:
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
10  
OVER AUDIO LIMIT :  
GAIN CHG. MARK  
FILTER CHG. MARK :  
SHUTTER CHG. MARK:  
WHITE CHG. MARK  
FLASH MARK  
FLASH MARK LEVEL :  
:
:
:
When the unit is shipped from the factory, it is set up to  
display the first frame of a clip as the clip’s thumbnail  
image (see page 60). As required, you can select another  
frame to display as a clip’s thumbnail image.  
For example, if all clips have the same image in their first  
frames, you can specify a frame a few seconds after the  
start of the clip, so that all thumbnails will not show the  
same image.  
INDEX PIC. POS. :? 0SEC  
7
8
Turn the MENU knob to select the desired time.  
Press the MENU knob.  
The selection is confirmed.  
To select the frame to display as a clip’s  
thumbnail image  
9
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF to end the  
menu operation.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Turn the POWER switch on.  
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch to ON.  
The TOP menu appears.  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“MAINTENANCE”.  
Press the MENU knob.  
If this is the first time the MAINTENANCE menu has  
been displayed, the CONTENTS page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu appears. If the menu has been  
used before, the last accessed page appears.  
5
6
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “ESSENCE MARK”,  
then press the MENU knob.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the ESSENCE MARK page appears, then press  
the MENU knob to select the page.  
Press the MENU knob, then turn it to move the b mark  
to “INDEX PIC.POS.”, and press the MENU knob  
again.  
The b mark changes to a z mark, and the z mark  
changes to a ? mark.  
92  
5-7 Setting the Thumbnail Image  
   
File Operations  
6
Chapter  
6-1 Overview  
root a)  
INDEX.XML  
A remote computer can be connected to this unit and used  
to operate on recorded data which has been saved in data  
files, such as video and audio data files.  
DISCMETA.XML  
There are two way to connect a remote computer.  
• FAM connection  
Clip  
C0001.MXF  
Connect the S400 (i.LINK) connector on this unit to  
the i.LINK (IEEE1394) connector on the remote  
computer, using an i.LINK cable (see page 96).  
• FTP connection  
Connect the network connectors on this unit and the  
remote computer, using a network cable (see page 98).  
C0001M01.XML  
C0002.MXF  
C0002M01.XML  
C0003.MXF  
6-1-1 Directory Structure  
C0003M01.XML  
The following figure shows the directory structure of discs  
visible to a remote computer.  
Edit  
Note  
E0001E01.SMI  
E0001M01.XML  
E0002E01.SMI  
E0002M01.XML  
This structure is not the same as the actual structure  
recorded on the disc.  
Sub  
C0001S01.MXF  
C0002S01.MXF  
C0003S01.MXF  
General  
a) Root directory  
6-1 Overview  
93  
             
6-1-2 File Operation Restrictions  
This section explains which operations are possible on  
files stored in each directory.  
When required, the following operation tables distinguish  
reading and writing from partial reading and writing.  
Read: Read data sequentially from the start to the end of  
the file.  
Partial read: Read only a part of the data in the file.  
Write: Write data sequentially from the start to the end of  
the file.  
Partial write: Write data to a part of the file only.  
Root directory  
File name  
Content  
Operations  
Read/  
Partial read Partial write  
Write/  
Rename  
Create  
Delete  
INDEX.XML  
Contains information about all  
material on the disc.  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
a)  
DISCMETA.XML Contains the disc ID and disc label. Yes  
Other files Files other than the above  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
No  
a) Only files which can be written by XDCAM  
Notes  
• Directories cannot be created in the root directory.  
• The directories in the root directory (Clip, Edit, Sub, and  
General) cannot be deleted or renamed.  
Clip Directory  
File name  
Content  
Operations  
Read/  
Write/  
Rename  
Create  
Delete  
Partial read Partial write  
a)  
b)  
C*.MXF  
Clip file created by recording (MXF Yes  
file)  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
*: 0001 to 0300  
c)  
d)  
e)  
C*M01.XML  
Metadata file generated  
automatically when C*.MXF file is  
created.  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
No  
*: 0001 to 0300  
Other files  
Files other than the above  
No  
No  
a) Only files which are 2 seconds or longer in length, in a format matching  
the line mode format (525/625) and recording format (IMX50/IMX40/  
IMX30/DVCAM and number of audio channels) of the recorded sections  
of the disc, and which can be overwritten by XDCAM.  
b) Only most recently recorded clip  
c) Only files which can be written by XDCAM  
d) When a C*.MXF file is created, a C*M01.XML file with the same number  
is generated automatically.  
e) When a C*.MXF is deleted, the C*M01.XML file with the same number  
is also deleted automatically.  
Note  
Directories cannot be created in the Clip directory.  
Edit Directory  
File name  
Content  
Operations  
Read/  
Write/  
Rename  
Create  
Delete  
Partial read Partial write  
a)  
b)  
c)  
E*E01.SMI  
Clip list file  
*: 0001 to 0099  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
94  
6-1 Overview  
   
File name  
Content  
Operations  
Read/  
Write/  
Rename  
Create  
Delete  
Partial read Partial write  
a)  
d)  
e)  
E*M01.XML  
Metadata file generated  
automatically when E*E01.MXF file  
is created.  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
No  
*: 0001 to 0099  
Other files  
Files other than the above  
No  
No  
a) Only files which can be written by XDCAM. Partial writing is not  
possible.  
e) When an E*E01.MXF is deleted, the E*M01.XML file with the same  
number is also deleted automatically.  
b) Only files which can be written by XDCAM  
c) Only when the write-protect tab on the disc is set to enable recording, and  
when expanded menu item 310 REC INHIBIT is set to “off”.  
d) When an E*E01.MXF file is created, an E*M01.XML file with the same  
number is generated automatically.  
Note  
Directories cannot be created in the Edit directory.  
Sub Directory  
File name  
Content  
Operations  
Read/  
Partial read Partial write  
Write/  
Rename  
Create  
Delete  
a)  
b)  
C*S01.MXF  
Proxy AV data (MXF) file generated Yes  
automatically when a C*.MXF file is  
created.  
No  
No  
No  
No  
*: 0001 to 0300  
Other files  
Files other than the above  
No  
No  
a) When a C*.MXF file is created, a C*S01.MXF file with the same number  
is generated automatically.  
b) When a C*.MXF is deleted, the C*S01.MXF file with the same number is  
also deleted automatically.  
Note  
Directories cannot be created in the Sub directory.  
General Directory  
File name  
Content  
Operations  
Read/  
Partial read Partial write  
Yes Yes  
Write/  
Rename  
Create  
Delete  
a)  
b)  
Any file  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
a) File name up to 63 characters  
b) Only when the write-protect tab on the disc is set to enable recording, and  
when expanded menu item 310 REC INHIBIT is set to “off”.  
The following directory operations are possible in the  
General directory.  
• Directory creation (up to 64 levels, including the  
General directory)  
• Deletion and renaming of directories  
Note  
• The maximum number of files that can be created on one  
disc, including directories, is 5000.  
• The following characters can be used in file names and  
directory names  
0 to 9 (digits), a to z (lowercase alphabetic), A to Z  
(uppercase alphabetic), @ (at mark), (minus), _  
(underscore), . (period), and ~ (tilde).  
6-1 Overview  
95  
The setting is confirmed. The z mark changes to a b  
mark and the ? mark changes to a z mark.  
6-2 File Access Mode  
File Operations  
5
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF to end the  
menu operation.  
File access mode operating environment  
Making FAM connections  
Operating system requirements for file operations by file  
access mode (called FAM below) are as follows.  
Proceed as follows.  
• Computer operating system: Microsoft Windows 2000  
Service Pack 4 or higher, or Microsoft Windows XP  
1
If there is a disc loaded in this unit, put the unit into the  
following state.  
• Recording, playback, search and other disc  
operations: Stopped  
Preparations  
• Thumbnail indicator (see page 31): Off  
• Disc access by DELETE LAST CLIP, DELETE  
ALL CLIPS (see page 48), QUICK FORMAT (see  
page 44), and so on: Stopped  
• Picture Cache function and Interval Rec function:  
Off  
Do the following on the remote computer and this unit.  
• Install the FAM driver on the remote computer.  
• Enable FAM connections over the i.LINK connector.  
To install the FAM driver  
Insert the supplied CD-ROM (Proxy Browsing Software  
PDZ-1) in the CD-ROM drive of the computer and execute  
the Setup.exe file, then follow the installation instructions.  
• MENU ON/OFF switch: OFF  
2
3
If this unit is connected to a remote computer by FTP,  
log out from the FTP session (see page 99).  
For details, refer to the ReadMe file contained on the CD-  
ROM disc.  
Connect the i.LINK DV IN/OUT S400 connector on  
this unit to the i.LINK (IEEE1394) connector on the  
remote computer, using an i.LINK cable.  
To enable FAM connections over the i.LINK  
connector  
Proceed as follows.  
Note  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
The last accessed page appears.  
As the i.LINK cable, use an S400-compliant cable  
which is as short as possible (up to 1.5 m (5 feet)).  
It may not be possible to establish a FAM connection  
if a longer cable is used.  
Turn the MENU knob to scroll to the OUTPUT page,  
then press the MENU knob.  
File data  
The OUTPUT page appears. The current settings  
appear on the right side of each item.  
Transfer of files  
Laptop computer, etc.  
PDW-510/510P/  
530/530P  
3
Move the b mark to “PC REMOTE”, then press the  
MENU knob.  
The b mark changes to a z mark, and the z mark  
changes to a ? mark.  
i.LINK cable (not supplied)  
U01 OUTPUT  
TOP  
LCD BRIGHT <L>  
LCD BRIGHT <H>  
LCD COLOR  
:
:
:
0
0
0
Windows recognizes this unit as a removable disc, and  
displays one of the following icons on the remote  
computer’s task bar:  
PC REMOTE  
REAR BNC OUT SEL:  
:
DSABL  
VBS  
• Windows 2000:  
• Windows XP:  
The remote computer is now able to perform file  
operations when a disc is inserted into this unit.  
4
Turn the MENU knob to select ENABL, then press the  
MENU knob.  
96  
6-2 File Access Mode File Operations  
       
Operation limitations during FAM connections  
• With the exception of the EJECT button, recording  
buttons and playback control buttons are disabled.  
• VDR of this unit cannot be controlled from devices  
connected to the REMOTE connector (8-pin) and S400  
(i.LINK) connector.  
Windows XP: The Safely Remove Hardware dialog  
appears.  
2
3
Select “Sony XDCAM PDW-530 (or 530p/510/510P)  
IEEE 1394 SBP2 Device” and click Stop.  
The Stop a Hardware device dialog appears.  
• There is no signal output from this unit while video is  
being input to this unit from external equipment.  
Select “Sony XDCAM PDW-530 (or 530p/510/510P)  
IEEE 1394 SBP2 Device” and click OK.  
Operating on files  
Proceed as follows.  
Windows 2000: A confirmation message appears.  
Windows XP: “Sony XDCAM PDW-530 (or 530p/  
510/510P) IEEE 1394 SBP2 Device” is deleted from  
the Hardware devices list.  
1
Start Explorer.  
Check that a drive letter has been assigned to this unit.  
(The drive letter will differ depending on the number  
of other peripherals connected to the remote  
computer.)  
This unit can now resume normal operations. (The  
limitations described in “Operation limitations during  
FAM connections” (see page 97) no longer apply.)  
4
Disconnect the i.LINK cable as required.  
2
Use Explorer to perform file operations on the disc  
loaded in this unit.  
Reconnecting  
To reconnect after exiting file operations, do one of the  
following, depending on whether an i.LINK cable is  
connected.  
You can operate in the same way that you operate on  
local drives and files on network computers.  
Notes  
i.LINK cable is not connected: Connect this unit and a  
remote computer with an i.LINK cable.  
i.LINK cable is connected: Disconnect the i.LINK cable  
from either this unit or the remote computer, wait for  
at least 10 seconds, and then reconnect the  
disconnected cable.  
• If you power this unit off during an FAM  
connection, the data transferred thus far is discarded.  
• All file operations are not possible for some types of  
files.  
The unit is powered off and an i.LINK cable is  
connected: Power the unit on.  
To eject discs from a remote computer  
Right click the icon representing this unit in Explorer, and  
select Eject from the menu which appears.  
To disable FAM connections  
Execute one of the procedures described in the previous  
section “Reconnecting” to make a FAM connection  
between this unit and the remote computer. To disable  
FAM connections, set the menu item PC REMOTE to  
“DSABL.”  
Exiting file operations  
Proceed as follows.  
Note  
For more information about how to make this setting, see  
Do not disconnect the cable before performing steps 1 to 3.  
1
Do one of the following on the  
displayed in the remote computer’s taskbar.  
or  
icon  
• Double click.  
• Right click, and select one of the following  
commands from the menu which appears.  
- Windows 2000: Unplug or eject hardware  
- Windows XP: Safely Remove Hardware  
Windows 2000: The Unplug or Eject Hardware  
dialog appears.  
6-2 File Access Mode File Operations  
97  
   
To log in  
If this unit is connected to a remote computer with a FAM  
connection, first exit file operations on the FAM  
connection (see page 97).  
6-3 FTP File Operations  
File operations between this unit and a remote computer  
can be carried out by the File Transfer Protocol (called  
FTP below).  
1
Load a disc into this unit and put the unit into the  
following state.  
• Recording, playback, serch, and other disc  
operations: Stopped  
• Thumbnail indicator (see page 31): Off  
• Picture Cache function and Interval Rec function:  
Off  
A CBK-NC01 Network Adaptor (option) is required to  
enable file operations by FTP.  
For installation and use, see the Installation Manual  
supplied with the CBK-NC01.  
• MENU ON/OFF switch: OFF  
Preparations  
Note  
Login is not possible unless the unit is in the state  
described above.  
1
Connect the network connectors of this unit and a  
remote computer with a network cable. Or connect this  
unit to the network to which the remote computer is  
connected.  
2
3
Start the command prompt.  
Enter “ftp <SP> <IP address>,” and press the Enter  
key. (<SP> refers to a space.)  
File data  
For example, if the IP address of this unit is set to  
192.168.001.010, enter “ftp 192.168.1.10.”  
Transfer of files  
PDW-510/510P/  
530/530P  
Laptop computer, etc.  
Refer to the Windows help for more information about  
the FTP command.  
If the connection succeeds, you are prompted to enter  
a user name.  
1)  
Network cable (Cross cable, not supplied)  
4
5
Enter the user name “admin” and press the Enter key.  
1)To make connections to the LAN through a hub, use straight type  
network cables (not supplied).  
When the user name is verified, your are prompted to  
enter a password.  
2
3
Set the IP address and other network setting items for  
this unit.  
Enter the password and press the Enter key.  
The password is set to “pdw-530 (or 510)” when the  
unit is shipped from the factory.  
The login is complete when the password is verified.  
If network settings have already been made  
Check the IP address of this unit.  
commands supported by this unit.  
Set the remote control switch to NETWORK.  
If the connection times out  
This unit terminates FTP connections if no command  
is received within 90 seconds of the last command. If  
this occurs, log out (see the next section) and repeat  
steps 2 to 4.  
Making FTP connections  
FTP connections between this unit and a remote computer  
can be made with either of the following.  
• The command prompt  
• FTP client software  
Note  
If you power this unit off during an FTP connection,  
the data transferred thus far is discarded.  
This section explains how to use the command prompt. For  
more information about using FTP client software, refer to  
the documentation of the FTP client software on your  
system.  
98  
6-3 FTP File Operations  
   
To log out  
To log out after finishing file operations, enter “QUIT” at  
the command prompt and press the Enter key.  
6-3 FTP File Operations  
99  
 
6-3-1 Command List  
This unit supports standard FTP commands (see the next  
section), and extended FTP commands (see page 104).  
Standard commands  
The following table shows the standard FTP commands  
supported by this unit.  
In the command syntax column, <SP> means a space,  
entered by pressing the space bar, and <CRLF> means a  
new line, entered by pressing the Enter key.  
Command name  
Description  
Command syntax  
USER  
Send this command to begin the login USER <SP> <username> <CRLF>  
process.  
Input example: USER admin  
PASS  
QUIT  
PORT  
After sending the USER command,  
send this command to complete the  
login process.  
PASS <SP> <password> <CRLF>  
Input example: PASS pdw-530 (or 510)  
Terminates the FTP connection. If a file QUIT <CRLF>  
is being transferred, terminates after  
completion of the transfer.  
Specifies the IP address and port to  
which this unit should connect for the  
next file transfer (for data transfer from  
this unit).  
PORT <SP> <h1,h2,h3,h4,p1,p2> <CRLF>  
• h1 (most significant byte) to h4 (least significant byte): IP  
address  
• p1 (most significant byte), p2 (least significant byte): Port  
address  
Input example: PORT 10,0,0,1,242,48  
(IP address: 10.0.0.1, Port number: 62000)  
PASV  
TYPE  
This command requests this unit to  
“listen” on a data port (which is not its  
default data port). It puts this unit into  
passive mode, waiting for the remote  
computer to make a data connection.  
PASV <CRLF>  
Specifies the type of data to be  
transferred.  
TYPE <SP> <type-code (options delimited by <SP>)>  
<CRLF>  
<type-code> can be any of the following. However, for  
XDCAM, data is always transferred as “I,” regardless of the  
type-code specification.  
• A: ASCII  
- N: Non-print (default)  
- T: Telnet format  
- C: ASA Carriage Control  
• E: EBCDIC  
- N: Non-print  
- T: Telnet format  
- C: ASA Carriage Control  
• I: IMAGE (Binary)  
• L: LOCAL BYTE  
- SIZE: byte size  
Input example: TYPE I  
100  
6-3 FTP File Operations  
   
Command name  
Description  
Command syntax  
STRU  
Specifies the data structure.  
STRU <SP> <structure-code> <CRLF>  
<structure-code> can be any of the following. However, for  
XDCAM, the structure is always “F,” regardless of the  
structure-code specification.  
• F: File structure (default)  
• R: Record structure  
• P: Page structure  
Input example: STRU F  
MODE  
Specifies the transfer mode.  
MODE <SP> <mode-code> <CRLF>  
<mode-code> can be any of the following. However, for  
XDCAM, the mode is always “S,” regardless of the mode-  
code specification.  
• S: Stream mode (default)  
• B: Block mode  
• C: Compressed mode  
Input example: MODE S  
LIST  
Sends a list of files from this unit to the LIST <SP> <options> <SP> <path-name> <CRLF>  
remote computer.  
<options> can be any of the following.  
• -a: Also display file names that begin with “.”  
• -F: Append “/” to directory names.  
The following data is transferred, depending on whether  
<path-name> specifies a directory or file.  
• Directory specified: A list of the files in the specified  
directory  
• File specified: Information about the specified file  
• No specification: A list of the files in the current directory.  
The wildcard characters “*” (any string) and “?” (any  
character) may be used in <path-name>.  
Input example 1: LIST -a Clip  
Input example 2: LIST Clip/*.MXF  
NLST  
Sends a list of file names from this unit NLST <SP> <options or path-name> <CRLF>  
to the remote computer, with no other  
information.  
The following options may be specified when no path name  
is specified.  
• -a: Also display file names that begin with “.”  
• -l: Display information other than file name (gives the same  
result as the LIST command).  
• -F: Append “/” to directory names.  
The following data is transferred, depending on whether  
<path-name> specifies a directory or file.  
• Directory specified: A list of the file names only in the  
specified directory  
• No specification: A list of the file names only in the current  
directory.  
The wildcard characters “*” (any string) and “?” (any  
character) may be used in <path-name>.  
Input example 1: NLST l  
Input example 2: NLST Clip/*.MXF  
RETR  
Begins transfer of a copy of a file in the RETR <SP> <path-name> <CRLF>  
specified path on this unit to the current  
directory on the remote computer.  
Input example: RETR Clip/C0001.MXF  
6-3 FTP File Operations  
101  
Command name  
Description  
Command syntax  
STOR  
Begins transfer of a copy of a file in the STOR <SP> <path-name> <CRLF>  
specified path on the remote computer  
to the current directory on this unit.  
Depending on the type of file  
transferred, the following items are  
created.  
Input example: STOR Data/E0001E01.SMI  
• C*.MXF file  
- C*M01.XML file (metadata)  
- C*S01.MXF file (proxy AV data)  
- UMID (The UMID of the copy  
source file is not saved. However, it  
is saved if an immediately  
preceding SITE UMMD extended  
command has been issued.)  
• E*E01.SMI file  
- E*M01.XML file (metadata)  
*: 0001 to 0300  
Notes  
• For C*.MXF files, some data, such as  
file header metadata, may be  
missing.  
• Depending on the transfer  
destination directory and the file type,  
transfer may not be possible.  
RNFR  
RNTO  
Rename a file. Specify the file to be  
renamed with the RNFR command,  
and specify the new name with the  
RNTO command. (Always follow a  
RNFR command with a RNTO  
command.)  
RNFR <SP> <path-name (before change)> <CRLF>  
RNTO <SP> <path-name (after change)> <CRLF>  
Input example: RNFR General/info.txt  
RNTO General/clip_info.txt  
Note  
Files in directories other than the  
General directory cannot be renamed.  
DELE  
Deletes the specified file on this unit.  
DELE <SP> <path-name> <CRLF>  
Input example: DELE Clip/C0099.MXF  
Note  
Depending on the directory and file  
type, deletion may not be possible.  
102  
6-3 FTP File Operations  
Command name  
Description  
Command syntax  
STAT  
Sends information about properties of STAT <SP> <path-name> <CRLF>  
the specified file, or about data transfer  
status, from this unit to the remote  
computer.  
The following property information is  
sent, depending on the file type.  
• MXF file  
The following data is transferred, depending on whether a file  
is specified with <path-name>.  
• File specified: The properties of the specified file  
• No specification: The size of the data transferred thus far  
(unit: bytes)  
- File name  
- File type  
Input example: STAT Clip/C0001.MXF  
- CODEC type  
- Frame rate  
- Number of audio channels  
- Duration  
• non-MXF file  
- File name  
ABOR  
Requests this unit to abort a file  
transfer currently in progress.  
ABOR <CRLF>  
SYST  
HELP  
Displays the system name of this unit. SYST <CRLF>  
Displays a list of the commands  
HELP <SP> <command-name> <CRLF>  
supported by this unit, or an  
explanation of the specified command. The following data is transferred, depending on whether a  
command name is specified with <command-name>.  
• Command name specified: Explanation of the specified  
command.  
• No specification: Command list  
Input example: HELP RETR  
NOOP  
Does nothing except return a response. NOOP <CRLF>  
(Used to check whether this unit is  
running.)  
PWD  
CWD  
Displays the current directory (“/” if the PWD <CRLF>  
directory is the root directory).  
Changes the current directory (moves CWD <SP> <path-name> <CRLF>  
from the current directory to another  
directory).  
Moves to a directory as follows, depending on whether a  
directory is specified with <path-name>.  
• Directory specified: To the specified directory  
• No specification: To the root directory  
Input example: CWD General  
CDUP <CRLF>  
CDUP  
MKD  
Moves one level up in the directory  
structure (makes the parent of the  
current directory be the current  
directory).  
Creates a new directory.  
MKD <SP> <path-name> <CRLF>  
RMD <SP> <path-name> <CRLF>  
Note  
Directories can be created only in the  
General directory.  
RMD  
Deletes a directory.  
Note  
Directories can be deleted only in the  
General directory.  
6-3 FTP File Operations  
103  
Extended commands  
The following table shows the extended FTP commands  
supported by this unit.  
In the command syntax column, <SP> means a space,  
entered by pressing the space bar, and <CRLF> means a  
new line, entered by pressing the Enter key.  
Command name  
Description  
Command syntax  
SITE REPF  
Sends an MXF file from the specified  
path on this unit to the remote  
SITE REPF <SP> <path-name> <SP> <start-frame> <SP>  
<transfer-size> <CRLF>  
computer. This command allows you to  
specify a segment in the body of the  
<start-frame> specifies an offset from the start of the file.  
MXF file (composed of video and audio Data is transferred from the video frame at the offset (the first  
data), for transfer of the required  
segment only.  
frame is 0).  
<transfer-size> specifies the number of video frames to  
transfer (specify 0 to transfer to the end of the file).  
Note  
Input example: SITE REPF Clip/C0001.MXF 5 150 (Transfer  
C0001.MXF. Body data is transferred only from frame 6 to  
frame 155.)  
A segment greater than the file size  
cannot be specified.  
SITE FSTS  
Acquires the system status of this unit. SITE FSTS <CRLF>  
One of the following status codes is  
sent.  
0: Initial state, or no disc is loaded.  
1: File system mount is OK.  
3: File system mount is not OK.  
SITE MEID  
SITE FUNC  
Acquires the media ID of the disc  
loaded in this unit.  
SITE MEID <CRLF>  
Acquires the function and version of the SITE FUNC <CRLF>  
expanded commands.  
Information is sent in the following  
format.  
<main function> <SP> <branch  
function> <SP> <branch function  
version>  
For XDCAM, sent in a format like “200  
MXF DISK 1” (200 is a response code).  
SITE UMMD  
When C*.MXF file (*: 0001 to 0300) is SITE UMMD <CRLF>  
sent with the STOR, the copy source  
UMID is saved if this command is  
invoked immediately before the STOR  
command.  
104  
6-3 FTP File Operations  
 
Menu Displays and  
Detailed Settings  
7
Chapter  
For details of customizing the USER menu, see 7-1-4  
7-1 Menu Organization  
and Operation  
TOP menu  
The TOP menu consists of the following submenus.  
<TOP MENU>  
7-1-1 Menu Organization  
USER  
USER MENU CUSTOMIZE  
ALL  
The following shows the organization of menus that you  
can use to make various settings and adjustments.  
OPERATION  
PAINT  
MAINTENANCE  
FILE  
DIAGNOSIS  
TOP MENU  
USER  
00.CONTENTS  
01.OUTPUT  
The USER menu consists of  
the pages shown on the right.  
If required, you can add,  
When you select an item in the TOP menu, this displays  
the most recently shown page of the corresponding  
submenu. When the submenu is selected for the first time,  
the 00 CONTENTS page appears.  
02.TEST OUT  
03.FUNCTION 1  
04.VF DISP 1  
05.VF DISP 2  
06.'!'LED  
delete, or rearrange pages  
1)  
(USER menu customization).  
In this case the number, for  
example, 01, also changes.  
07.MARKER 1  
08.GAIN SW  
09.VF SETTING  
10.AUTO IRIS  
11.SHOT ID  
Submenus selected in the TOP menu  
These are the following menus.  
• USER menu:  
This menu includes monitor output settings, viewfinder  
settings, and commonly used functions. This menu is  
normally displayed when the MENU ON/OFF switch is  
changed to ON.  
12.SHOT DISP  
13.SET STATUS  
14.LENS FILE  
15.USER FILE  
This menu used to  
add or delete pages in  
the USER group.  
USER MENU CUSTOMIZE  
ALL  
• USER MENU CUSTOMIZE menu:  
This menu allows you to add pages to or delete pages from  
the USER menu to suit your needs.  
• Each menu consists of pages 00  
CONTENTS, 01 xxx, 02 xxx, and  
so on.  
• You can select the desired items  
from these menus to create new  
pages, which you can add to the  
USER menu.  
OPERATION  
PAINT  
• ALL menu:  
MAINTENANCE  
FILE  
This menu contains all items of the OPERATION menu,  
PAINT menu, MAINTENANCE menu, FILE menu and  
DIAGNOSIS menu.  
DIAGNOSIS  
1) In this manual, the USER menu consisting of items and pages registered  
at the factory is used.  
7-1 Menu Organization and Operation  
105  
           
• OPERATION menu:  
Displaying menus on the color LCD  
With the camcorder powered on, proceed as follows.  
This menu contains items for changing settings according  
to conditions related to the subject when the camcorder is  
being operated.  
1
2
Open the cover of the menu operating section, and set  
the MENU ON/OFF switch to the ON position.  
• PAINT menu  
This menu contains items for making detailed image  
adjustments while using a waveform monitor to monitor  
the waveforms output by the camera. Support of a video  
engineer is usually required to use this menu. Although  
you can also use an external remote control panel or master  
setup unit to set the items on this menu, this menu is  
effective when using the camcorder by itself outdoors.  
Set the DISP SEL switch at the lower left of the color  
LCD to CHAR.  
This displays menus on the color LCD.  
In the remainder of this section, the viewfinder display is  
generally shown as an example menu display, but the  
display on the color LCD is similar.  
• MAINTENANCE menu  
This menu contains items for performing camera  
maintenance operations, such as changing the VDR  
system or using infrequently used “paint” items.  
7-1-3 Basic Menu Operations  
When you open the cover of the menu operating section,  
the MENU ON/OFF switch appears. If the MENU ON/  
OFF switch is set to ON, the USER menu is displayed on  
the screen. Closing the cover automatically sets the MENU  
ON/OFF switch to OFF.  
• FILE menu  
This menu is for performing file operations, such as  
writing the reference file.  
• DIAGNOSIS menu  
This menu enables you to confirm the VDR status or  
identify a failed circuit board.  
7-1-2 Displaying Menus  
The camcorder can display menus both on the viewfinder  
screen and on the color LCD.  
Viewfinder  
CANCEL/PRST /  
ESCAPE switch  
MENU ON/OFF  
switch  
ColorLCD  
DISP SEL  
switch  
Cover of the menu  
MENU knob  
operating section  
The MENU ON/OFF switch  
is inside the cover.  
Controls used for the basic use of the menu oerations  
POWER switch  
Displaying the TOP menu  
Hold down the MENU button, and move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch from the OFF to the ON position.  
Displaying menus on the viewfinder screen  
When the camcorder is powered on, open the cover of the  
menu operating section, and set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to the ON position.  
This displays menus on the viewfinder screen, regardless  
of the ON/OFF setting of the viewfinder DISPLAY  
switch.  
Note  
Depending on the internal switch settings, display of the  
TOP menu may be disabled.  
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
106  
7-1 Menu Organization and Operation  
         
2
3
Turn the MENU knob until the desired page appears.  
Press the MENU knob.  
Returning to the TOP menu from other  
menus  
There are two methods.  
• Align the b mark with “TOP” at the top right of the  
menu page, and press the MENU knob.  
• Push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch down to the  
ESCAPE position repeatedly until the TOP menu  
appears.  
A b mark appears on the left of the item currently  
selected on the page.  
U08 GAIN SW  
TOP  
GAIN LOW  
GAIN MID  
GAIN HIGH  
GAIN TURBO  
:
:
:
:
0db  
9db  
18db  
42db  
Menu operations in the USER menu  
TURBO SW IND.  
:
OFF  
This section explains operations on the USER menu. But  
the operations are the same as those on menus other than  
the USER menu. Also, if the optional extension boards are  
not installed in your camcorder, some items on the USER  
menu pages are not displayed. But the operations are the  
same as those on the menus other than the USER menu.  
To carry out menu operations in the USER menu, proceed  
as follows.  
4
5
Turn the move MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired item.  
• Turning the MENU knob counterclockwise as seen  
from the front of the camera moves the b mark up  
continuously.  
• Turning the MENU knob clockwise as seen from the  
front of the camera moves the b mark down  
continuously.  
1
Switch the MENU ON/OFF switch from OFF to ON.  
The USER menu normally appears. If it does not, in  
the TOP menu select USER, and press the MENU  
knob.  
Press the MENU knob.  
U03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
OFF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL REC:  
U08 GAIN SW  
TOP  
GAIN LOW  
GAIN MID  
GAIN HIGH  
GAIN TURBO  
:
:
0db  
9db  
:? 18db  
:
42db  
TURBO SW IND.  
:
OFF  
(For the PDW-530P/510P, the DF/NDF item is not  
included.)  
If the USER menu has been used before, the last  
accessed page appears. In this case, go to step 2.  
If this is the first time the USER menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page of the USER menu  
appears. In this case, follow the procedure below.  
6
Turn the MENU knob to change the setting.  
Before going to the next step, you can cancel a change  
or return to the standard settings. For this operation,  
1 Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired page number.  
To interrupt changing the settings  
This indicates that  
the menu screen  
can be scrolled.  
By setting the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF, the  
menu disappears from the screen. By setting the  
MENU ON/OFF switch to ON again, the values that  
were displayed when you interrupted the setting  
operations will reappear so you can continue making  
settings.  
U00 CONTENTS  
TOP  
01.OUTPUT  
02.TEST OUT  
03.FUNCTION 1  
04.VF DISP 1  
05.VF DISP 2  
06.'!'LED  
07.MARKER 1  
08.GAIN SW  
09.VF SETTING  
10.AUTO IRIS  
b mark  
7
Press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark. The setting is confirmed.  
2 Press the MENU knob.  
The selected page is displayed. Go to step 4.  
7-1 Menu Organization and Operation  
107  
8
To continue setting other items in the same page,  
repeat steps from 4 to 7.  
• Close the cover of the menu operating section. When  
you close the cover, the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to  
OFF automatically.  
The menu disappears from the screen, and the display  
indicating the current status of the camcorder appears  
along the top and bottom of the screen (when the  
viewfinder DISPLAY switch is set to ON or the VF DISP  
item on the VF DISP 1 page of the USER menu is set to  
“ON”).  
To cancel a change or return to the standard  
settings  
Proceed as follows.  
1
Before pressing the MENU button in step 7 of the  
above procedure, push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE  
switch up to the CANCEL/PRST position.  
For details of the viewfinder display , see 7-2-2 “Selecting  
Under the page name, a message “CANCEL DATA  
OK?” appears.  
2
3
Push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch up to the  
CANCEL/PRST position once more.  
7-1-4 Editing the USER Menu  
The USER MENU CUSTOMIZE menu allows you to  
configure a USER menu that consists only of pages and  
items that you need by adding, deleting or replacing the  
pages.  
A message “CANCEL DATA” appears to indicate that  
the change has been cancelled.  
To return to the standard settings, push the CANCEL/  
PRST / ESCAPE switch up to the CANCEL/PRST  
position.  
Adding a new page  
The USER MENU CUSTOMIZE menu allows you to add  
a new page to the USER menu.  
A message “PRESET DATA OK?” appears on the  
screen.  
While the EDIT page contains factory-preset items, the  
USER 1 EDIT to USER 19 EDIT pages and the ASSIGN  
SEL EDIT page are all blank in their initial state. You can  
register up to 10 items, including blank lines, on each of  
these pages.  
4
Push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch up to the  
CANCEL/PRST position once more.  
This returns to the standard settings.  
To add a new page, proceed as follows.  
Depending on the setting item, in some cases only the  
function to return to the standard setting is valid. Check  
this for each individual item.  
1
2
While holding down the MENU knob, move the  
MENU ON/OFF switch from the OFF position to the  
ON position.  
To move to another page  
Proceed as follows.  
The TOP menu appears.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “USER  
MENU CUSTOMIZE”, then press the MENU knob.  
1
Turn the MENU knob to move the b arrow to the page  
number, then press the MENU knob.  
If this is the first time the USER MENU CUSTOMIZE  
menu has been displayed, the CONTENTS page of the  
menu appears.  
If the b mark is placed at a position other than the page  
number, push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch  
to ESCAPE.  
A ? mark appears in front of the page number. The  
camcorder is now in page selecting mode.  
U00 CONTENTS  
TOP  
01.EDIT PAGE  
02.USER 1  
03.USER 2  
04.USER 3  
05.USER 4  
06.USER 5  
07.USER 6  
08.USER 7  
09.USER 8  
10.USER 9  
EDIT  
EDIT  
EDIT  
EDIT  
EDIT  
EDIT  
EDIT  
EDIT  
EDIT  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob until the desired page appears.  
Press the MENU knob when the desired page appears.  
To end menu operations  
You can end menu operations using the following two  
methods:  
• Turn the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF.  
If the USER MENU CUSTOMIZE menu has been  
used before, the last accessed page appears.  
3
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to one of USER 1 EDIT to  
108  
7-1 Menu Organization and Operation  
     
USER 19 EDIT and ASSIGN SEL EDIT, then press  
the MENU knob to display the page.  
You can add up to 10 items on one page.  
Deleting items from a page by using the CANCEL/  
PRST / ESCAPE switch  
You can delete items from any of the USER 1 EDIT to  
USER 19 EDIT pages. Proceed as follows.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the desired page appears, then press the MENU  
knob to select the page.  
Example: When you select the USER 2 EDIT page  
1
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
to be deleted.  
U03 USER 2 EDIT  
TOP  
Push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch to  
CANCEL/PRST.  
The message “PRESET DATA OK?” appears.  
3
Push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch to  
CANCEL/PRST again.  
The item is deleted.  
4
Move the b mark to the item to be added (this  
operation is unnecessary, if no item exists on the page  
as shown in the figure for step 3), then press the  
MENU knob.  
Deleting items from a page by using the menu  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Move the b mark to the item to be deleted, and press  
The EDIT FUNCTION page appears.  
the MENU knob.  
EDIT FUNCTION  
INSERT  
MOVE  
ESC  
The EDIT FUNCTION page appears.  
Select “DELETE”, and press the MENU knob.  
DELETE  
BLANK  
The previously displayed page appears again, and the  
message “DELETE OK? Yes b No” appears at the  
upper right.  
3
To delete, turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
5
Move the b mark to “INSERT”, and press the MENU  
“YES”, and press the MENU knob.  
knob.  
Replacing items on a page  
You can replace the items on any of the USER 1 EDIT to  
USER 5 EDIT pages. Proceed as follows.  
The page for the last added item appears.  
P25 BLACK/FLARE  
ESC  
MASTER BLACK  
R GLACK  
B BLACK  
MASTER FLARE  
R FLARE  
G FLARE  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ON  
1
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
to be replaced, then press the MENU knob.  
The EDIT FUNCTION page appears.  
B FLARE  
FLARE  
TEST OUT SELECT :  
ENC  
2
3
Select MOVE, then press the MENU knob.  
The previously displayed page appears again.  
6
7
Add the items.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
position where you want to move the item, then press  
the MENU knob.  
1 Turn the MENU knob until the page that has the  
desired items appears, then press the MENU knob.  
2 Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired item, then press the MENU knob.  
The USER P2 EDIT page appears again,  
displaying the newly added item.  
Add the remaining items by repeating steps 4 to 6.  
7-1 Menu Organization and Operation  
109  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the EDIT PAGE screen appears, then press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
E02 USER 1 EDIT  
WHITE<B>CH  
TOP  
AWB  
OFF  
:
:
TEST OUT MENU  
E01 EDIT PAGE  
TOP  
OFFSET WHITE <A>:  
OFF  
3200  
0
WARM COOL  
COLOR FINE  
MASTER BLACK  
<A>:  
<A>:  
:
01.OUTPUT  
02.TEST OUT  
03.FUNCTION 1  
04.VF DISP 1  
05.VF DISP 2  
06.'!'LED  
0
07.MARKER 1  
08.GAIN SW  
09.VF SETTING  
10.AUTO IRIS  
The item selected in step 1 moves to the position that  
you selected in step 3.  
In the above example, “MASTER BLACK” is moved  
to the top and the other items are moved down one line.  
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to where  
you want to add the page, then press the MENU knob.  
Inserting a blank line  
You can insert a blank line above the selected item.  
Proceed as follows.  
The EDIT FUNCTION page appears.  
EDIT FUNCTION  
INSERT  
MOVE  
DELETE  
BLANK  
ESC  
1
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
above which you want to insert a blank line.  
The EDIT FUNCTION page appears.  
2
Select “BLANK”, and press the MENU knob.  
The previously displayed page appears again, and a  
blank line is inserted above the specified item.  
5
6
Select INSERT, and press the MENU knob.  
The selection screen appears.  
Note  
You cannot insert a blank line on a page where 10 items  
have already been registered.  
CONTENTS  
ESC  
01.USER PAGE 1  
02.USER PAGE 2  
03.USER PAGE 3  
04.USER PAGE 4  
05.USER PAGE 5  
06.USER PAGE 6  
07.USER PAGE 7  
08.USER PAGE 8  
09.USER PAGE 9  
Adding/deleting/replacing pages  
You can add a new page to the USER menu, delete a page  
from the USER menu or replace pages, using the EDIT  
PAGE of the USER MENU CUSTOMIZE menu.  
To add a page  
Proceed as follows.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired page, then press the MENU knob.  
1
While holding down the MENU knob, move the  
MENU ON/OFF switch from the OFF position to the  
ON position.  
This adds the number and name of the selected page  
above the item selected in step 4.  
The TOP menu appears.  
To cancel adding a page  
Before pressing the MENU knob in step 6, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “ESC” at the top right of the  
screen, then press the MENU knob.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “USER  
MENU CUSTOMIZE”, then press the MENU knob.  
The EDIT PAGE screen appears again.  
If this is the first time the USER MENU CUSTOMIZE  
menu has been displayed, the CONTENTS page of the  
menu appears. If the menu has been used before, the  
last accessed page appears.  
To delete a page by using the CANCEL/PRST /  
ESCAPE switch  
Proceed as follows.  
3
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “EDIT PAGE”, then press  
the MENU knob to display the EDIT PAGE screen.  
1
Open the EDIT PAGE and turn the MENU knob to  
move the b mark to the page to be deleted.  
110  
7-1 Menu Organization and Operation  
2
3
Push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch to  
CANCEL/PRST.  
E01 EDIT PAGE  
PUSH TO PAGE INSERT  
01.OUTPUT  
02.TEST OUT  
03.FUNCTION 1  
04.VF DISP 1  
05.'!'LED  
06.MARKER 1  
07.GAIN SW  
08.VF SETTING  
09.AUTO IRIS  
The message “PRESET DATA OK?” appears.  
E01 EDIT PAGE  
DELETE PAGE OK ?  
01.OUTPUT  
02.TEST OUT  
03.FUNCTION 1  
04.VF DISP 1  
05.VF DISP 2  
06.'!'LED  
07.MARKER 1  
08.GAIN SW  
09.VF SETTING  
10.AUTO IRIS  
4
Press the MENU knob.  
The page selected in step 1 is moved to the position  
selected in step 3.  
In the above example,”AUTO IRIS” moves to the  
“04” position and the “VF DISP 1” and following  
items move down one line.  
Push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch to  
CANCEL/PRST again.  
In the above example, the VF DISP 2 page is deleted.  
To delete a page by using the menu  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
3
On the EDIT PAGE screen of the USER MENU  
CUSTOMIZE menu, move the b mark to the page to  
be deleted, and press the MENU knob.  
The EDIT FUNCTION page appears.  
Select DELETE, and press the MENU knob.  
The previously displayed page appears again, and the  
message “DELETE PAGE OK?” appears at the upper  
right.  
To delete, turn the menu knob to move the b mark to  
“YES”, and press the MENU knob.  
To move a page  
Proceed as follows.  
1
Display the EDIT PAGE screen of the USER MENU  
CUSTOMIZE menu. Turn the MENU knob to move  
the b mark to the page that you want to move.  
The EDIT FUNCTION page appears.  
2
3
Select MOVE, then press the MENU knob.  
The EDIT PAGE screen appears again.  
Turn MENU knob to move the b mark to the position  
to where you want to move the page selected in step 1.  
7-1 Menu Organization and Operation  
111  
b Zoom position  
This indicator appears only when you use a lens that has a  
7-2 Status Display on  
the Viewfinder  
Screen  
zoom position display function. It indicates the  
1)  
approximate position of the variator of the zoom lens,  
between wide angle and telephoto.  
1) Variator  
A group of lenses that are moved to adjust the focal length.  
The viewfinder screen displays not only the video picture  
but also characters and messages indicating the camcorder  
settings and operating status, a center marker, a safety zone  
marker, etc.  
When the MENU ON/OFF switch is set to OFF and the  
DISPLAY switch is set to ON, the items for which an  
“ON” setting was made in the VF DISP1 page of the  
USER menu or with related switches are displayed at the  
top and bottom of the screen. The messages that give  
details of the settings and adjustment progress and results  
can also be made to appear for about 3 seconds while  
settings are being changed, during adjustment, and after  
adjustment.  
c Color temperature  
This indicates the currently selected color temperature.  
d UHF wireless microphone reception level  
This indicates reception level of the wireless microphone  
when the UHF wireless microphone is attached, using four  
x which appear at the right of “W”. When four x are lit,  
the receiving condition is good.  
e DC IN / battery voltage or remaining capacity  
This shows the battery voltage or remaining capacity of an  
internal battery pack.  
When the power is supplied from an AC adaptor connected  
to the DC IN connector, “DC IN” appears.  
When the DISP BATT REMAIN item is set to “INT” on  
the VF DISP 2 page of the USER menu, the battery voltage  
is not indicated. However, when the Anton Bauer  
intelligent battery system or the BP-IL75/GL95/M100  
battery pack is used, the remaining battery capacity is  
automatically detected and indicated as a percentage even  
when the DISP BATT REMAIN item is set to “OFF”. The  
indicated value changes in steps of 10 %.  
For information about the display item selection, ssee 7-2-  
information about setting change and adjustment progress  
115. For information about marker display, see 7-2-4  
• Until the remaining battery capacity is reduced to 40 %,  
the indications MAX, 90 %, 80 %...40 % are displayed  
for three seconds in the viewfinder each time the  
remaining battery capacity reduces by 10 %.  
7-2-1 Layout of the Status Display  
on the Viewfinder Screen  
All items that can be displayed on the viewfinder screen  
are shown below.  
• When the remaining battery capacity is less than 40 %,  
the indication is displayed all the time.  
1)  
• When the remaining battery capacity is less than 10 % ,  
the the indication flashes. When the remaining battery  
capacity is reduced further, the LOW indication flashes.  
16:9  
PDW-530  
EM  
1) This value can be set to either 10 % or 20 % on the FUNCTION 2 page of  
the OPERATION menu.  
#30001  
f 16:9 mode recording indicator  
This indicates recording in the 16:9 mode. This indicator is  
recorded together with the color bars.  
D5600  
IMX50  
g Setting change and adjustment progress message  
display area  
6, qj, qk, ql and wa appear only when color bars are displayed.  
Status display on the viewfinder  
h Operation/error message display area  
a Extender  
“EX” is displayed when a lens extender is used.  
112  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
           
i Iris setting/auto iris override  
1F to 8F, 16F: Number of frames in SLS mode  
This indicates the f-stop (iris setting) of the lens.  
Also, the auto iris override is displayed using bars which  
appear in the upper and lower parts to the left of the F  
number respectively.  
m Gain  
This indicates the gain of the video amplifier, as set by the  
GAIN selector.  
n White balance memory  
This indicates the currently selected white balance  
automatic adjustment memory.  
j Remaining disc capacity  
This indicator indicates the remaining disc recording time  
(in minutes) of the VDR.  
A: Displayed when the WHITE BAL switch is set to A.  
B: Displayed when the WHITE BAL switch is set to B.  
P: Displayed when the WHITE BAL switch is set to PRST  
or when the preset button on the RM-B150 has been  
pushed.  
Examples of remaining disc recording time indication  
T: Displayed when ATW is being used.  
Indication  
F - 30  
Remaining disc recording time  
Full to 30 minutes  
30 to 25 minutes  
25 to 20 minutes  
20 to 15 minutes  
15 to 10 minutes  
10 to 5 minutes  
5 to 4 minutes  
o Filter  
30 - 25  
This indicates the currently selected filter types.  
25 - 20  
p Time code  
This indicates the time code, user bits or other information  
selected by the DISPLAY switch.  
20 - 15  
15 - 10  
10 - 5  
q ID number  
5 MIN  
This indicates the ID number selected from ID 1 to ID 4.  
The ID number is recorded together with the color bars.  
4 MIN  
4 to 3 minutes  
3 MIN  
3 to 2 minutes  
2 MIN  
2 to 1 minutes  
r Date and time  
This indicates the date and time of recording, which are  
recorded together with the color bars.  
1 (flashing)  
0 MIN (flashing)  
1 to 0 minute  
0 minute  
s Model name and serial number  
This indicates the model name and serial number of the  
camcorder, which are recorded together with the color  
bars.  
k Audio level  
These indicate the level of audio channel 1 and channel 2.  
The peak indication of the VDR level meter is related as  
follows to the audio level when an 1-kHz sine wave is  
input.  
t 16:9/4:3 mode  
“16:9” or “4:3” is displayed depending on the currently  
selected aspect ratio.  
Audio channel 1  
level indicator  
Audio channel 2  
level indicator  
u *  
VDR level meter  
indicator  
This flashes when the color bars are displayed and is  
recorded together with the color bars  
v Recording format  
This indicates the current recording format.  
l Shutter speed  
This indicates the shutter speed or the shutter mode.  
However, if the SHUTTER selector is set to OFF, nothing  
is displayed.  
1/100 (PDW-510/530) or 1/60 (PDW-510P/530P), 1/125,  
1/250, 1/500, 1/1000, 1/2000: Shutter speed (in  
seconds) in standard mode (scan mode:I)  
1/40, 1/60, 1/120 (PDW-510/530) or 1/33, 1/50, 1/100  
(PDW-510P/530P), 1/125, 1/250, 1/500, 1/1000, 1/  
2000: Shutter speed (in seconds) in standard mode  
(scan mode:PsF)  
w D5600 indication  
This appears when the electric 5600 K color temperature  
filter function is on.  
x EM indicator  
This appears when essence marks are recorded on the disc.  
48).  
ECS: ECS mode  
EVS: EVS mode  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
113  
Item  
Description  
7-2-2 Selecting the Display Items  
DISP SHUTTER  
Shutter speed and ECS mode  
indicator  
To select the items to be displayed on the viewfinder  
screen from the VF DISP 1 and VF DISP 2 pages of the  
USER menu, turn on or off the indication next to each  
item.  
DISP AUDIO  
DISP DISC  
DISP IRIS  
Audio level indicator  
Remaining disc capacity indicator  
Iris opening indicator  
To select the items to be displayed on the viewfinder  
screen, proceed as follows.  
1) The viewfinder display can be also turned on or off by using the DISPLAY  
switch on the viewfinder.  
2) For detailed information on the display mode, see 7-2-3 “Display Modes  
VF DISP 2 page  
Item  
Description  
CANCEL/PRST /  
ESCAPE switch  
DISP ZOOM  
Zoom position indicator  
Displays the color temperature.  
DISP COLOR  
TEMP.  
MENU knob  
MENU ON/OFF switch  
DISP BATT  
REMAIN  
Displays the battery voltage/  
1)  
remaining capacity of an internal  
battery pack or an external battery  
connected to the DC IN connector.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
DISP DC IN  
Displayed when the power is supplied  
from an external battery connected to  
the DC IN connector.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the  
viewfinder screen.  
DISP 16:9/4:3 ID  
Displays the 16:9/4:3 mode indicator.  
DISP WRR RF LVL Displays the reception level of the  
wireless microphone.  
Turn the MENU knob until the VF DISP 1 or VF DISP  
2 page appears, and press the MENU knob to select the  
page.  
DISP TIME CODE  
Displays the time code.  
DISP REC FORMAT Displays the recording format.  
1) When an Anton Bauer Intelligent Battery System or the BP-IL75/GL95/  
M100 battery pack is used, the setting of this item determines the display  
as follows.  
INT: The remaining battery capacity is shown as a percentage when there  
is a change, and when the capacity is low.  
AUTO: The remaining battery capacity is shown as a percentage, except  
that when this is impossible the battery voltage appears.  
VOLT: The battery voltage is shown.  
U04 VF DISP 1  
VF DISP  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
ON  
3
VF DISP MODE  
DISP EXTENDER  
DISP FILTER  
DISP WHITE  
DISP GAIN  
DISP SHUTTER  
DISP AUDIO  
DISP DISC  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
DISP IRIS  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press the MENU knob.  
VF DISP 1 page  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
You can select the following items to be displayed on  
the screen on the VF DISP 1 or VF DISP 2 page.  
VF DISP 1 page  
Turn the MENU knob to select whether the selected  
item should appear in the viewfinder display (the  
“ON” setting), or not appear (the “OFF” setting), and  
press the MENU knob.  
Item  
Description  
VF DISP  
Turning on or off the viewfinder  
1)  
display  
2)  
VF DISPLAY MODE  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
Selecting the display mode  
changes to a z mark.  
DISP EXTENDER  
DISP FILTER  
DISP WHITE  
DISP GAIN  
Extender indicator  
Types of the ND filter  
White balance memory indicator  
Gain indicator  
Note that pressing the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE  
switch to CANCEL/PRST on this page has no effect.  
114  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
   
5
6
To set another item to “ON” or “OFF”, repeat steps 3  
and 4.  
7-2-3 Display Modes and Setting  
Change Confirmation/  
Adjustment Progress  
Messages  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
You can limit or suppress the messages that give details of  
setting changes and adjustment progress and results by  
setting a display mode.  
The conditions under which messages are displayed and  
their correspondence with the display mode are as follows:  
Setting change confirmation/adjustment progress messages  
and display modes  
Y: Message is displayed.  
N: Message is not displayed.  
Message  
display  
condition  
Message  
Display  
mode  
setting  
1
2
3
When the filter  
selection has  
been changed  
ND : n, CC : m (where n =  
1, 2, 3, 4, m = A, B, C, D)  
N
N
Y
When the gain  
setting has been 0dB, 3dB, 6dB, 9dB,12dB,  
changed  
GAIN : n (where n = -3dB,  
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
18dB, 24dB, 30dB, 36dB,  
42dB, 48dB)  
When the  
WHITE : n (where n = A  
CH, B CH, PRESET) or  
ATW : RUN  
setting of the  
WHITE BAL  
switch has been  
changed  
When the  
DCC : ON (or OFF)  
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
OUTPUT/DCC  
selector has  
been set to DCC  
ON or OFF  
When the  
shutter speed  
and mode  
SS : 1/100 (PDW-510/530)  
or 1/60 (PDW-510P/530P)  
(or 1/125, 1/250, 1/500,  
setting has been 1/1000, 1/2000,ECS, SLS)  
1)  
changed  
When the black E.g. WHITE : OK  
or white balance  
has been  
N
Y
Y
adjusted  
1) This is also displayed for about 3 seconds when the SHUTTER selector is  
set to ON.  
Changing the display mode  
The currently set display mode appears on the VF DISP 1  
page of the USER menu. To change it, proceed as follows.  
1
Follow steps 1 and 2 in 7-2-2 “Selecting the Display  
Items” on page 114, until the VF DISP 1 page of the  
USER menu appears on the screen.  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
115  
   
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “VF  
Item  
Description  
DISPLAY MODE”, and press the MENU knob.  
SAFETY ZONE  
SAFETY AREA  
To display the safety zone, set to ON.  
The b mark on the left of “VF DISPLAY MODE”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
To select the safety zone range (80%,  
90%, 92.5 % or 95 %), when SAFETY  
ZONE is set to ON.  
ASPECT  
To display the aspect marker, set to ON.  
To select the type of the aspect marker.  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob until the desired display mode  
appears, and press the MENU knob.  
ASPECT  
SELECT  
ASPECT MASK  
(4:3)  
To make the areas out of the selected  
aspect marker dimmer, set to ON.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
1)  
ASPECT MASK  
LVL  
To set the mask level (1/2, 1/4 or 1/8),  
when the ASPECT MASK is set to ON.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
100 % MARKER To display the effective pixel area, set to  
ON.  
1) The ASPECT MASK item is for processing the signal to be output to the  
viewfinder. When R, G, or B is selected for the TEST OUT SELECT item  
from the menu, the same video signal is output to the viewfinder and the  
TEST OUT connector. Thus, when the ASPECT MASK (4:3) item is set  
to “ON” with R/G/B selected, the masked video signal is output to the  
TEST OUT connector.  
7-2-4 Setting the Marker Display  
Use the MARKER 1 page of the USER menu to switch the  
display of the center and safety zone markers on or off and  
to select whether the area indicated by the safety zone  
marker is 80%, 90% or 100% of the screen area.  
3
Perform the settings for each item.  
1 Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
item you want to set, and press MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes  
to the z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
CANCEL/PRST /  
ESCAPE switch  
2 Turn the MENU knob to change the setting, and  
press the MENU knob.  
The z mark on the left of the selected item changes  
to a b mark and the ? mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a z mark.  
MENU knob  
MENU ON/OFF switch  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
4
5
To continue setting other items, repeat step 3.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
Turn the MENU knob until the MARKER 1 page  
appears, and press the MENU knob to select the page.  
The menu disappears from the screen, and the display  
indicating the current status of the camcorder appears  
along the top and bottom of the screen.  
U07 MARKER 1  
MARKER  
TOP  
OFF  
:
CENTER  
:
:
:
:
:
:
OFF  
OFF  
90%  
OFF  
4:3  
OFF  
1/4  
OFF  
SAFETY ZONE  
SAFETY AREA  
ASPECT  
ASPECT SELECT  
ASPECT MASK  
7-2-5 Setting the Viewfinder  
Use the VF SETTING page of the USER menu to select  
items related to the viewfinder.  
ASPECT MASK LVL :  
100% MARKER  
:
You can set the following items on the MARKER 1  
page.  
Item  
MARKER  
CENTER  
Description  
Not to display all markers, set to OFF.  
To display the center marker, set to ON.  
116  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
         
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
4
Turn the MENU knob to change the setting, and press  
the MENU knob.  
CANCEL/PRST /  
ESCAPE switch  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
MENU knob  
MENU ON/OFF switch  
5
6
To continue setting other items, repeat steps 3 and 4.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
The menu disappears from the screen, and the display  
indicating the current status of the camcorder appears  
along the top and bottom of the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob until the VF SETTING page  
appears, and press the MENU knob to select the page.  
U09 VF SETTING  
7-2-6 Recording Shot Data  
Superimposed on the Color  
Bars  
ZEBRA  
ZEBRA SELECT  
:
:
OFF  
1
ZEBRA1 DET.LEVEL:  
ZEBRA1 APT.LEVEL:  
ZEBRA2 DET.LEVEL:  
70%  
10%  
100%  
VF DETAIL LEVEL :  
OFF  
In the SHOT DISP page of the USER menu, you can select  
which shot data is recorded superimposed on the color  
bars. You can also select which of the shot IDs (1 to 4) set  
in the SHOT DATA page is recorded superimposed on the  
picture.  
VF ASPECT  
:
AUTO  
Item  
Description  
Turns the zebra display on or off.  
Selects ZEBRA 1, ZEBRA 2 or BOTH.  
1)  
ZEBRA  
Proceed as follows.  
ZEBRA SELECT  
ZEBRA 1 DET. LVL Adjusts the level of the zebra 1 (70%)  
display.  
ZEBRA 1 APT. LVL Adjusts the aperture level of the zebra  
1 display. (1 to 10 to 20)  
CANCEL/PRST /  
ESCAPE switch  
ZEBRA 2 DET. LVL Adjusts the level of the zebra 2 (100%)  
display.  
VF DETAIL LEVEL Adjusts the sharpness of the  
2)  
MENU knob  
MENU ON/OFF switch  
viewfinder (–99 to 0 to 99).  
Turns the VF detail function on or off  
and adjusts the level.  
VF ASPECT  
Selects the viewfinder aspect ratio.  
(AUTO/16:9)  
Selecting the shot data for superimposed recording  
3)  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
1) When you use the viewfinder which is not equipped with the ZEBRA  
switch, turns the display on or off using this item. When you use the  
viewfinder with the ZEBRA switch, the most recent operation of the  
ZEBRA switch and this menu operation is effective.  
2) The sharpness setting at the viewfinder does not affect the recorded image.  
3) When the VF ASPECT item is set to “AUTO”, this is linked to the 16:9/  
4:3 selection on the FORMAT page.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob until the SHOT DISP page  
appears, and press the MENU knob to select the page.  
When the VF ASPECT item is set to “16:9”, but “4:3” is selected on the  
FORMAT page, then it is not possible to mix the zebra display and marker  
display signals on the output signal from the TEST OUT connector.  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press the MENU knob.  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
117  
   
The items selected for superimposed recording appear on  
the screen and are recorded superimposed on the color  
bars.  
U12 SHOT DISP  
SHOT DATE  
SHOT TIME  
SHOT MODEL NAME :  
SHOT SERIAL NO  
SHOT ID SEL  
SHOT 16:9 ID  
:
:
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
:
:
:
7-2-7 Setting the Shot ID  
SHOT BLINK CHARA:  
On the SHOT ID page of the USER menu, you can set a  
shot ID of up to 12 alphanumeric characters, spaces, and  
symbols.  
When the OUTPUT/DCC switch is set to BARS, DCC  
OFF, this shot ID is output with the color bar signal. The  
shot ID comprises ID1 to ID4, and the setting can be  
changed using the SHOT DISP page of the USER menu.  
You can select the SHOT ID to be recorded superimposed  
on the color bars on the SHOT DISP page.  
You can set the following items on the SHOT DISP  
page.  
Item  
Description  
SHOT DATE  
Selects whether or not the shot data is  
superimposed (ON or OFF).  
SHOT TIME  
Selects whether or not shot time is  
superimposed (ON or OFF).  
Note  
SHOT MODEL  
NAME  
Selects whether or not the model name  
is superimposed (ON or OFF).  
When the menu is displayed, the shot ID is not displayed  
even if the color bar signal is output.  
SHOT SERIAL  
NO.  
Selects whether or not the serial  
number is superimposed (ON or OFF).  
To set the shot ID, proceed as follows.  
Selects whether or not the shot ID set  
SHOT ID SEL  
1)  
on the SHOT ID page is  
superimposed (1 to 4 or OFF).  
SHOT 16:9 ID  
Selects whether or not the 16:9 mode  
indicator is superimposed (ON or OFF).  
SHOT BLINK  
CHARA  
Selects whether or not the blinking * is  
superimposed (ON or OFF).  
CANCEL/PRST /  
ESCAPE switch  
1) To carry out superimposed recording, select the SHOT ID number (1 to 4).  
Not to carry out superimposed recording, select “OFF”.  
MENU knob  
MENU ON/OFF switch  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press MENU knob.  
Setting the shot ID  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob to select whether or not to  
record the selected item superimposed on the color  
bars, and press the MENU knob.  
Turn the MENU knob until the SHOT ID page  
appears, and press the MENU knob to select the page.  
The z mark on changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
U11 SHOT ID  
TOP  
changes to a z mark.  
ID-1 : ssssssssssss  
ID-2 : ssssssssssss  
ID-3 : ssssssssssss  
ID-4 : ssssssssssss  
5
6
To continue setting other items, repeat steps 3 and 4.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the ID  
(one of ID-1 to ID-4) you want to set, and press the  
MENU knob.  
To carry out superimposed recording  
To actually record the items selected for superimposed  
recording on the SHOT DISP page, set the OUTPUT/DCC  
switch to BARS, DCC OFF.  
A x mark appears over the first character position in  
the string, and characters can now be input.  
118  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
     
U11 SHOT ID  
ID-1 :?  
TOP  
U11 SHOT ID  
TOP  
x
ID-1 : CM015  
ID-2 : ssssssssssss  
ID-3 : ssssssssssss  
ID-4 : ssssssssssss  
ID-2 : ssssssssssss  
ID-3 : ssssssssssss  
ID-4 : ssssssssssss  
$%&'()*+,-./0123456789:  
;<=>?@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR  
STUVWXYZ[\]_  
$%&'()*+,-./0123456789:  
;<=>?@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR  
STUVWXYZ[\]_  
Move the x mark  
INS DEL RET  
ESC END  
INS DEL RET  
ESC END  
over “INS”.  
4
Enter or change the shot ID.  
2
Move the x mark over “RET”, then press the MENU  
knob.  
When you are entering the whole shot ID, go to step  
2.  
U11 SHOT ID  
TOP  
1 Turn the MENU knob to move the x mark to the  
character which you want to change, then press the  
MENU knob.  
ID-1 : CM 015  
ID-2 : ssssssssssss  
ID-3 : ssssssssssss  
ID-4 : ssssssssssss  
Space inserted  
$%&'()*+,-./0123456789:  
;<=>?@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR  
STUVWXYZ[\]_  
A character table appears.  
INS DEL RET  
ESC END  
U11 SHOT ID  
ID-1 :?  
TOP  
x
ID-2 : ssssssssssss  
ID-3 : ssssssssssss  
ID-4 : ssssssssssss  
To delete a character  
In step 4 of the procedure for setting the shot ID (see page  
119), move the x mark over “DEL”, and press the MENU  
knob.  
x
$%&'()*+,-./0123456789:  
;<=>?@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR  
STUVWXYZ[\]_  
INS DEL RET  
ESC END  
This deletes the character under the x mark in the shot ID  
row.  
To cancel deleting the character, move the x mark over  
“RET”, and press the MENU knob.  
2 Turn the MENU knob until the x mark moves to  
the character position that you want to select, then  
press the MENU knob.  
To cancel entering or changing shot ID  
Example: To input “+”  
Before executing step 6 of the procedure for setting the  
shot ID (see page 119), move the b mark to “ESC” at the  
top right of the screen, then press the MENU knob or push  
the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch down to ESCAPE.  
This cancels all changes, and returns to the SHOT ID page.  
U11 SHOT ID  
ID-1 :?  
TOP  
+
ID-2 : ssssssssssss  
ID-3 : ssssssssssss  
ID-4 : ssssssssssss  
x
$%&'()*+,-./0123456789:  
;<=>?@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR  
STUVWXYZ[\]_  
INS DEL RET  
ESC END  
7-2-8 Displaying the Status  
Confirmation Windows  
5
6
Repeat step 4 for each of the remaining characters.  
You can confirm the settings or status of the camcorder on  
the screen by displaying the following three windows.  
• ABNORMAL <!> window  
• FUNCTION window  
• AUDIO STATUS window  
When the input is complete, turn the MENU knob to  
move the x mark over “END”, then press the MENU  
knob.  
This ends the input, and returns to the original SHOT  
ID page.  
ABNORMAL <!> window  
ABNORMAL<!>  
To insert a space  
Proceed as follows.  
xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx  
!GAIN  
!SHUTTER  
WHT PRESET : ON  
:
ON  
3dB  
OFF  
W:P  
OFF  
OFF  
1B  
:
ON  
ATW RUN  
EXTENDER  
!FILTER  
:
:
ON  
ON  
: OFF  
ON  
1
In step 4 above, move the x mark over “INS”, and  
press the MENU knob.  
OVERRIDE  
:
OFF  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
119  
       
This window allows you to confirm why the ! (warning)  
indicator lights.  
You can use the '!' LED page of the USER menu to set  
whether or not the ! (warning) indicator lights.  
FUNCTION window  
FUNCTION  
FORMAT:  
I
ASSIGN<1> ATW <2> OFF  
<3> OFF <4> OFF  
<T>TURBO  
ZEBRA :OFF SELECT:  
1
10%  
By pushing the STATUS ON/SEL  
/ OFF switch up to ON/SEL, the  
confirmation window appears.  
Each time you push this switch up  
to ON/SEL, the window switches.  
After 10 seconds, the window  
disappears automatically.  
DET  
DET2 100%  
P.CACHE  
70%  
APT:  
:
OFF: 0-2s  
- Actual State ---------  
REAR BNC:OFF  
This window allows you to confirm the assigned function  
of the ASSIGN 1/2/3/4 switches, ON/OFF of the Loop Rec  
function, and ON/OFF of the output of the VIDEO OUT  
connector.  
To make the window disappear  
promptly after displaying the  
window, push this switch down  
to OFF.  
AUDIO STATUS window  
AUDIO STATUS  
16bit DF F.MIC:MONO  
CH2:FRONT  
CH2:FRONT  
CH3:FRONT  
CH4:FRONT  
To disable display of the status  
confirmation windows  
Proceed as follows.  
1:  
2:  
3:  
4:  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
This window allows you to confirm the following items  
related to audio.  
• Audio bit rate  
• Setting condition of DF/NDF (only for the PDW-510/  
530)  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob until the SET STATUS page  
appears, and press the MENU knob to select the page.  
• Type of front microphone  
• Type of input signal to audio channels 1 to 4  
• Input level of audio channels 1 to 4  
You can use the SET STATUS page of the USER menu to  
set whether or not the status confirmation windows are  
displayed.  
U13 SET STATUS  
STATUS ABNORMAL :  
STATUS FUNCTION :  
STATUS AUDIO  
ON  
ON  
ON  
:
To display the status confirmation  
windows  
You can use the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch as the  
STATUS ON/SEL / OFF switch when the MENU ON/  
OFF switch is set to OFF (when the cover of the menu  
operating section is closed, OFF is automatically selected).  
Item  
Description  
ABNORMAL  
Selects whether or not the ABNORMAL  
window is displayed (ON or OFF).  
FUNCTION  
Selects whether or not the FUNCTION  
window is displayed (ON or OFF).  
STATUS AUDIO Selects whether or not the STATUS  
AUDIO window is displayed (ON or  
OFF).  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press MENU knob.  
120  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
4
Carry out setting operations as follows.  
1 Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“GENLOCK”, and press the MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of “GENLOCK” changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
GENLOCK setting changes to a ? mark.  
4
Turn the MENU knob to select whether or not to  
display the selected window, then press the MENU  
knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
2 Turn the MENU knob until ”OFF” appears, then  
press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
5
6
To continue setting other windows, repeat steps 3 and  
4.  
changes to a z mark, and the setting is executed.  
3 Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“RETURN VIDEO”, and press the MENU knob.  
The b mark changes to a z mark and the z mark  
changes to a ? mark.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
4 Turn the MENU knob until “ON” appears, then  
press the MENU knob.  
7-2-9 Confirming the Image of the  
Return Video Signal in the  
Viewfinder  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark, and the setting is executed.  
5
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
You can set whether or not the image of the return video  
signal input to the GENLOCK IN connector is displayed in  
the viewfinder, using the GENLOCK page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu.  
Proceed as follows.  
To see the image of the return video signal  
on the viewfinder screen  
Hold down the RET switch on the lens. The image of the  
return video signal input to the GENLOCK IN connector  
is displayed on the viewfinder screen while you are  
holding down the RET switch.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON while holding  
down the MENU knob.  
The TOP menu appears.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“MAINTENANCE”, then press the MENU knob.  
When the return video function is assigned to the ASSIGN  
1/3/4 switch, you can see the image of the return video  
signal on the viewfinder screen while you are holding  
down the ASSIGN 1/3/4 switch even if the RETURN  
VIDEO item is set to “OFF” on the GENLOCK page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu.  
If this is the first time the MAINTENANCE menu has  
been displayed, the CONTENTS page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu appears.  
If the menu has been used before, the last accessed  
page appears.  
Note  
3
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “GENLOCK”, then press  
the MENU knob to display the GENLOCK page.  
When no signal is input to the GENLOCK IN connector,  
the image is not changed even if you hold down the RET  
switch on the lens.  
However, the image is switched while you are holding  
down the ASSIGN 1/3/4 switch to which the return video  
function is assigned, even if no signal is input to the  
GENLOCK IN connector.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the GENLOCK page appears, then press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
M15 GENLOCK  
TOP  
GENLOCK  
RETURN VIDEO  
:
:
ON  
OFF  
GL H PHASE  
GL SC PHASE  
:
:
0
0
GL SC 0/180 SEL :  
180  
7-2 Status Display on the Viewfinder Screen  
121  
     
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
7-3 Adjustments and  
Settings from Menus  
4
Turn the MENU knob to change the setting, and press  
the MENU knob.  
The camcorder provides menus for adjustments and  
settings.  
The z mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a b mark and the ? mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a z mark.  
7-3-1 Setting Gain Values for the  
GAIN Selector Positions  
Any of –3, 0, 3, 6, 9, 12, 18, 24, 30, 36, 42 or 48 dB  
can be set for each of the L, M, and H positions, in any  
sequence.  
Before using the camcorder, use the GAIN SW page of the  
USER menu to set the gains corresponding to the L, M,  
and H positions of the GAIN selector, which switches the  
gain of the video amplifier.  
For TURBO, any of –3, 0, 3, 6, 9, 12, 18, 24, 30, 36,  
42 or 48 dB can be selected.  
To change the gain corresponding to another switch  
position, return to step 3.  
To set the gain values, proceed as follows.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
5
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob until the GAIN SW page  
appears, then press the MENU knob to select the page.  
The menu display disappears, and the current status of  
the camcorder is shown along the top and bottom of  
the screen.  
U08 GAIN SW  
TOP  
GAIN LOW  
GAIN MID  
GAIN HIGH  
GAIN TURBO  
:
:
:
:
0db  
9db  
18db  
42db  
7-3-2 Selecting the Output Signals  
When the CBK-SD01 is installed, you can select the type  
of video signals (VBS/SDI) from the VIDEO OUT  
connector on the OUTPUT page of the USER menu.  
Use the POWER SAVE page to specify whether or not to  
enable DV stream output from the i.LINK DV IN/OUT  
S400 connector of this unit.  
When DV stream output is enabled, it is output when the  
recording format is any of MPEG IMX 50Mbps, 40Mbps,  
30Mbps or DVCAM.  
TURBO SW IND.  
:
OFF  
Item  
Description  
GAIN LOW  
Sets the gain value corresponding to  
the L position of the GAIN selector.  
GAIN MID  
Sets the gain value corresponding to  
the M position of the GAIN selector.  
To select the signal output from the VIDEO  
OUT connector  
Proceed as follows.  
GAIN HIGH  
GAIN TURBO  
TURBO SW IND  
Sets the gain value corresponding to  
the H position of the GAIN selector.  
Sets the gain value corresponding to  
TURBO GAIN button selection.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
OFF: When you operate the GAIN  
selector after pressing the TURBO  
GAIN button once, the video gain is  
changed according to the GAIN  
selector operation.  
ON: When the video gain is boosted to  
the video gain to the value preset by  
pressing the TURBO GAIN button  
once, the video gain is not changed  
even if you operate the GAIN selector,  
until you press the TURBO GAIN  
button once more.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob until the OUTPUT page  
appears, then press the MENU knob to select the page.  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press MENU knob.  
122  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
           
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“OPERATION”, then press the MENU knob.  
U01 OUTPUT  
TOP  
LCD BRIGHT <L>  
LCD BRIGHT <H>  
LCD COLOR  
:
:
:
0
0
0
If this is the first time the OPERATION menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page appears. If the menu  
has been used before, the last accessed page appears.  
PC REMOTE  
REAR BNC OUT SEL:  
:
DSABL  
VBS  
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to POWER SAVE, then  
press the MENU knob.  
Item  
Description  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the POWER SAVE page appears, then press the  
MENU knob.  
LCD BRIGHT <L> Adjusts the LCD brightness when the  
LCD switch is in the L position.  
LCD BRIGHT <H> Adjusts the LCD brightness when the  
LCD switch is in the H position.  
The POWER SAVE page appears. The current  
settings appear on the right side of each item.  
LCD COLOR  
Adjusts the color saturation of the LCD.  
i.LINK SBP2  
MODE  
Selects whether or not to use the  
i.LINK connector SBP2 interface.  
04 POWER SAVE  
TOP  
REAR BNC OUT  
SEL  
Selects the type of the video signal to  
be output from the VIDEO OUT  
connector.  
i.LINK OUT  
REC AUDIO OUT  
:
:
DSABL  
EE  
NETWORK/THUMB  
:
SAVE  
SDI : Outputs the SDI signal. When  
SDI is selected, connect the  
VIDEO OUT connector to the SDI  
IN connector of the video monitor.  
VBS: Outputs the analog composite  
video signal. When VBS is  
selected, connector the VIDEO  
OUT connector to the VIDEO IN  
connector of the video monitor.  
This setting allows you to save the  
power.  
Item  
Setting  
i.LINK OUT  
Enable or disable i.LINK (AV/C) OUT.  
REC AUDIO OUT  
Select whether to output E-E signals  
or no audio from the AUDIO OUT  
connector during recording.  
3
4
5
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “REAR  
NETWORK/  
THUMB  
Select whether to permanently enable  
the CBK-NC01 (option) and thumbnail  
display, or to disable them in power  
saving mode.  
BNC OUT SEL”, and press the MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of “REAR BNC OUT SEL”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
4
5
6
Move the b mark to “i.LINK OUT”, then press the  
MENU knob.  
Turn the MENU knob to change the desired setting,  
and press the MENU knob.  
The b mark changes to a z mark, and the z mark  
changes to a ? mark.  
The z mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a b mark and the ? mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a z mark.  
Turn the MENU knob to select “ENABL”, then press  
the MENU knob.  
The setting is confirmed. The z mark changes to a b  
mark and the ? mark changes to a z mark.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
To enable DV stream output  
Proceed as follows.  
Notes  
• As the i.LINK cable, use an S400-compliant cable  
which is as short as possible (up to 1.5 m (5 feet)).  
It may not be possible to establish a FAM  
connection if a longer cable is used.  
• DV streams are not output when the i.LINK DV IN/  
OUT S400 connector is set to input.  
1
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch to ON.  
The TOP menu appears.  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
123  
Equipment” (page 63) for more information on the  
input setting of the i.LINK DV IN/OUT S400  
connector.  
Items followed by “<B>” are used to adjust the white  
balance of channel B.  
4
5
6
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press MENU knob.  
7-3-3 Setting the Color Temperature  
Manually  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
You can adjust the value of the white balance manually by  
setting the color temperature.  
Proceed as follows.  
Turn the MENU knob to change the setting, and press  
the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
To set other items, go back to step 3.  
1
2
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch to ON.  
The TOP menu appears.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“PAINT”, and press the MENU knob.  
If this is the first time the PAINT menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page appears. If the menu  
has been used before, the last accessed page appears.  
7-3-4 Specifying an Offset for the  
Auto White Balance Setting  
3
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “WHITE”, and press the  
MENU knob to display the WHITE page.  
By setting an offset for the value of auto white balance,  
you can make the picture warmer or colder.  
The OFFSET WHT page of the OPERATION menu  
allows you to do this setting.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the WHITE page appears, and press the MENU  
knob to select the page.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch from OFF to ON.  
P02 WHITE  
The TOP menu appears.  
COLOR TEMP  
COLOR FINE  
R GAIN  
B GAIN  
D5600K  
COLOR TEMP  
COLOR FINE  
R GAIN  
B GAIN  
D5600K  
<A>:  
<A>:  
<A>:  
<A>:  
<A>:  
<B>:  
<B>:  
<B>:  
<B>:  
:
3200  
0
0
0
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“OPERATION”, and press the MENU knob.  
OFF  
3200  
0
0
0
OFF  
If this is the first time the OPERATION menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page appears. If the menu  
has been used before, the last accessed page appears.  
Item  
Description  
3
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “OFFSET WHITE”, and  
press the MENU knob to display the OFFSET WHITE  
page.  
COLOR TEMP  
<A>  
Sets the color temperature for the  
desired value. Adjust the value while  
looking at the real image because error  
tends to be bigger for adjustment of  
high color temperature.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the OFFSET WHITE page appears, and press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
COLOR FINE <A> Adjusts the value more precisely when  
the color temperature adjustment  
through COLOR TEMP is not  
satisfactory.  
R GAIN <A>  
B GAIN <A>  
D5600K  
Only the value of R GAIN is changed.  
Only the value of B GAIN is changed.  
Sets the color temperature to  
approximately 5600 K.  
The above table shows the adjustment of the white  
balance of channel A.  
124  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
         
To set other items, go back to step 3.  
To set the other white balance channel, go back to step  
P17 OFFSET WHT  
TOP  
2.  
OFFSET WHITE <A>:  
WARM COOL  
COLOR FINE  
OFF  
3200  
0
<A>:  
<A>:  
7
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
OFFSET WHITE <B>:  
WARM COOL <B>:  
COLOR FINE <B>:  
OFF  
3200  
0
7-3-5 Assigning Functions to  
ASSIGN 1/2/3/4 Switches  
Item  
Description  
OFFSET WHITE  
<A>  
Turns the setting of the offset for  
channel A ON or OFF. ON: Adds the  
offset adjusted on this page to the  
white balance.  
You can assign the desired function to any of the ASSIGN  
1/2/3/4 switches and the TURBO GAIN button.  
Proceed as follows.  
WARM-COOL <A> When OFFSET WHITE <A> is ON,  
sets the offset for the white balance of  
channel A, using the color  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
temperature. Adjust the value while  
looking at the real image because  
error tends to be bigger for adjustment  
of high color temperature.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob until the FUNCTION 1 page  
appears, then press the MENU knob to select to page.  
COLOR FINE <A> Adjusts the value more precisely if the  
adjustment by WARM-COOL <A> is  
not satisfactry.  
U03 FUNCTION1  
TOP  
OFFSET WHITE  
<B>  
Turns the setting of the offset for  
channel B ON or OFF. ON: Adds the  
offset adjusted on this page to the  
white balance.  
ASSIGN SW <1>  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
TURBO SW  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
ATW  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
TURBO  
DF  
OFF  
DF/NDF  
CACHE/INTVAL  
WARM-COOL <B> Sets the offset for the white balance of  
channel B, using the color  
temperature. Adjust the value while  
looking at the real image because  
error tends to be bigger for adjustment  
of high color temperature.  
Item  
Description  
COLOR FINE <B> Adjusts the value more precisely if the  
adjustment by WARM-COOL <B> is  
not satisfactory.  
ASSIGN SW 1  
ASSIGN SW 2  
ASSIGN SW 3  
ASSIGN SW 4  
Assigns the function to ASSIGN 1  
(push-type) switch.  
Assigns the function to ASSIGN 2  
(slide-type) switch.  
4
Set the WHITE BAL switch to the position  
corresponding to the desired channel (A or B).  
Assigns the function to ASSIGN 3  
(push-type) switch.  
Assigns the function to ASSIGN 4  
(push-type) switch.  
Note  
If the WHITE BAL switch is not set to A or B when  
you operate the camcorder, the adjustment value will  
not be reflected in the output signal.  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
corresponding to the switch to which you want to  
assign the function, and press the MENU knob.  
5
6
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press MENU knob.  
The corresponding ASSIGN SW SEL window  
appears.  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
Turn the MENU knob to change the setting, and press  
the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
125  
   
Function  
Description  
ASSIGN SW1 <3/4> SEL window  
ZOOM WIDE/  
TELE  
When using a serial lens, assign the  
ZOOM WIDE setting to ASSIGN 3, and  
the TELE setting to ASSIGN 4.  
ASSIGN SW1 SEL ESC  
3)  
OFF  
PICTURE CACHE ON/OFF  
TEST OUT CHARACTER  
MARKER  
RE-TAKE  
ATW  
RETURN VIDEO  
LENS RET  
REC SWITCH  
TURBO SWITCH  
SHOT MARK1  
SHOT MARK2  
Assigns the function to record a SHOT  
MARK 1 essence mark.  
Assigns the function to record a SHOT  
MARK 2 essence mark.  
4)  
Assigns the items assigned in the  
ASSIGN SEL menu.  
UA01 to UA10  
ASSIGN SW2 SEL window  
1) Even when the MARKER item is set to “OFF” on the MARKER page of  
the USER menu, the ASSIGN 1/3/4 switch allows you to display or not to  
display all markers.  
2) Even if the RETURN VIDEO item is set to “OFF” on the GENLOCK page  
of the MAINTENANCE menu, you can use this switch to display the  
image of the return video signal on the viewfinder.  
ASSIGN SW2 SEL ESC  
OFF  
PICTURE CACHE ON/OFF  
TEST OUT CHARACTER  
MARKER  
ZEBRA  
FREEZE MIX  
FREEZE MIX(Manual)  
D5600  
EXT REC CONTROL  
3) Only the Assign 3SEL and Assign 4 SEL screens appear.  
4) This does not appear if nothing is assigned in the Assign menu.  
Functions to be assigned to the ASSIGN 2 (slide-  
type) switch  
Functions to be assigned to the ASSIGN 1/3/4  
(push-type) switch  
Function  
OFF  
Content  
Function  
Description  
Disables the switch.  
OFF  
Disables the switch.  
CACHE  
Assigns execution of recording in picture  
cache mode.  
CACHE  
Assigns execution of recording in picture  
cache mode.  
TEST OUT  
CHARACTER  
Assigns the function to switch whether or  
not the characters are mixed to the video  
signal to be output from the TEST OUT  
connector.  
TEST OUT  
CHARACTER  
Assigns the function to switch whether or  
not text is superimposed on the video  
signal to be output from the TEST OUT  
connector.  
MARKER  
Assigns the ON/OFF function to display  
all markers.  
MARKER  
Assigns the ON/OFF function to display  
1)  
1)  
all markers.  
ZEBRA  
D5600  
Assigns the zebra pattern display  
function to the switch.  
RETAKE  
ATW  
Assigns the function to delete the last  
recorded clip.  
Applies an electrical 5600 K filter.  
Assigns the ON/OFF function of auto-  
tracing white balance.  
EXT REC  
CONTROL  
Selects whether or not recording control  
of external devices connected through  
the i.LINK connector or the CCZ  
connector (26-pin) of a CA-702 is  
possible.  
RETURN VIDEO Assigns the ON/OFF function to display  
the image of the return video signal on  
2)  
the viewfinder to the switch.  
REC VIDEO  
SOURCE  
Selects which signals you will record  
pictures being shot by the camcorder or  
video signals from external equipment  
connected to GENLOCK IN connector.  
LENS RET  
Assigns the same function as that of the  
RET switch on the lens to the switch.  
2)  
REC SWITCH  
Assigns the VTR S/S (start/stop) function  
to the switch.  
3)  
Assigns the items assigned in the  
ASSIGN SEL menu.  
UA01 to UA10  
TURBO  
SWITCH  
Assigns the turbo gain function to the  
switch.  
1) Even when the MARKER item is set to “OFF” on the MARKER page of  
the USER menu, the ASSIGN 2 switch allows you to display or not to  
display all markers.  
2) When the CBK-SC01 is not installed, this item does not appears since this  
function is not effective.  
ZEBRA  
Assigns the zebra pattern display  
function to the switch.  
FREEZE MIX  
Outputs the freeze image and camera  
input alternately, to allow frame alignment  
(automatic switching).  
3) This does not appear if nothing is assigned in the Assign menu.  
FREEZE MIX  
(Manual)  
Outputs the freeze image and camera  
input alternately, to allow frame alignment  
(manual switching).  
Note  
For functions that are assigned to the ASSIGN 2  
switch, you cannot change those settings using other  
menus. The function assigned to ASSIGN 2 switch  
takes precedence over the menu setting.  
D5600  
Applies an electrical 5600 K filter.  
ZOOM TELE/  
When using a serial lens, assign the  
ZOOM TELE setting to ASSIGN 3, and  
the WIDE setting to ASSIGN 4.  
3)  
WIDE  
126  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
4
5
6
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the TIME/DATE page appears, then press the  
MENU knob to select the page.  
you want to set, and press MENU knob.  
The b mark changes to a z mark, and the z mark by  
the setting changes to a ? mark.  
04 TIME/DATE  
ADJUST  
:
EXEC  
Turn the MENU knob to switch to the desired setting,  
and press the MENU knob.  
HOUR  
MIN  
SEC  
:
:
:
12  
55  
58  
YEAR  
MONTH  
DAY  
:
:
:
00  
07  
31  
The z mark changes to a b mark, and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark, confirming the setting.  
To continue with other settings, repeat steps 3 and 4.  
4
Press the MENU knob.  
To return to the previous page  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “ESC” at the  
right top of the window and press the MENU knob.  
Alternatively, push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch  
down to the ESCAPE side.  
The TIME ADJUST setting window appears.  
TIME ADJUST ESC  
HOUR  
MIN  
SEC  
:
:
:
12  
55  
58  
To end the menu operation  
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF or close the cover  
of the menu operating section.  
YEAR  
MONTH  
DAY  
:
:
:
00  
07  
31  
OK  
Operation of the ASSIGN 1/2/3/4 switches when  
UA01 to UA10 are assigned  
When an on/off switchable function (or menu item) is  
assigned to one of the ASSIGN 1/2/3/4 switches, each time  
the switch is pressed toggles the function on or off.  
When another type of menu item is assigned, pressing the  
switch displays the item and its setting value on the  
viewfinder screen.  
You can then change the setting by pressing and turning  
the MENU knob.  
The viewfinder screen display disappears approximately  
three seconds after the last operation.  
Item  
Description  
HOUR  
MIN  
Sets the hour value.  
Sets the minutes value.  
Sets the seconds value.  
Sets the year.  
SEC  
YEAR  
MONTH  
DAY  
Sets the month.  
Sets the day.  
5
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press MENU knob.  
7-3-6 Setting the Date/Time of the  
Internal Clock  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
You can set or change the date and time of the internal  
clock. The date and time set are reflected in the time code.  
Proceed as follows.  
6
Turn the MENU knob to display the desired value, and  
press the MENU knob.  
1
Holding down the MENU knob, move the MENU ON/  
OFF switch to ON.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
The TOP menu appears.  
7
8
To continue the remaining settings, repeat steps 5 and  
6.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“DIAGNOSIS”, and press the MENU knob.  
When you finish settings, turn the MENU knob to  
move the b mark to “OK”, then press the MENU knob.  
If this is the first time the DIAGNOSIS menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page appears. If the menu  
has been used before, the last accessed page appears.  
The internal clock is set with the date and time set in  
steps 5 to 7. The TIME/DATE page of the  
DIAGNOSIS menu appears again. The time set on the  
TIME ADJUST setting window is displayed.  
3
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “TIME/DATE”, and press  
the MENU knob to display the TIME/DATE page.  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
127  
   
To cancel the setting  
7-3-8 Selecting the Aspect Ratio  
Before executing step 8, move the b mark to “ESC” at the  
top right of the window and press the MENU knob.  
Alternatively, push the CANCEL/PRST / ESCAPE switch  
down to the ESCAPE side.  
The FORMAT page of the OPERATION menu allows you  
to select the aspect ratio of the video output signal.  
All settings or changes are discarded and the TIME/DATE  
page of the DIAGNOSIS menu appears.  
Note  
When the CA-701/702/702P camera adaptor is used with  
the camcorder, this function is not available. To select the  
aspect ratio, disconnect the CA-701/702/702P camera  
adaptor from the camcorder or turn off the power of the  
CA-701/702/702P camera adaptor.  
7-3-7 Selecting the Lens File  
The LENS FILE page of the USER menu allows you to  
change the lens file according to the lens in use.  
Proceed as follows.  
Note  
When using a serial lens, lens file selection is not possible.  
1
Follow the procedure of steps 1 to 3 described in  
FORMAT page of the OPERATION menu.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
20 FORMAT  
16:9/4:3 SELECT :  
16:9  
I
Turn the MENU knob until the LENS FILE page  
appears, then press the MENU knob to select the page.  
SCAN MODE  
:
:
UC/J SELECT  
UC  
The LENS FILE page shows the name and the f-stop  
(iris setting) of the lens currently selected.  
U15 LENS FILE  
LENS FILE SELECT:  
F.ID :  
TOP  
1
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “16:9/4:3  
SELECT”, and press MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to display the desired aspect  
ratio, and press the MENU knob.  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to LENS  
FILE SELECT, and press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
The b mark on the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
Turn the MENU knob until the lens file No. in use  
appears, then press the MENU knob.  
To display the aspect ratio of 16:9/4:3 on the  
viewfinder screen  
By setting the “DISP 16:9/4:3 ID” item on the VF DISP 2  
page of the USER menu to “ON”, “16:9” or “4:3” appears  
on the viewfinder screen when the aspect ratio of 16:9 is  
selected.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
If you do not want to use a lens file  
Select NO OFFSET.  
5
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
128  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
           
To display “16:9” in color bars  
By setting the “SHOT 16:9 ID” on the SHOT DISP page  
of the USER menu to ON, you can record a “16:9” mode  
indicator superimposed on the color bars.  
Color bars (SMPTE type)  
Color bars (EBU type)  
16:9 mode indicator on the color bar display  
7-3-9 Setting the CCD Scan Mode  
Since the camcorder has CCDs that use an “all pixels read-  
out method,” a progressive scan mode is also available in  
addition to the conventional interlace scan mode.  
You can select either of the following modes using the  
FORMAT page of the OPERATION menu.  
• I (interlace scan) mode  
• PsF (progressive scan) mode  
Installing the CBK-FC01 allows you to select the 24P  
mode.  
Each mode is described below using timing charts.  
I (interlace scan) mode  
CCD output  
Video output signal  
O: Odd  
E: Even  
Interlace scan mode timing chart  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
129  
       
The video signal of an odd scanning line and that of an  
even scanning line are output from the CCD alternately.  
Thus, the timing of the odd-field video signal and even-  
field video signal are different.  
PsF (progressive scan) mode  
CCD output  
Video output signal  
O: Odd  
E: Even  
Progressive scan mode timing chart  
The video signal of an odd scanning line and that of an  
even scanning line are output from the CCD at the same  
time. Then they are sent to the memory and separated into  
odd-field and even-field scanning lines. Thus the timing of  
an odd-field video signal and an even-field video signal are  
the same.  
24P mode (2-3 pull-down) mode (PDW-510/530 only)  
23.98 frames per second  
CCD output  
A ( O + E )  
B ( O + E )  
C ( O + E )  
D ( O + E )  
A ( O + E )  
A O  
A E  
B O  
B E  
B O  
C E  
C O  
D E  
D O  
D E  
A O  
A E  
Video output signal  
O: Odd  
E: Even  
29.97 frames per second  
24P mode timing chart  
After reading from the CCDs in 24P mode (23.98 frames  
per second), a pull-down conversion is carried out to the 30  
frames (29.97 frames per second) of the normal  
progressive scan mode.  
Setting the CCD scan mode  
The scan mode of the camcorder has been set to the  
interlace scan mode at the factory. The FORMAT page of  
the OPERATION menu allows you to change the CCD  
scan mode to the progressive scan mode or 24P mode  
(PDW-510/530 only).  
19 FORMAT  
16:9/4:3 SELECT :  
16:9  
I
SCAN MODE  
:?  
UC/J SELECT  
:
UC  
1
Follow the procedures given in steps 1 to 3 described  
FORMAT page of the OPERATION menu.  
3
Turn the MENU knob to display “PsF” or “24P”, and  
press the MENU knob.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “SCAN  
MODE”, and press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
The b mark on the left of “SCAN MODE” changes to  
a z mark and the z mark on the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
130  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
   
4
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
19 FORMAT  
16:9/4:3 SELECT :  
16:9  
PsF  
UC  
SCAN MODE  
:
:
UC/J SELECT  
7-3-10Using UMID Data  
To perform operations from interviewing to editing  
effectively and to detect audio-visual materials easily  
when reusing them, metadata that provides additional  
information is recorded along with audio-visual data on a  
disc. As one of application of metadata, the UMID  
(Unique Material Identifier) is internationally  
standardized.  
What is a UMID?  
The UMID (Unique Material Identifier) is a unique  
identifier for audio-visual material defined by the  
SMPTE330M-2003 standard.  
The UMID may be used either as the 32-byte Basic UMID  
or as the extended UMID, which includes an additional 32  
bytes of Source Pack to make a total 64 bytes.  
For details, refer to SMPTE 330M.  
Extended UMID (64 bytes)  
Basic UMID (32 bytes)  
Source Pack (32 bytes)  
Spatial  
Universal label  
12 bytes  
L
1
Inst. No. Material Number  
Time/Date  
8 bytes  
Country Org  
User  
Co-ordinates  
3 bytes  
16 bytes  
12 bytes  
4 bytes 4 bytes 4 bytes  
Globally unique ID is automatically recorded every  
shooting.  
The Extended UMID is metadata that provides additional  
information such as location, time/date, company and so  
on.  
The UMID is applied as follows.  
Source Pack  
Shooting information (when,  
where and who)  
Same as the above  
Material No.  
ID generated when shooting  
Same as the above  
Instance No.  
Original material: 00 00 00  
Copied material: generation number  
(1 byte) + random number (2 byte)  
M
M
M
Distinguishing between the  
original material and copied  
material  
Material source ID/detecting  
material  
Metadata pack that identifies  
the source of material unit by  
defining the when, where  
and who of the material unit  
with which it is associated.  
Using the Extended UMID  
You have to enter a country code, organization code and  
user code. Set the country code referring to the ISO-3166  
table, and set the organization code and user code  
independently.  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
131  
     
Proceed as follows.  
Item  
Contents  
Functions of UMID data  
The UMID data enables the followings:  
COUNTRY CODE Sets the country code.  
• Add a globally unique ID to every shot of audio-visual  
material. The unique ID is used to detect the material  
source and to link it with the original source material.  
• Distinguishing between original material and copied  
material. 00 is added to the Instance Number for original  
material.  
• Recording based on the UTC. The UTC is used when  
recording the UMID. This enables uniform control of  
source material recorded all over the world based on the  
universal time code.  
ORGANIZATION  
USER CODE  
TIME ZONE  
Sets the organization code.  
Sets the user code.  
Sets the time difference from UTC.  
4
5
6
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the item  
you want to set, and press the MENU knob.  
The b mark to the left of the selected item changes to  
a z mark and the z mark to the left of the setting  
changes to a ? mark.  
• Calculating the date difference among source materials.  
The source material is recorded based on the MJD  
(Modified Julian Date), which enables easy calculation  
of date difference among source materials.  
Turn the MENU knob to change the setting of the  
selected item or to display the desired value, and press  
the MENU knob.  
UMID Menu Setup  
The UMID SET page of the OPERATION menu allows  
you to make settings for UMID data.  
Proceed as follows.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
1
2
Holding down the MENU knob, set the MENU ON/  
OFF switch from OFF to ON.  
Additional information related to the UMID  
COUNTRY CODE  
When you select this item, the COUNTRY CODE window  
appears.  
The TOP menu appears.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“OPERATION”, and press the MENU knob.  
22 UMID SET  
TOP  
If this is the first time the Operation menu has been  
displayed, the CONTENTS page appears.  
If the menu has been used before, the last accessed  
page appears.  
COUNTRY CODE  
ORGANIZATION  
:
:
sss  
sssss  
USER CODE  
:
sssss  
TIME ZONE : 1B : -07:30  
-0123456789ABCDEFGHIJKL  
MNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghij  
klmnopqrstuvwxyz  
INS DEL RET  
ESC END  
3
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “UMID SET”, and press  
the MENU knob.  
Enter an abbreviated alphanumeric string (4-byte  
alphanumeric strings) according to the values defined in  
ISO 3166-1.  
There are about 240 country codes.  
Find your own country code on the following home page.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the UMID SET page appears, then press the  
MENU knob.  
The UMID SET page appears.  
The current settings appear on the right side of each  
item.  
Refer to ISO-3166-1:  
http://www.din.de/gremien/nas/nabd/iso3166ma/  
codlstp1/en_listp1.html  
When the country code is less than 4 bytes, the active part  
of the code will occupy the first part of the 4-bytes and the  
remainder must be filled with the space character (20h).  
Example: In the case of Japan  
?22 UMID SET  
COUNTRY CODE  
TOP  
:
ssss  
ORGANIZATION CODE: ssss  
USER CODE  
TIME ZONE  
:
ssss  
00:+00:00  
For Japan, if the country code is JP, it is 2 bytes, if JPN, it  
is 3 bytes.  
Thus, enter the following:  
JP_ _  
132  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
 
or  
JPN _  
Note  
When you change the time zone, adjust the built-in clock  
to local time and turn the power of the camcorder off and  
then the power on again.  
where _ represents a space.  
ORGANIZATION (organization code)  
When you select this item, the ORGANIZATION window  
appears.  
(Refer to the COUNTRY CODE window above.)  
Enter an abbreviated 4-byte alphanumeric string for the  
organization code.  
7-3-11Making Network Settings  
The NETWORK page of the MAINTENANCE menu  
allows you to make settings for connections to other DV  
devices via a network.  
Note  
There are no problems in recording or playing back audio-  
video signals,if ORGANIZATION is not set.  
Organization codes must be acquired by applying to the  
SMPTE registration office. When no organization code  
has been acquired, it is forbidden to enter an arbitrary  
string. As a rule, the code “00” must be entered. Freelance  
operators who do not belong to an origination should enter  
“~”.  
Enabling automatic acquisition of the IP  
address  
When the unit is shipped from the factory, automatic  
acquisition of the IP address is disabled. Proceed as  
follows to enable it.  
1
Holding down the MENU knob, set the menu switch  
from OFF to ON.  
USER CODE  
When you select this item, the USER CODE window  
appears.  
(Refer to the COUNTRY CODE window above.)  
Enter the 4-byte alphanumeric strings for user  
identification.  
The user code is registered with each organization locally.  
It is usually not centrally registered.  
When the user code is less than 4 bytes, enter the user code  
from the beginning of the 4 bytes and enter the space  
character (20h) in the remaining strings.  
This user code is determined by the organization. The  
methods used depend on the organization.  
The TOP menu appears.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“MAINTENANCE”, and press the MENU knob.  
If this is the first time the MAINTENANCE menu has  
been displayed, the CONTENTS page appears.  
If the menu has been used before, the last accessed  
page appears.  
3
If the CONTENTS page is displayed, turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “NETWORK”, and press  
the MENU knob.  
If a different page is displayed, turn the MENU knob  
until the NETWORK page appears, then press the  
MENU knob.  
Note  
User bits cannot be entered when no organization code has  
been entered.  
TIME ZONE  
When you select this item, the TIME ZONE window  
appears.  
The NETWORK page appears. The current settings of  
the items on the page appear to the right of the items.  
The UTC is calculated based on the local time, using the  
time zone. If the time zone is not set, the UTC is not  
recorded correctly.  
M18 NETWORK  
TOP  
DISABL  
DHCP  
:
:
:
:
:
:
IP ADDRESS  
SUBNET MASK  
DEF. GATEWAT  
LINK SPEED  
DUPLEX  
192 168  
1
10  
0
255 255 255  
0
0
0
0
AUTO  
AUTO  
TIME ZONE  
00.UTC  
ESC  
GREENWICH  
01.UTC-01:00 AZORES  
02.UTC-02:00 M-ATRANTIC  
03.UTC-03:00 ARZENTINE  
04.UTC-04:00 HALIFAX  
05.UTC-05:00 NEW YORK  
06.UTC-06:00 CHICAGO  
07.UTC-07:00 DENVER  
08.UTC-08:00 LOSANGELES  
09.UTC-09:00 ALASKA  
4
Press the MENU knob, and turn it to move the b mark  
to “DHCP”, then press the MENU knob.  
The b mark to the left of “DHCP” changes to a z  
mark, and the z mark to the left of the setting changes  
to a ? mark.  
Set the time difference from UTC. When setting the  
summer time or daylight savings time, change the code to  
one which will advance the time by 1 hour.  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
133  
         
5
6
Turn the MENU knob to display “ENABL”, then press  
the MENU knob.  
6
7
When you are finished, move the b mark to SET, then  
press the MENU knob.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“SUBNET MASK”, then press the MENU knob.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
SUBNET MASK setting window appears.  
8
9
Carry out steps 3 to 6 to set the subnet mask.  
Note  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “DEF.  
GATEWAY”, then press the MENU knob.  
Before enabling automatic acquisition of the IP address,  
check to be sure that this unit is connected to a network  
with a network cable.  
The DEF. GATEWAY setting window appears.  
The acquired IP address is displayed in the “IP  
ADDRESS” line of the NETWORK page.  
If an IP address could not be acquired, “0.0.0.0” is  
displayed. In this case, contact your network  
administrator.  
10Repeat steps 3 to 6 to set the default gateway.  
11To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
Setting the communications speed  
Setting the IP address, subnet mask, and  
default gateway  
The unit is shipped from the factory with the following  
settings.  
Set the communications speed by choosing AUTO,  
10Mbps, or 100Mbps from the menu.  
The factory default setting is “AUTO”.  
Proceed as follows.  
IP ADDRESS:  
192.168. 1.10  
SUBNET MASK: 255.255.255. 0  
DEF. GATEWAY: 0. 0. 0. 0  
Proceed as follows to change the settings.  
1
Carry out steps 1 to 3 in “Enabling automatic  
the NETWORK page of the MAINTENANCE menu.  
1
Carry out steps 1 to 3 in “Enabling automatic  
the NETWORK page of the MAINTENANCE menu.  
2
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “LINK  
SPEED”, then press the MENU knob.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired value, then press the MENU knob.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “IP  
ADDRESS”, then press the MENU knob.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
The IP ADDRESS setting window appears.  
3
4
Move the b mark to the value that you want to change,  
Setting the communications mode (full  
duplex or half duplex)  
Set the communications speed by choosing AUTO, FULL  
(full duplex) or HALF (half duplex) from the menu.  
The factory default setting is “AUTO”.  
Proceed as follows.  
then press the MENU knob.  
The b mark changes to a ? mark.  
Turn the MENU knob to display the desired value,  
then press the MENU knob.  
The ? mark changes to a b mark.  
1
Carry out steps 1 to 3 in “Enabling automatic  
the NETWORK page of the MAINTENANCE menu.  
To cancel the change and restore the standard  
setting  
Push the CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE switch to the  
CANCEL/PRST side.  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“DUPLEX”, then press the MENU knob.  
106).  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired mode, then press the MENU knob.  
5
Repeat steps 3 and 4 to set the remaining values.  
134  
7-3 Adjustments and Settings from Menus  
4
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
7-4 Resetting USER  
Menu Settings to the  
Standard Settings  
You can return all settings in the USER menu to the  
standard settings. It is also possible to change the standard  
settings from their factory default values.  
For details on how to change the factory settings, refer to  
the Maintenance Manual.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
The last accessed menu appears on the screen.  
Turn the MENU knob until the USER FILE page  
appears, and press the MENU knob.  
The USER FILE page appears.  
U16 USER FILE  
USER FILE LOAD  
USER FILE SAVE  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
F.ID : sssssssssssssssss  
USER PRESET EXEC  
:
USER FILE page  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “USER  
PRESET”, and press the MENU knob.  
The message “LOAD OK? YES b NO” appears.  
U16 USER FILE  
LOAD OK?  
USER FILE LOAD  
USER FILE SAVE  
YES NO  
: EXEC  
:
EXEC  
F.ID : sssssssssssssssss  
USER PRESET EXEC  
:
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to”YES”,  
and press the MENU knob.  
The settings for all items in the USER menu are reset  
to the standard settings.  
7-4 Resetting USER Menu Settings to the Standard Settings  
135  
       
Saving and Loading User  
Setting Data  
8
Chapter  
8-1-1 Handling the “Memory Stick”  
8-1 Saving and Loading  
User Files to and  
from a “Memory  
Stick”  
The “Memory Stick” can be inserted to or removed from  
the camcorder with the power turned on or off.  
Inserting the “Memory Stick”  
Proceed as follows.  
1
Open the cover of the menu operating section.  
The camcorder is equipped with a “Memory Stick” drive,  
which enables you to save user files, scene files, lens files,  
reference files and ALLfiles. You can load these files  
from the “Memory Stick” for immediate recall of a  
particular setting configuration.  
The “Memory Stick” slot is now visible.  
When a menu page is displayed, you can set up the  
camcorder so that inserting a “Memory Stick”  
automatically jumps to the appropriate file-related menu  
page.  
For details about scene files, see 8-2 “Saving and Loading  
For details about lens files, reference files and “ALL”  
files, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
For details of the function for jumping to the appropriate  
145.  
2
Hold the “Memory Stick” with the notch facing  
downward and the arrow facing away from you, and  
insert the “Memory Stick” into the “Memory Stick”  
slot until it clicks into place. Then close the cover.  
“Memory Sticks” usable with this  
camcorder  
With this camcorder, you can use “Memory Sticks” whose  
capacity does not exceed 128 MB.  
For details, see “Memory Stick” in the Specifications on  
“Memory Stick”  
Inserting the “Memory Stick”  
136  
8-1 Saving and Loading User Files to and from a “Memory Stick”  
                 
• Avoid getting liquids on the “Memory Stick”.  
• Avoid using or storing the “Memory Stick” in a location  
subject to:  
- extremely high temperature such as the hot inside of a  
car or the outdoors exposed to a burning sun, or a place  
near a heater.  
Note  
If it does not fit into the slot properly or if there is some  
resistance when you insert it, the “Memory Stick” may be  
turned around or upside down. Do not force the “Memory  
Stick” into the slot. Confirm the direction of the notch and  
arrow on the “Memory Stick” before inserting the  
“Memory Stick”, and then try inserting it again.  
- direct sunlight  
- high humidity  
- excessive dust  
Removing the “Memory Stick”  
• When storing and carrying the “Memory Stick”, keep it  
in its original case to ensure protection of important data.  
• When carrying the camcorder with the “Memory Stick”  
inserted, close the cover of the menu operating section.  
• Avoid removing the “Memory Stick” from the insertion  
slot while the access indicator is lit.  
Check that the access indicator is not lit, then gently press  
in the “Memory Stick” and release. It pops out, and you  
can withdraw it from the slot.  
• Do not format the “Memory Stick” using a PC.  
For formatting the “Memory Stick”, see the description  
of the MEMORY STICK page of the FILE menu on  
8-1-2 Saving User Menu Data to the  
“Memory Stick”  
Check that the access  
indicator is not lit  
Gently press in  
You can save USER menu settings held in the camcorder  
as user files in the “Memory Stick”.  
Removing the “Memory Stick”  
You can save up to 100 user files in the “Memory Stick”.  
Insert the “Memory Stick”, then proceed as follows.  
Note  
Do not remove the “Memory Stick” while the access  
indicator is lit. You may lose data, or damage the “Memory  
Stick”.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
Protecting saved data  
To prevent accidental erasure of important setup data, use  
the LOCK switch on the “Memory Stick”.  
Turn the MENU knob until the USER FILE page  
appears, then press the MENU knob to select the page.  
Slide the switch right to the write protect position. It is now  
impossible to write or delete data on the “Memory Stick”.  
U15 USER FILE  
USER FILE LOAD  
USER FILE SAVE  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
F.ID : sssssssssssssssss  
USER PRESET EXEC  
:
If you want to set a file ID for the data to be saved  
Set the file ID before going to step 3.  
LOCK switch on the “Memory Stick”  
For details on setting the file ID, see “Setting the file  
Notes on using and storing the “Memory  
Stick”  
• Avoid touching the connector of the “Memory Stick” or  
contacting it with a metal object.  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to USER  
FILE SAVE, and press the MENU knob.  
• When attaching a label to the “Memory Stick”, use only  
the label supplied for the “Memory Stick”.  
• Do not drop, bend, or submit the “Memory Stick” to  
external shock.  
The P00 USER SAVE page appears.  
• Do not disassemble or modify the “Memory Stick”.  
8-1 Saving and Loading User Files to and from a “Memory Stick”  
137  
   
If you select a file number where data has already  
been saved  
The message “OVERWRITE OK? YES b NO”  
appears. In this case, the b mark appears on the left of  
“NO”, which is flashing.  
• To stop overwriting, press the MENU knob.  
• To overwrite, move the b mark to “YES” and press  
the MENU knob.  
?P00 USER SAVE  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
:
001.NEW FILE  
002.NEW FILE  
003.NEW FILE  
004.NEW FILE  
005.NEW FILE  
When a ? appears on the left of “P00” at the top left of  
the page, you can change the page. Up to 20 pages,  
from P00 to P19, can be used to save user files in the  
“Memory Stick”. Each page can hold up to 5 files.  
You can select the information displayed on each  
USER SAVE or USER LOAD page.  
4
5
6
Turn the MENU knob until the page which contains  
the desired file number appears, and press the MENU  
knob.  
7
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
P00 USER SAVE  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
The menu disappears from the viewfinder screen, and  
the display indicating the current status of the  
camcorder appears along the top and bottom of the  
screen.  
:
001.NEW FILE  
002.NEW FILE  
003.NEW FILE  
004.NEW FILE  
005.NEW FILE  
USER menu settings to be saved in the “Memory  
Stick”  
Settings for items on all pages of the USER menu are  
saved in the “Memory Stick” as a user file. However, you  
can select the items which are not to be saved in the  
“Memory Stick”.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired file number, and press the MENU knob.  
The message “SAVE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
For details, refer to the Maintenance Manual.  
P00 USER SAVE  
SAVE OK?  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
When a file number is  
shown as “NEW FILE”,  
this means that the file  
is empty. When data is  
stored in a file number,  
the file name appears.  
If data cannot be saved  
If one of the following error messages appears during or  
after the save operation, then the data was not saved.  
YES NO  
:
001.NEW FILE  
002.NEW FILE  
003.NEW FILE  
004.NEW FILE  
005.NEW FILE  
Data save error messages  
Error message  
Cause  
Action  
NO MEMORY  
STICK (flashing) Stick” is inserted. “Memory Stick”.  
No “Memory  
Insert or reinsert the  
To carry out the save, move the b mark to “YES” and  
press the MENU knob.  
To cancel, press the MENU knob leaving the b mark  
pointing to “NO”.  
MEMORY STICK The LOCK  
LOCKED  
Set the LOCK switch  
to the write enable  
position.  
switch on the  
“Memory Stick”  
is set to the write  
protect position.  
The access indicator lights.  
MEMORY STICK Circuit or  
ERROR  
(flashing)  
Check the circuitry, or  
replace the “Memory  
Stick” .  
When the saving is completed, the message  
“COMPLETE” appears and the access indicator goes  
off.  
“Memory Stick”  
fault.  
Setting the file ID  
Before data is saved to a “Memory Stick”, it is useful to set  
a file ID for the “Memory Stick” to identify it.  
When data is saved to a “Memory Stick”, the file ID is  
saved to the “Memory Stick” together with the data.  
If no “Memory Stick” has been inserted, the message  
“NO MEMORY STICK” will appear. Insert a  
“Memory Stick”.  
138  
8-1 Saving and Loading User Files to and from a “Memory Stick”  
   
Selecting the display contents  
Note  
Set the file ID before saving data in the “Memory Stick”.  
Otherwise, the file ID is not saved with the other data.  
You can select the contents of the file to be displayed on  
the USER SAVE page and USER LOAD page.  
Proceed as follows.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
1
On the USER FILE page, turn the MENU knob to  
move the b mark to “F. ID”.  
“DISPLAY MODE”, and press the MENU knob.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark until the  
desired type of the display contents (see the following  
table) appears, then press the MENU knob.  
U16 USER FILE  
TOP  
USER FILE LOAD  
USER FILE SAVE  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
F.ID : sssssssssssssssss  
P00 USER LOAD  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
USER PRESET  
:
EXEC  
:
F.ID  
001.USER1  
002.USER2  
003.NO FILE  
004.USER4  
005.USER5  
2
Press the MENU knob.  
A character table appears, allowing you to select  
characters you want to enter.  
Display type Description  
ALL  
File ID (10 characters) and date ((month/  
day/year) for PDW-510/530 and (day/month/  
year) for PDW-510P/530P)  
U16 USER FILE  
TOP  
USER FILE LOAD  
USER FILE SAVE  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
F.ID :?  
x
F.ID  
File ID (16 characters)  
DATE  
Saved date (year/month/day/hours/minutes/  
seconds)  
$%&'()*+,-./0123456789:  
;<=>?@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR  
STUVWXYZ[\]_  
INS DEL RET  
ESC END  
MODEL  
Information on the model  
8-1-3 Loading saved data from a  
“Memory Stick”  
3
4
Follow the procedure of steps 4 and 5 described in 7-  
ID.  
Note  
When you finish entering the file ID, turn the MENU  
knob to move the x mark to “END”, then press the  
MENU knob.  
The data loaded from the “Memory Stick” overwrites the  
data saved in the camcorder.  
The entered file ID is now displayed.  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON.  
13 USER FILE  
TOP  
USER FILE LOAD  
USER FILE SAVE  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
The last accessed menu page appears on the screen.  
F.ID : sssssssssssssssss  
Turn the MENU knob until the USER FILE page  
appears, then press the MENU knob. Alternatively,  
select “USER FILE” on the CONTENTS page.  
USER PRESET  
:
EXEC  
File ID set in step 3  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “USER  
FILE LOAD”, and press the MENU knob.  
After setting the file ID, carry out the procedure from  
step 3 in 7-1-2 “Saving User Menu Data to the  
“Memory Stick”” on page 137.  
The P00 USER LOAD page appears.  
The set file ID is saved in the “Memory Stick” with the  
data.  
8-1 Saving and Loading User Files to and from a “Memory Stick”  
139  
     
Data load error messages  
?P00 USER LOAD  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
Error message  
Cause  
Action  
Insert or reinsert the  
:
NO MEMORY  
STICK (flashing) Stick” is inserted. “Memory Stick”.  
No “Memory  
001.USER1  
002.USER2  
003.NO FILE  
004.USER4  
005.USER5  
JAN/01/04  
JAN/15/04  
FEB/05/04  
FEB/20/04  
MEMORY STICK Circuit or  
Recheck, and  
ERROR  
(flashing)  
“Memory Stick”  
fault.  
consult your Sony  
representative.  
FILE ERROR  
(flashing)  
The “Memory  
Stick” contains  
data that cannot  
be loaded into this  
camcorder.  
Do not try to load  
data saved from  
another camcorder.  
4
5
Turn the MENU knob until the page which contains  
the desired file number appears, then press the MENU  
knob.  
P00 USER LOAD  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
:
001.USER1  
002.USER2  
003.NO FILE  
004.USER4  
005.USER5  
JAN/01/04  
JAN/15/04  
FEB/05/04  
FEB/20/04  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired file number to be loaded, and press the MENU  
knob.  
The message “LOAD OK? YES b NO” appears.  
P00 USER LOAD  
LOAD OK?  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
YES NO  
:
001.USER1  
002.USER2  
003.NO FILE  
004.USER4  
005.USER5  
JAN/01/04  
JAN/15/04  
FEB/05/04  
FEB/20/04  
6
7
To carry out the load, move the b mark to “YES” and  
press the MENU knob.  
To cancel, press the MENU knob leaving the b mark  
pointing to “NO”.  
The access indicator lights.  
When the load is completed, the message  
“COMPLETE” appears and the access indicator goes  
off.  
The USER FILE page appears again.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
If data cannot be loaded  
If one of the following error messages appears during or  
after the load operation, then the data was not loaded.  
140  
8-1 Saving and Loading User Files to and from a “Memory Stick”  
For details on setting the file ID, see “Setting the file  
8-2 Saving and Loading  
Scene Files  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “SCENE  
STORE”, and press the MENU knob.  
You can save various settings for shooting a particular  
scene as a scene file. Loading the scene file, you can  
quickly recreate setup conditions suitable for the scene.  
You can save up to five scene files in the camcorder  
memory and up to 100 scene files in a “Memory Stick”.  
You can also load data from the “Memory Stick” into the  
camcorder memory.  
F04 SCENE FILE  
TOP  
s
s
s
s
s
s
1
2
3
4
5
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
STANDARD  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
F.ID:  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
The SCENE STORE page appears.  
Data that can be saved in a scene file  
You can save the following data in a scene file:  
• Values adjusted using the PAINT menu  
?P00 SCENE STORE  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
:
MEM-01:STANDARD  
MEM-02:STANDARD  
MEM-03:STANDARD  
MEM-04:STANDARD  
MEM-05:STANDARD  
For details of the PAINT menu, refer to the Maintenance  
Manual.  
• Shutter speed settings made in the standard mode and  
ECS mode  
• The white balance data included in a scene file depends  
on the SCENE WHITE DATA setting on the  
REFERENCE page of the FILE menu.  
4
Select the desired file number.  
When no “Memory Stick” has been inserted  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired file number, and press the MENU knob.  
When the save is completed, the SCENE FILE page  
appears again.  
8-2-1 Saving a Scene File  
When you select a file number where data has  
already been saved  
The message “OVERWRITE OK? YES b NO”  
appears. In this case, the b mark is placed on the left  
of “NO”.  
Proceed as follows to save a scene file in the camcorder  
memory or the “Memory Stick”.  
To save a scene file in the “Memory Stick”, insert the  
“Memory Stick” before starting the operation.  
• To stop overwriting, press the MENU knob.  
• To overwrite, move the b mark to “YES” and press  
the MENU knob.  
1
2
In the TOP menu, select the FILE menu.  
Turn the MENU knob until the SCENE FILE page  
appears, then press the MENU knob to select the page.  
Alternatively, select “SCENE FILE” on the  
When a “Memory Stick” has been inserted  
You can use up to 20 pages, from P01 to P20, to save  
scene files in the “Memory Stick”. Each page can hold  
up to 5 files.  
CONTENTS page to display the SCENE FILE page.  
04 SCENE FILE  
TOP  
1 Turn the MENU knob until the page which  
contains the desired file number appears, then press  
the MENU knob.  
s
s
s
s
s
s
1
2
3
4
5
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
STANDARD  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
F.ID:  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
If you want to set a file ID for the data to be saved  
Set the file ID before going to step 3.  
8-2 Saving and Loading Scene Files  
141  
         
When SCENE WHITE DATA is set to ON  
The white balance setting data selected when you save the  
scene file is saved. For example, when the WHITE BAL  
switch is set to A, the adjusted values in memory A are  
saved in the scene file, and when the WHITE BAL switch  
is set to PRST, the preset value is saved.  
P01 SCENE STORE  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
:
001.SCENE1  
FEB/05/02  
002.STANDARD  
003.STANDARD  
004.STANDARD  
005.STANDARD  
***.5FILE SAVE  
MEM1-5  
When SCENE WHITE DATA is set to OFF  
White balance setting data is not stored in the scene file.  
2 Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired file number, and press the MENU knob.  
The message “STORE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
Saving scene files from the camcorder  
memory to the “Memory Stick”  
You can save five scene files from the camcorder to the  
“Memory Stick” in a single operation.  
Proceed as follows.  
P01 SCENE STORE  
STORE OK?  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
YES NO  
:
001.SCENE1  
FEB/05/02  
002.STANDARD  
003.STANDARD  
004.STANDARD  
005.STANDARD  
1
After displaying the SCENE FILE page (see page 141)  
turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “SCENE  
STORE”, then press the MENU knob.  
***.5FILE SAVE  
MEM1-5  
One of the SCENE STORE pages appears.  
3 To carry out the storing, move the b mark to  
“YES” and press the MENU knob.  
2
Turn the MENU knob until the desired SCENE  
STORE page appears, then press the MENU knob.  
To cancel, press the MENU knob leaving the b  
mark pointing to “NO”.  
P01 SCENE STORE  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
You can select the contents of the user file to be  
displayed on the page.  
:
001.SCENE1  
002.SCENE2  
003.NO FILE  
004.SCENE4  
005.SCENE5  
FEB/05/02  
FEB/06/02  
FEB/08/02  
FEB/08/02  
***.5FILE SAVE  
MEM1-5  
5
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
3
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “5FILE  
SAVE B MEM1-5”, and press the MENU knob.  
To return to the SCENE FILE page  
After the message “COMPLETE” is displayed, move  
the b mark to “ESC” at the top right of the page by  
turning the MENU knob, then press the MENU knob.  
The message “SAVE OK? YES b NO” appears.  
P01 SCENE STORE  
SAVE OK?  
DISPLAY MODE  
ESC  
ALL  
YES NO  
:
White balance setting data to be saved in  
the scene file  
The white balance setting data to be saved in the scene file  
depends on the setting of the SCENE WHITE DATA item  
on the REFERENCE page of the FILE menu.  
001.SCENE1  
002.SCENE2  
003.NO FILE  
004.SCENE4  
005.SCENE5  
***.5FILE SAVE  
MEM1-5  
F05 REFERENCE  
4
5
To carry out the save, move the b mark to “YES” and  
press the MENU knob.  
To cancel, press the MENU knob leaving the b mark  
pointing to “NO”.  
REFERENCE STORE :  
REFERENCE CLEAR :  
EXEC  
EXEC  
REFERENCE LOAD EXEC  
REFERENCE SAVE EXEC  
F.ID: sssssssssssssssss  
:
:
SCENE WHITE DATA:  
OFF  
When the save is completed, the message  
“COMPLETE” appears.  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF.  
142  
8-2 Saving and Loading Scene Files  
   
Note  
04 SCENE FILE  
TOP  
If files have been saved in the page selected in step 2, those  
files are replaced with files loaded from the camcorder  
memory. For example, files from 001 to 005 are replaced.  
s
s
s
s
s
s
1
2
3
4
5
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
STANDARD  
Setting the file ID  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
F.ID: SCENE21  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
Before the data is saved as a scene file, it is useful to set a  
file ID to identify it. The set file ID is saved together with  
the data.  
Carry out the procedure from step 3 in 8-2-1 “Saving  
To set the file ID, proceed as follows.  
The set file ID is saved together with the data.  
1
On the SCENE FILE page, turn the MENU knob to  
move the b mark to “F. ID”.  
Selecting the display contents  
You can select the items of file information to be displayed  
on the SCENE STORE pages (P01 to P20) or the SCENE  
RECALL pages (P01 to P20) used for saving data to or  
loading data from a “Memory Stick”.  
F04 SCENE FILE  
TOP  
s
s
s
s
s
s
1
2
3
4
5
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
:STANDARD  
STANDARD  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
F.ID:  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
8-2-2 Loading Scene Files  
2
Press the MENU knob.  
Proceed as follows.  
A character table appears, allowing you to select  
characters you want to enter.  
1
2
In the TOP menu, select the FILE menu.  
U16 USER FILE  
TOP  
Turn the MENU knob until the SCENE FILE page  
appears, then press the MENU knob to select the page.  
Alternatively, on the CONTENTS page select  
“SCENE FILE”, and press the MENU knob to display  
the SCENE FILE page.  
$%&'()*+,-./0123456789:  
;<=>?@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR  
STUVWXYZ[\]_  
INS DEL RET  
ESC END  
s
STANDARD  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
F.ID:  
x
3
Load the scene file.  
To load the scene file stored in the camcorder  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
desired file number, and press the MENU knob.  
The s which is displayed on the left of the file number  
changes to x.  
3
4
Carry out the operations for steps 4 and 5 described in  
file ID.  
Note  
The camcorder is set up according to the loaded scene  
file.  
Set the file ID before saving the scene file in the  
“Memory Stick” or the camcorder memory.  
Otherwise, the file ID is not saved with the other data.  
04 SCENE FILE  
TOP  
s
x
s
s
s
s
1
2
3
4
5
:SCENE 25  
:SCENE 26  
:SCENE 27  
:SCENE 28  
:NO FILE  
When you finish entering the file ID, turn the MENU  
knob to move the x mark to “END”, then press the  
MENU knob.  
STANDARD  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
F.ID: SCENE21  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
The SCENE FILE page appears again.  
To cancel the selected scene file  
Move the b mark to x, and press the MENU knob. x  
changes to s.  
8-2 Saving and Loading Scene Files  
143  
             
The camcorder returns to the settings before selecting  
this scene file.  
1
After displaying the SCENE FILE page (see page  
143), turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“SCENE RECALL”, and press the MENU knob.  
To load a scene file saved in the “Memory Stick”  
Proceed as follows.  
A SCENE RECALL page appears.  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob until the SCENE RECALL  
page which contains the desired scene files appears,  
then press the MENU knob.  
1 Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to  
“SCENE RECALL”, and press the MENU knob.  
The P00 SCENE RECALL page appears.  
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “5FILE  
LOAD b MEM 1-5”, and press the MENU knob.  
?P00 SCENE RECALL  
ESC  
DISPLAY MODE  
:
F.ID  
The message “RECALL OK? YES bNO” appears.  
MEM<1>:STANDARD  
MEM<2>:STANDARD  
MEM<3>:STANDARD  
MEM<4>:STANDARD  
MEM<5>:NO FILE  
P01 SCENE RECALL  
RECALL OK? YES NO  
ESC  
ALL  
DISPLAY MODE  
:
001.SCENE1  
002.SCENE2  
003.NO FILE  
004.SCENE4  
005.SCENE5  
2 Turn the MENU knob until the page which  
contains the desired file number appears, then press  
the MENU knob.  
***.5FILE LOAD  
MEM1-5  
3 Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to the  
4
5
To carry out the recall, move the b mark to “YES” and  
press the MENU knob.  
To cancel, press the MENU knob leaving the b mark  
pointing to “NO”.  
desired file number, and press the MENU knob.  
The message “RECALL OK? YES bNO”  
appears.  
When loading is complete, the message  
“COMPLETE” appears and the access indicator goes  
off.  
P01 SCENE RECALL  
RECALL OK? YES NO  
ESC  
ALL  
DISPLAY MODE  
:
001.SCENE1  
002.SCENE2  
003.NO FILE  
004.SCENE4  
005.SCENE5  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
***.5FILE LOAD  
MEM1-5  
Notes  
• The scene files loaded from the “Memory Stick”  
overwrite data saved in the camcorder memory.  
• To load the scene file saved in the camcorder memory  
when the “Memory Stick” is inserted, return to the P00  
SCENE RECALL page and load the desired scene file in  
the camcorder memory.  
• When there is no file to be loaded (shown as “NO  
FILE”), an existing file of the same number is  
unaffected. In the example shown in step 3, MEM(3) is  
not overwritten.  
4
5
To carry out the recall, move the b mark to “YES” and  
press the MENU knob.  
To cancel, press the MENU knob leaving the b mark  
pointing to “NO”.  
When the loading is completed, the message  
“COMPLETE” appears. The camcorder is set up  
according to the loaded scene file.  
If no file is present with a particular file number, this  
is shown as “NO FILE”.  
8-2-3 Resetting the Settings of the  
Camcorder to the Standard  
Settings Saved in the  
To end the menu operation, set the MENU ON/OFF  
switch to OFF or close the cover of the menu operating  
section.  
Reference File  
Loading scene files from a “Memory Stick”  
into the camcorder memory  
You can load up to five scene files stored in the “Memory  
Stick” into the camcorder memory in a single operation.  
You can reset the settings of the camcorder to the settings  
saved in the reference file (standard settings).  
144  
8-2 Saving and Loading Scene Files  
   
For details about the items in the reference file, refer to the  
Maintenance Manual.  
8-3 Jumping to a File-  
Related Menu Page  
When Inserting a  
On the SCENE FILE page (see page 143), turn the MENU  
knob to move the b mark to “STANDARD”, and press the  
MENU knob.  
“Memory Stick”  
F04 SCENE FILE  
TOP  
s
s
s
s
s
x
1
2
3
4
5
:SCENE 25  
:SCENE 26  
:SCENE 27  
:SCENE 28  
:NO FILE  
A “Memory Stick” enables you to save user files, scene  
files, lens files, reference files and “ALL” files. The  
camcorder menu system allows you to make a setting so  
that when a “Memory Stick” holding these files is inserted  
while in menu operating mode, a menu page relating to the  
desired file is automatically displayed on the screen. Thus  
you can proceed to file operation quickly. This is very  
convenient especially when you manage data files using  
“Memory Stick”s.  
STANDARD  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
F.ID: SCENE21  
:
:
EXEC  
EXEC  
The s displayed on the left of STANDARD changes to x.  
When x changes to s, the settings of the camcorder are  
reset to the settings saved in the reference file.  
If you press the MENU knob again while x is displayed,  
the operation is cancelled and the camcorder returns to the  
settings before STANDARD was selected.  
To make this setting, proceed as follows.  
1
2
In the TOP menu, select the FILE menu.  
Turn the MENU knob until the MEMORY STICK  
page of the FILE menu appears, then press the MENU  
knob to select the page. Alternatively, on the  
CONTENTS page select MEMORY STICK to display  
the MEMORY STICK page.  
09 MEMORY STICK  
TOP  
FORMAT  
MS IN > JUMP TO :  
:
EXEC  
OFF  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to move the b mark to “MS IN  
> JUMP TO”, and press the MENU knob.  
The b mark on the left of “MS IN > JUMP TO”  
changes to a z mark and the z mark on the left of the  
setting changes to a ? mark.  
Turn the MENU knob to select the desired setting  
(target FILE menu page).  
Setting  
OFF  
Description  
Disables this function.  
USER  
ALL  
Jumps to the USER FILE page.  
Jumps to the ALL FILE page.  
Jumps to the SCENE FILE page.  
Jumps to the LENS FILE 1 page.  
Jumps to the REFERENCE page.  
SCENE  
LENS  
REFER  
8-3 Jumping to a File-Related Menu Page When Inserting a “Memory Stick”  
145  
     
Setting  
Description  
USER 1  
Jumps to the USER 1 page.  
5
Press the MENU knob to confirm the selection.  
The z mark changes to a b mark and the ? mark  
changes to a z mark.  
Notes  
In the following cases, jumping to the target page is  
impossible.  
• When the power is turned on after you insert a “Memory  
Stick”.  
• When OFF is selected for the MS IN > JUMP TO item.  
• When any of the following menu pages is already  
displayed.  
- A file-related page such as the USER FILE page of the  
FILE menu  
- MEMORY STICK, ALL FILE, SCENE FILE, LENS  
FILE, REFERENCE FILE or ROM VERSION page  
146  
8-3 Jumping to a File-Related Menu Page When Inserting a “Memory Stick”  
Setting Up the  
Camcorder  
9
Chapter  
Attaching the battery pack  
9-1 Power Supply  
1
Press the battery pack against the back of the  
camcorder, aligning the line on the side of the battery  
pack with the matching line on the camcorder.  
The following power supplies can be used with the  
camcorder.  
• BP-GL65/GL95/L60S Lithium-ion Battery Pack  
Back of camcorder  
• BP-M100 Nickel Metal Hydride Rechargeable Battery  
Pack  
• AC power using the AC-550/550CE or AC-DN10 AC  
adaptor  
BP-GL65/  
GL95/L60S/  
M100  
Align these  
lines.  
9-1-1 Using a Battery Pack  
When a BP-GL95 Battery Pack is used, the camcorder will  
operate continuously for about 120 minutes. Before use,  
charge the battery pack with a BC-M150 Battery Charger.  
It takes about 180 minutes to charge one BP-GL95.  
2
Slide the battery pack down until its “LOCK” arrow  
points at the matching line on the camcorder.  
For details, refer to the battery charger operation manual.  
When a BP-M100 Battery Pack is used, the camcorder will  
operate for about 120 minutes. Before use, charge the  
battery pack with a BC-M50 Battery Charger. It takes  
about 240 minutes to charge one BP-M100.  
For details, refer to the battery charger operation manual.  
“LOCK”  
arrow  
Note on using the battery pack  
A warm battery pack may not be able to be fully recharged.  
Matching line on  
the camcorder  
9-1 Power Supply  
147  
                       
Detaching the battery pack  
to an AC power source  
Power switch on  
ACCESS  
indicator  
AC Adaptor  
AC-550/  
550CE  
Holding the  
button in, pull  
the battery  
pack up.  
DC OUT  
DC IN  
DC output cable (supplied with  
the AC-550/550CE)  
Using an AC adaptor  
Using the AC-DN10 AC adaptor  
Mount the AC-DN10 on the camcorder in the same way as  
a battery pack, then connect to the AC power supply. The  
AC-DN10 can supply up to 100 W of power.  
Detaching the battery pack  
Note  
During recording or playback (while the ACCESS  
indicator is lit), be careful never to remove the battery  
pack.  
9-1-2 Avoiding Breaks in Operation  
Due to an exhausted Battery  
to an AC power  
source  
When the battery pack is becoming exhausted, you can  
perform battery replacement without causing a break to the  
camcorder operation by using an AC adaptor.  
To do this, proceed as follows.  
Connecting to an AC power source using the AC-DN10 AC Adaptor  
9-1-4 Using the Anton Bauer  
Ultralight System  
1
Connect an AC-550/AC-550CE Adaptor to an AC  
power source, then connect it to the DC IN connector  
of the camcorder.  
By fitting the camcorder with the Anton Bauer Ultralight  
system, and setting the LIGHT switch to AUTO, you can  
switch the light on and off automatically as you start and  
stop REC operation. This system operates with lights  
powered by 12 V, with a maximum power consumption of  
50 W.  
For details, see the next section.  
The power source switches automatically from the  
battery pack to the AC adaptor connected to the DC IN  
connector.  
Note  
There may be some noise on the video signal at the  
time of power source switching.  
2
Replace the battery pack with a fully charged one.  
9-1-3 Using an AC Adaptor  
Using the AC-550/550CE AC adaptor  
Connect the camcorder to the AC power supply through  
the AC-550/550CE AC Adaptor as shown in the following  
figure, and turn the POWER switch of the AC-550/550CE  
on.  
148  
9-1 Power Supply  
               
1
2
3
Loosen the viewfinder front-rear positioning lever and  
the LOCK knob.  
9-2 Adjusting the  
Viewfinder  
Slide the viewfinder longitudinally to the most  
convenient position.  
Tighten the viewfinder front-rear positioning lever and  
the LOCK knob.  
For maximum viewing convenience, you can adjust the  
viewfinder position in the left-right and backward-forward  
directions.  
9-2-2 Adjusting the Viewfinder  
Focus and Screen  
9-2-1 Adjusting the Viewfinder  
Position  
Adjusting the viewfinder focus  
Turn the diopter adjustment ring until the viewfinder  
image is sharpest.  
Adjusting the position to the left or right  
Proceed as follows.  
Diopter adjustment ring  
Adjusting the position to the left or right  
Adjusting the viewfinder focus  
Adjusting the viewfinder screen  
Adjust the brightness, contrast, and peaking of the  
viewfinder screen with the controls shown below.  
1
2
3
Loosen the viewfinder left-right positioning ring.  
Slide the viewfinder to the most convenient position.  
Tighten the viewfinder left-right positioning ring.  
BRIGHT control  
To store the camcorder in the carrying case  
Always store the camcorder with the viewfinder moved  
fully in the direction opposite to the barrel and the  
viewfinder left-right positioning ring tightened.  
CONTRAST  
control  
PEAKING  
control  
Adjusting the position backward or  
forward  
Proceed as follows.  
Adjusting the viewfinder screen  
Adjusting the position backward or forward  
9-2 Adjusting the Viewfinder  
149  
           
2
Fit two of the four holes in the back of the viewfinder  
shoe over the upper two pins on the fixing plate. Make  
sure that the triangular mark on the viewfinder shoe is  
pointing up.  
9-2-3 Detaching the Viewfinder  
Viewfinder stopper  
Pins  
Fit these holes over  
the pins.  
Triangular mark  
3
Using the bolts and spring washers removed in step 1,  
fix the viewfinder shoe to the camcorder.  
Detaching the viewfinder  
1
2
3
Point the viewfinder barrel up or down.  
Loosen the viewfinder left-right positioning ring.  
Holding the viewfinder stopper up, slide the  
viewfinder in the direction indicated by the arrow and  
detach it.  
4
Remove the viewfinder cable and microphone cable  
from the clamps and disconnect them.  
9-2-4 Moving the viewfinder shoe  
up  
9-2-5 Using the BKW-401  
Viewfinder Rotation Bracket  
1
Using a hexagonal wrench 2.5 mm across flats,  
remove the bolts (M3 × 25) and spring washers, to  
detach the viewfinder shoe from the camcorder body.  
By fitting a BKW-401 Viewfinder Rotation Bracket (not  
supplied), you can rotate the viewfinder out of the way so  
that your right leg does not hit the viewfinder while you are  
carrying the camcorder.  
Viewfinder shoe assembly (A-8278-412-G)  
Using the BKW-401 Viewfinder Rotation Bracket  
To fit the BKW-401 to the camcorder, proceed as follows.  
150  
9-2 Adjusting the Viewfinder  
             
1
Turn the arm of the rotation mechanism assembly of  
the BKW-401 in the direction of the arrow in the  
following illustration.  
Next, using a hexagonal wrench 3 mm across flats,  
remove the bolts (M4 × 8), to separate the rotation  
mechanism assembly from the viewfinder front-back  
positioning mechanism assembly.  
9-2-6 Detaching the Eyepiece  
Removing the eyepiece gives a clearer view of the screen  
from further away. It is also easy to remove dust from the  
viewfinder screen and mirror when the eyepiece is  
detached.  
1
Turn the eyepiece locking ring fully counterclockwise,  
to align the red marks on the locking ring and the  
viewfinder barrel.  
2
3
Remove the two M3 × 10 hexagon socket bolts from  
the front-back positioning mechanism assembly,  
together with the washers. Take care not to lose these  
bolts and washers.  
Red mark  
Red mark  
Hexagon socket bolts  
(M3 × 10)  
Line up the red marks.  
Locking ring  
Using a hexagonal wrench 2.5 mm across flats, detach  
the viewfinder shoe from the camcorder body.  
2
Detach the eyepiece.  
Reattaching the eyepiece  
1
2
Align the red marks on the eyepiece locking ring and  
the viewfinder barrel.  
4
Using the two bolts (M3 × 10) and washers removed in  
step 2, attach the rotation mechanism assembly of the  
BKW-401 to the camcorder.  
Align the red mark on the end of the eyepiece end with  
the red marks on the eyepiece locking ring and the  
viewfinder barrel. Then insert the eyepiece into the  
viewfinder barrel.  
9-2 Adjusting the Viewfinder  
151  
   
9-3 Mounting the Lens  
To mount the lens, proceed as follows.  
For information about using the lens, refer to the lens  
manual.  
Red mark on the end of the eyepiece  
Lens mount  
securing rubber  
3
Turn the eyepiece locking ring clockwise until its  
“LOCK” arrow points at the red mark on the  
viewfinder barrel.  
Note  
When the eyecup is worn out, replace it with a new one  
(service part number 3-723-079-03).  
(The camcorder was shipped with an eyecup whose part  
number is 3-776-341-01.)  
Mounting the lens  
1
2
3
Push the lens locking lever up and remove the lens  
mount cap from the lens mount.  
Align the center slot in the lens mount with the center  
pin on the lens, and insert the lens into the mount.  
Holding the lens in place, push the lens locking lever  
down to mount the lens.  
Note  
If the lens is not firmly locked, it may come off while  
the camcorder is being used. This could cause a serious  
accident. Make sure the lens is firmly locked. It is  
recommended that the lens mount securing rubber be  
put on the lens-locking lever as illustrated above.  
4
5
Connect the lens cable to the LENS connector.  
Secure the lens cable with the cable clamps.  
152  
9-3 Mounting the Lens  
   
9-4 Adjusting the Flange 9-5 Audio Input System  
Focal Length  
9-5-1 Using the Supplied  
If the lens does not stay in focus properly as you zoom  
from telephoto to wide angle, adjust the flange focal length  
Microphone  
(the distance from the plane of the lens mounting flange to  
the imaging plane). Make this adjustment after mounting  
or changing the lens.  
You can use the supplied microphone either detached from  
or attached to the camcorder.  
Using the microphone detached from the  
camcorder  
Adjusting the flange focal length  
The position of the controls for adjusting the flange focal  
length vary somewhat from lens to lens. Check the  
identification of the various controls in the lens manual.  
Connect to the MIC IN connector.  
Set the AUDIO IN switch for the desired  
audio recording channel to FRONT.  
About 3 m (10 ft)  
Adjusting the flange focal length  
Using the microphone detached from the camcorder  
1
2
Set the iris to manual.  
Note  
Open the iris. Place the flange focal length adjustment  
chart about 3 m (10 ft) away from the camera, lit well  
enough to provide a satisfactory video output level.  
When using the supplied microphone with an extension  
cable, always use an external power supply type cable.  
Using the microphone attached to the  
camcorder  
3
Loosen the fixing screws on the F.f or F.B ring (flange  
focal length adjustment ring).  
1
Loosen the screw and open the microphone holder  
clamp.  
4
5
Use manual or power zoom to set the lens to telephoto.  
Point the camera at the chart by turning the focus ring  
and focus on it.  
6
7
Set the zoom ring to wide angle.  
Clamp of the  
Microphone holder  
Turn the F.f or F.B ring until the chart is in focus,  
being careful not to disturb the focus ring.  
8
9
Repeat steps 4 to 7 until the chart stays in focus all the  
way from wide angle to telephoto.  
Tighten the F.f or F.B ring fixing screws.  
9-4 Adjusting the Flange Focal Length / 9-5 Audio Input System  
153  
               
2
Place the microphone in the microphone holder.  
Place the microphone in  
the holder so that “UP” is at  
Tighten the screw.  
the top.  
+48V/OFF switch  
Monaural  
microphone  
Close the microphone holder.  
AUDIO IN CH1 or CH2  
connector  
AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 switches  
Using an external microphone (not attached to the camcorder)  
3
Plug the microphone cable into the MIC IN connector,  
then set the AUDIO IN switch for the desired  
recording channel to FRONT or F.  
XLR connection automatic detection function  
With the XLR connection automatic detection function  
being on, when a cable is connected to the AUDIO IN CH1  
or CH2 connector, the input from that connector is  
automatically selected for audio recording, regardless of  
the setting of the AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 switch.  
The XLR connection automatic detection function can be  
switched on or off on the AUDIO-1 page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu, with the REAR XLR AUTO  
item.  
Connect to the MIC IN connector.  
Note  
In order for the AUDIO IN CH1 and CH2 connectors on  
the camcorder to be able to provide a phantom 48 V power  
supply, female XLR connectors (3-pin) are fitted. If the  
microphone cable has a female connector, use an adaptor.  
4
Secure the microphone cable with the cable clamp.  
9-5-2 Using an External Microphone  
Using an external microphone attached to  
the camcorder  
You can attach an external microphone to the camcorder.  
You can connect up to two external monaural microphones  
using the AUDIO IN CH1 and CH2 connectors.  
1
Remove the fixing screws for external microphone  
holder.  
Switch settings when using an external  
microphone  
When using an external microphone, make the following  
switch settings.  
• Set the LINE / AES/EBU / MIC selector to MIC.  
• Make the following setting, depending on the type of  
microphone used.  
Using a microphone with an internal power supply:  
set the +48V/OFF switch to OFF.  
Using a microphone with an external power supply:  
set the +48V/OFF switch to +48V.  
• If the XLR connection automatic detection function (see  
next item) is off (the factory default setting), set the  
AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 switch for the channel to which  
the microphone is connected to “REAR”.  
2
Attach the CAC-12 Microphone Holder.  
154  
9-5 Audio Input System  
         
Note  
When you detach the CAC-12 Microphone Holder  
once you have attached to the camcorder, be careful  
not to lose the two screws fixing the CAC-12. After  
detaching the CAC-12, be sure to put the two screws  
back into their original places (see the figure  
illustrating the step 1 operation).  
Screws removed  
in step 1  
CAC-12  
9-5-3 Attaching a UHF Portable  
Tuner (for a UHF Wireless  
Microphone System)  
3
Open the CAC-12 and remove the microphone  
adaptor.  
To use a Sony UHF wireless microphone system, fit one of  
the following UHF portable tuners.  
Open the CAC-12.  
• WRR-855A/855B UHF Synthesized Tuner Unit  
• WRR-862 UHF Portable Tuner.  
For each of these UHF portable tuners, use the following  
attachment procedure.  
Microphone  
adaptor  
1)  
For details, refer to the UHF portable turner manual.  
Loosen the screw.  
Fitting the WRR-855A/855B  
You can use the WRR-855A/855B UHF Synthesized  
Tuner Unit simply by inserting it into the slot in the  
camcorder, and fastening the fixing screws.  
1) Attach the microphone adaptor when using a small-diameter external  
microphone.  
4
Place an electret condenser microphone in the CAC-  
12.  
1
Undo the four fixing screws holding the cover of the  
slot, and remove the cover.  
Close the CAC-12.  
ECM-672 or  
similar  
microphone  
Tighten the screw.  
m
2
Insert the WRR-855A/855B, and fasten the four fixing  
screws.  
5
Connect the microphone cable to the AUDIO IN CH1  
or AUDIO IN CH2 connector. Set the switches as  
described in the section “Switch settings when using  
an external microphone(see page 154).  
9-5 Audio Input System  
155  
     
For details about attaching the BP-GL65/GL95/L60S/  
WRR-855A/  
855B  
BP-GL65/GL95/L60S/  
M100  
Set the AUDIO IN switch (see page 154)  
to WIRELESS for the channel to be used.  
Adjustment screws  
Mount plate  
(supplied with WRR-862)  
For the operation of the WRR-855A/855B, refer to the  
manual supplied with the WRR-855A/855B.  
Back of  
camcorder  
Notes  
Phillips type screwdriver  
• When the XLR connection automatic detection function  
is on, even if the AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 switch is set  
to WIRELESS, the signal input to the AUDIO IN CH1  
or CH2 connector is automatically selected when an  
audio cable is connected to the AUDIO IN CH1 or CH2  
connector. In such a case, set REAR XLR AUTO to OFF  
on the AUDIO-1 page of the MAINTENANCE menu.  
• The audio signals to be recorded on audio channels 3 and  
4 depend on the settings of the AUDIO IN CH-3/CH-4  
switches without being affected by the XLR connection  
automatic detection function.  
2
Mount the tuner on the WRR tuner fitting.  
WRR-862  
Fitting the WRR-862 (Using a BP-GL65/  
GL95/L60S/M100 Battery Pack)  
1
(1) Attach the WRR tuner fitting (not supplied,  
service part number: A-8278-057-A) to the back  
of the camcorder.  
3
4
Connect the tuner power cord to the DC OUT  
connector of the camcorder, and the audio output cable  
to the AUDIO IN CH1 or CH2 connector.  
1 Use a Phillips type screwdriver to tighten the  
four screws placed in the tuner fitting. For  
three of these screws, insert the screwdriver  
through the corresponding hole and tighten the  
screw.  
Set the switches as follows.  
• Set the LINE / AES/EBU / MIC switch for the  
channel to which the audio out cable is attached to  
MIC.  
2 Loosen the adjustment screws.  
• When the XLR connection automatic detection  
function is off, set the AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2  
switch for the channel to which the audio output  
cable is connected to REAR.  
If the XLR connection automatic detection function  
is on, the input signal for audio recording is selected  
automatically, and therefore this setting is not  
required.  
3 Adjust the tuner fitting position for a BP-  
GL65/GL95/L60S/M100 Battery Pack to be  
attached, and tighten the adjustment screws to  
fix its position.  
4 Attach the mount plate supplied with the  
WRR-862.  
(2) Attach the battery pack.  
156  
9-5 Audio Input System  
LINE/AES/EBU/  
MIC switch  
LINE /AES/EBU /  
MIC switch  
Audio equipment  
to AUDIO IN  
CH1 or CH2  
AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2  
switches  
AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 switches  
to DC OUT connector  
to AUDIO IN CH1 or  
CH2 connector  
Line input connection  
9-5-4 Connecting Line Input Audio  
Equipment  
Connect the audio output connector of the audio  
equipment that supplies the line input signal to the AUDIO  
IN CH1 or CH2 connector.  
Switch settings  
Set the LINE / AES/EBU / MIC switch for the channel to  
which the audio signal source is connected to “LINE”.  
Selecting the audio inputs to be recorded  
• With the XLR connection automatic detection function  
being off (the factory default setting): A signal must be  
selected for audio recording by setting the AUDIO IN  
CH-1 or CH-2 switch to “REAR”, depending on which  
of the AUDIO IN CH1 and CH2 connectors is used for  
connecting the external audio equipment.  
• With the XLR connection detection function being on:  
When a cable is connected to the AUDIO IN CH1 or  
CH2 connector, the input from that connector is  
automatically selected for audio recording, regardless of  
the setting of the AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 switch.  
The XLR connection automatic detection function can be  
switched on or off on the AUDIO-1 page of the  
MAINTENANCE menu, with the REAR XLR AUTO  
item.  
9-5 Audio Input System  
157  
   
Note  
The tripod adaptor pin may remain in the engaged position  
even after the camcorder is removed. If this happens, press  
the red button against the lever a second time and move the  
lever as shown below until the pin returns to the stowed  
position. If the pin remains in the engaged position, you  
will not be able to mount the camcorder on the tripod  
adaptor.  
9-6 Tripod Mounting  
You can easily mount and dismount the camcorder on a  
tripod by using the VCT-14 tripod adaptor (not supplied).  
1
Attach the tripod adaptor to the tripod.  
Stowed position  
Tripod adaptor  
Camera mount  
Pin  
If the pin remains in the engaged position  
2
Mount the camcorder on the tripod adaptor.  
Slide the camcorder  
forward along the  
groove in the adaptor  
until it clicks.  
Removing the camcorder from the tripod  
adaptor  
Whilepressing  
the red button  
against the  
lever, move  
the lever in the  
direction  
indicated by  
the arrow.  
Red button  
Lever  
Removing the camcorder from the tripod adapter  
158  
9-6 Tripod Mounting  
   
9-7 Attaching the  
Shoulder Strap  
9-8 Adjusting the  
Shoulder Pad  
Position  
Attach the supplied shoulder strap as shown below.  
You can shift the shoulder pad from its center position  
(factory setting) backward by up to 10 mm (3/8 inch) or  
forward by up to 25 mm (1 inch). This adjustment helps  
you get the best balance for shooting with the camcorder  
on your shoulder.  
Shoulder strap post  
1,3  
Bottom  
Shoulder pad  
2
Attaching the shoulder strap  
Adjusting the shoulder pad position  
Attaching  
1
2
3
Raise the lever in the center of the shoulder pad to  
unlock the shoulder pad.  
Pull up the strap to lock  
the fitting.  
Clip  
Slide the shoulder pad backward or forward until it is  
in the most convenient position.  
Bring down the lever to lock the shoulder pad in the  
selected position.  
Attaching the shoulder strap  
Removing  
Press here and pull in the direction  
shown by the arrow to release.  
Removing the shoulder strap  
9-7 Attaching the Shoulder Strap / 9-8 Adjusting the Shoulder Pad Position  
159  
           
Insert the viewfinder barrel here with the eyecup out  
and fasten the drawstring around the eyecup.  
9-9 Putting on the Rain  
Cover (Not Supplied)  
Attach the rain cover (part number 3-191-064-02) as  
illustrated below. You can insert and remove cassette  
tapes, operate various switches and controls, and mount  
the camcorder on the tripod adaptor with the rain cover  
attached.  
Drawstring  
Whenashoulder  
belt is not used,  
cover the holes  
on the rain cover  
with caps.  
When you use a  
shoulder strap,  
use these holes.  
For details, see  
the following  
Velcro tape  
diagram.  
Velcro tape  
Rear  
Front  
Velcro tape  
Drawstring  
Pass the shoulder strap post clearly through this hole  
on the rain cover.  
160  
9-9 Putting on the Rain Cover (Not Supplied)  
   
To disable the camcorder REC START button and  
the lens VTR button  
On the FUNCTION 3 page of the MAINTENANCE  
menu, set REC START/STOP to “RM”.  
If the same function as that of the REC START button is  
assigned to the ASSIGN 1/3/4 switch or the TURBO  
GAIN button, this setting also disables these controls.  
9-10 Connecting the  
Remote Control Unit  
Connecting the RM-B150/B750 Remote Control Unit  
enables remote control of the principal camera functions.  
Connecting the remote control unit to the REMOTE  
connector (8-pin) automatically puts the camcorder into  
remote control mode. If you disconnect the remote control  
unit, the remote control mode is cancelled.  
To enable the camcorder REC START button and  
the lens VTR button  
On the FUNCTION 3 page of the MAINTENANCE  
menu, set REC START/STOP to “CAM”.  
If the same function as that of the REC START button is  
assigned to the ASSIGN 1/3/4 switch or the TURBO  
GAIN button, this setting also enables these controls.  
RM-B150/B750  
To enable all of the camcorder REC START  
button, the lens VTR button, and the remote  
control unit VTR button  
On the FUNCTION 3 page of the MAINTENANCE  
menu, set REC START/STOP to “PARA”.  
If the same function as that of the REC START button is  
assigned to the ASSIGN 1/3/4 switch or the TURBO  
GAIN button, this setting also enables these controls.  
REMOTE  
connector  
Remote control cable  
When the monitor is connected to the  
MONITOR OUT connector of the remote  
control unit  
The MONITOR connector (BNC type) of the RM-B150/  
B750 outputs the same signal as that from the TEST OUT  
connector on the camcorder.  
Use the black cable supplied with the RM-B150/B750 to  
connect the monitor to the MONITOR connector on the  
RM-B150/B750.  
Camcorder switch functions when the  
remote control unit is connected  
The following switches on the camcorder do not function.  
• GAIN selector  
• OUTPUT/DCC switch  
• WHITE BAL switch  
• AUTO W/B BAL switch  
• SHUTTER selector  
• TURBO GAIN button (ASSIGN 1 switch to which the  
TURBO GAIN function is assigned)  
• REC START button (VTR button on the lens and the  
ASSIGN 1/3/4 or the TURBO GAIN switch to which the  
REC START/STOP function is assigned) (When the  
REC START/STOP item on the FUNCTION 3 page of  
the MAINTENANCE menu is set to RM.)  
For details of the function of the REC START button, see  
When the remote control unit is  
disconnected from the camcorder  
The camcorder settings return to the settings in effect  
before the remote control unit was connected.  
By making a menu setting, the setting of the paint  
adjustment made with the remote control unit can be  
retained even after the remote control unit is removed from  
the camcorder.  
on the next page.  
Paint adjustment when the remote control  
unit is connected  
The settings of the paint adjustment that were in effect the  
last time the remote control unit was used are recalled.  
Function of the REC START button when  
the remote control unit is connected  
You can select the function of the REC START button on  
the camcorder when the remote control unit is connected,  
using the REC START/STOP item on the FUNCTION 3  
page of the MAINTENANCE menu.  
9-10 Connecting the Remote Control Unit  
161  
       
Structure of the paint adjustment data  
can use settings of the paint adjustment data stored in the  
independent data region even if you connect the remote  
control unit. In this case, the settings stored in the  
independent data region will be renewed when you change  
the settings on the remote control unit. Thus, the settings  
of the paint data made with the remote control unit can be  
retained even if the remote control unit is removed.  
However, if the switch position on the remote control unit  
differs from the one on the camcorder, the switch position  
on the camcorder takes precedence over that on the remote  
control unit.  
Non-volatile memory  
Independent data  
region  
MASTER BLACK  
MASTER GAMMA  
KNEE POINT  
Setup  
DETAIL LEVEL  
menu of  
Also, it is possible to keep the settings that are in effect  
before you connect the remote control unit. In this case,  
you should set the control knob to the relative value mode  
on the remote control unit.  
R/B GAIN  
the  
cam-  
corder  
R/B BLACK  
Hardware  
of the  
camera  
RM-  
B150  
Remote control data  
region  
MASTER BLACK  
MASTER GAMMA  
KNEE POINT  
DETAIL LEVEL  
R/B GAIN  
For details, refer to the operation manual supplied with  
the remote control unit.  
RM-B150  
connected  
or not  
R/B BLACK  
connected  
As the illustration above shows, the non-volatile memory  
of the camcorder consists of two regions: one is the  
independent data region that becomes effective when the  
remote control unit is not connected, and the other is the  
remote control data region that becomes effective when the  
remote control unit is connected. Paint adjustment data is  
automatically selected depending on whether or not the  
remote control unit is connected to the camcorder.  
Thus, when the remote control unit is connected to the  
camcorder, the effective data region is switched to the  
remote control data region and the settings of the paint  
adjustment that were in effect the last time the remote  
control unit was used are recalled.  
1)  
Settings of the absolute value control knobs and absolute  
2)  
value switches are overwritten by those on the remote  
control unit after the remote control unit is connected.  
1) Absolute value control knob  
The data corresponding to the rotation degree (position) of the control  
knobs is output. The data corresponding to the rotation amount is called  
the relative value control knob.  
2) Absolute value switch  
Like the toggle switches or slide switches (except the momentary  
switches), the switches (or controls) whose positions must coincide with  
their functions are called absolute value switches.  
When the remote control unit is removed from the  
camcorder, the independent data region becomes effective.  
Thus the camcorder will return to the settings that were in  
effect before the remote control unit was connected.  
When RM COMMON MEMORY is set to ON on the  
FUNCTION 3 page of the MAINTENANCE menu, you  
162  
9-10 Connecting the Remote Control Unit  
 
Maintenance  
10  
Chapter  
4
After confirming that the disc is not write-protected,  
load the disc and close the disc compartment lid.  
10-1 Testing the  
Camcorder Before  
Condensation  
If you move the camcorder from a very cold place to a  
warm place, or use it in a damp location, condensation may  
form on the optical pickup. Then, if the camcorder is  
operated in this state, recording and playback may not be  
performed properly.  
Do the following to prevent this from happening.  
• When you move or operate the camcorder in an  
environment where condensation may form, be sure to  
load a disc in advance and close the disc compartment  
lid.  
Shooting  
Check the functions of the camcorder before setting out for  
a shooting session, preferably by operating the camcorder  
together with a color video monitor.  
10-1-1Preparations for Testing  
• Whenever you turn on the power, check that the HUMID  
indicator does not appear on the color LCD. If it  
appears, wait until it disappears before loading a disc.  
3
4
1
10-1-2Testing the Camera  
2
Set the switches and selectors as follows.  
1
2
Attach a fully charged battery pack.  
Iris: Automatic  
Set the POWER switch to ON and check that the  
HUMID indicator does not appear and that the BATT  
indicator shows at least five segments.  
• If the HUMID indicator appears, wait until it  
disappears.  
• If the BATT indicator does not show at least five  
segments, replace the battery pack with a fully  
charged one.  
Zoom: SERVO/MAN  
WHITE BAL: A or B  
VDR SAVE/STBY: SAVE  
GAIN: Set as low as possible.  
OUTPUT/DCC: BARS  
3
Check that there are no obstructions near the disc  
compartment, and then press the EJECT button to  
open the disc compartment lid.  
10-1 Testing the Camcorder Before Shooting  
163  
                   
8
9
Set both of the AUDIO IN switches to FRONT, and  
check that when sound is input to a microphone  
connected to the MIC IN connector on the front of the  
camcorder, the audio level indicators appear on the  
viewfinder screen.  
Testing the viewfinder  
Proceed as follows.  
1
2
Adjust the position of the viewfinder.  
Check that the color bars are displayed on the  
viewfinder screen, and adjust the BRIGHT,  
CONTRAST, and PEAKING controls to give the best  
color bar display.  
Check that setting the ZEBRA switch to ON and OFF  
makes the zebra pattern appear and disappear on the  
viewfinder screen.  
Note  
3
Check each of the following operations.  
The results of checking in steps 3 to 9 may not be as  
expected, depending on the settings relating to the  
viewfinder display function. In this case, set the desired  
items on the VF DISP 1 and VF DISP 2 pages of the USER  
menu.  
• The menu is displayed on the viewfinder screen.  
• Turn the MENU knob and check that the menu page  
changes to the next page.  
• Press the MENU knob and check that settings of  
each item of the selected page are displayed.  
• Turn the MENU knob and check that the b mark  
moves within the page.  
• Press the MENU knob and check that the b mark  
placed before the item changes to a z mark and the  
zmark placed before the setting of the item changes  
to a ? mark.  
• Turn the MENU knob and check that the setting of  
the selected item changes.  
Testing the iris and zoom functions  
1
2
3
Set the zoom to automatic zoom mode and check that  
the power zoom operates correctly.  
Set the zoom to manual zoom mode and check the  
zoom functions manually.  
4
5
Set the OUTPUT/DCC switch to CAM, and change  
the FILTER selector position in the sequence of 1, 2, 3  
and 4.  
Check that the FILTER indicator on the viewfinder  
screen displays the correct numbers.  
Set the iris switch on the lens to AUTO and point the  
camera at objects of different brightness. Check that  
the automatic iris adjustment operates correctly.  
Carry out of the following operations, and check that  
that the ! indicator lights if the corresponding item has  
been turned on on the '!' LED page of the USER menu.  
4
5
Set the iris switch on the lens to MANUAL and check  
that turning the iris ring manually adjusts the iris  
correctly.  
• Set the gain to anything but 0 dB by using the GAIN  
selector and the GAIN SW page of the  
OPERATION menu.  
• Set the SHUTTER selector to ON.  
• Set the WHITE BAL switch to PRST.  
• Use the lens extender.  
• Set the FILTER selector to other than the position  
“1” (PDW-510/510P) or other than the position  
“1B” (PDW-530/530P).  
Set the iris switch on the lens back to AUTO and check  
the following points when the GAIN selector is moved  
from L to M to H.  
• For objects of the same brightness, the iris is  
adjusted to correspond to the change in setting.  
• The gain indicator on the viewfinder screen changes  
to correspond to the change in setting.  
• Set the reference value of the auto iris to other than  
the standard value.  
6
If an extender mechanism is incorporated in your lens,  
put the extender lever of the lens into the 2x position  
and check the following points.  
6
7
Move the SHUTTER selector from ON to SELECT  
repeatedly, and check that the shutter setting changes  
on the viewfinder screen.  
• The indication “EX” appears at the top left on the  
viewfinder screen.  
• The auto iris functions correctly.  
Pointing the camera at a suitable subject, focus the  
camera and check the picture on the viewfinder screen.  
10-1-3Testing the VDR  
Perform tests (1) to (7) consecutively.  
164  
10-1 Testing the Camcorder Before Shooting  
   
2
Set the AUDIO SELECT CH-1/CH-2 switches to  
AUTO.  
(1) Testing the recording and playback  
functions  
3
4
Set the AUDIO IN CH-3/CH-4 switches to F (front).  
1
2
3
Set the VDR SAVE/STBY switch to SAVE and check  
that the SAVE indicator in the viewfinder goes on.  
Aim the microphone connected to the MIC IN  
connector at a suitable sound source. Check that the  
level indications for channels 1 to 4 correspond to the  
sound level, respectively.  
Set the VDR SAVE/STBY switch to STBY and check  
that the SAVE indicator in the viewfinder goes off.  
Set the switches located below the color LCD as  
follows.  
(3) Testing the manual audio level  
adjusting functions  
LCD switch: L or H  
DISP SEL switch: STATUS  
DISPLAY switch: COUNTER  
1
2
Set the AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 switches to FRONT.  
Turn the MIC LEVEL control. Check that the channel-  
1 and -2 audio level meters on the color and  
monochrome LCDs show more and more segments as  
you turn the control counterclockwise as seen from the  
front of the camcorder.  
4
5
Set the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK switch to PRESET,  
and set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN to R-RUN.  
Press the REC START button and check the following  
points.  
• The indication in the counter display is changing.  
• The REC indicator in the viewfinder is on.  
• The RF and SERVO indicators on the color LCD are  
off.  
(4) Testing the earphone and speaker  
1
2
Turn the MONITOR volume control and check that  
the speaker volume changes accordingly.  
6
7
Press the REC START button again and check that  
recording stops and that the REC indicator in the  
viewfinder goes off.  
Connect an earphone to the front or rear EARPHONE  
jack. Check that the speaker sound is cut off and that  
you can hear the sound from the microphone in the  
earphone.  
Repeat the checks of steps 5 and 6, this time using the  
VTR button on the lens.  
3
4
Turn the MONITOR volume control and check that  
the earphone volume changes accordingly.  
Press the RESET button and check that the indication  
in the counter display on each of the color and  
monochrome LCDs is “00:00:00:00”.  
Connect the earphone to the other EARPHONE jack.  
Check the earphone as in step 3.  
8
9
Press the F REV button and check that fast reverse  
playback is performed. Next, press the PLAY button  
and check that normal playback is performed.  
(5) Testing external microphones  
You can do this test by using both of the AUDIO IN CH1  
and CH2 connectors simultaneously. Alternatively, you  
can do the test by using one of the connectors, and then  
execute the same procedure using the other connector.  
The following is the testing procedure when both  
connectors are used.  
Press the STOP button and check that playback stops.  
Next, press the F FWD button and check that fast  
forward playback is performed.  
10Press the STOP button again, then press the PREV  
button. Check that the image of the beginning of the  
current or previous clip is displayed.  
1
2
Connect external microphones to the AUDIO IN CH1/  
CH2 connectors.  
11Press the NEXT button, and check that the image of  
Set the +48V/OFF switches as follows.  
the beginning of the next clip is displayed.  
• If the connected microphone is of the internal power  
supply type, set the switch to OFF.  
• If the connected microphone is of the external power  
supply type, set the switch to +48V.  
(2) Testing the automatic audio level  
adjusting functions  
1
Set the AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 switches to FRONT.  
3
Set the AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 switches to REAR.  
10-1 Testing the Camcorder Before Shooting  
165  
4
5
Aim the microphones at a sound source.  
6
7
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to F-RUN, and  
check that the time code indication starts changing  
again and continues to change even when you restart  
recording and stop recording again.  
Check that the audio level meters on the color and  
monochrome LCDs and the audio level indicators in  
the viewfinder reflect the changing sound level.  
Set the DISPLAY switch to U-BIT, and check that the  
user bit data that was set is displayed.  
(6) Checking the XLR connection  
automatic detection function  
Before starting to check, remove the front microphone  
connected to the MIC IN connector if it is connected.  
1
Perform the operations of steps 1 and 2 explained in  
(5) “Testing external microphones”.  
2
3
Set the AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 switches to FRONT.  
Perform the operations of steps 4 and 5 explained in  
(5) “Testing external microphones”.  
If the audio level meters on the color and monochrome  
LCDs and the audio level indicators in the viewfinder  
reflect the changing sound level, the function of the  
XLR connection automatic detection is working  
correctly.  
If it does not reflect the changing sound level, the  
function of the XLR connection automatic detection  
function is off. Set REAR XLR AUTO to “ON” on the  
VDR MODE 1 page of the MAINTENANCE menu.  
If it does not reflect even after making this setting, the  
XLR connection automatic detection function does not  
work correctly.  
(7) Checking the user bit and time code  
functions  
1
Set the user bits as required.  
2
Set the time code.  
3
4
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to R-RUN.  
Press the REC START button, and check that  
recording starts and that the time code indication in the  
counter display changes.  
5
Press the REC START button again, and check that  
recording stops and that the time code indication stops  
changing.  
166  
10-1 Testing the Camcorder Before Shooting  
Be sure to correctly assemble the fog-proof filter, the  
packing ring, and the eyecup so that the reassembled  
eyepiece is waterproof.  
10-2 Maintenance  
Note  
10-2-1Cleaning the Viewfinder  
When cleaning the fog-proof filter, wipe it very gently  
with a soft cloth to avoid damaging the anti-fogging  
coating.  
Use a dust blower to clean the CRT screen and mirror  
inside the viewfinder barrel.  
Clean the lens and protecting filter with a commercially  
available lens cleaner.  
Caution  
Never use organic solvents such as thinners.  
Disassembling the eyepiece for cleaning  
Eyecup  
holder  
Eyecup  
Viewfinder  
barrel  
Protecting  
filter  
Packing  
ring  
1
Detach the eyepiece from the viewfinder barrel.  
For the detaching procedure, see 9-2-6 “Detaching  
2
3
Remove the eyecup from the eyecup holder.  
Remove the protecting filter, together with the packing  
ring, from inside the eyecup holder.  
4
Detach the protecting filter from the packing ring.  
Fog-proof filter  
Depending on the temperature and humidity, the  
protecting filter may mist because of vapor or your breath.  
To ensure that the viewfinder is always clear, replace the  
protecting filter with a fog-proof filter (Part No. 1-547-  
341-11, not supplied).  
Fitting the fog-proof filter  
Replace the protecting filter on the packing ring with the  
fog-proof filter.  
10-2 Maintenance  
167  
       
10-3 Operation Warnings  
When a problem occurs at power on or during operation, a  
warning is given by the relevant indicators on the color and  
monochrome LCDs, in the viewfinder and on the  
camcorder body. The speaker and earphone also give  
audible warnings.  
Operation warnings  
Alarm  
Indicators on color/ Indicators in viewfinder/  
Warning  
sounds  
Problem VDR  
operation  
Action to take  
Message monochrome LCDs on camcorder body  
Warning/ Flashing/  
:
:Continuous  
:4 flashes/s  
:1 flash/s  
Battery  
status  
indication  
continuous  
4 beeps/s  
:
WARNING REC/tally BATT  
1 beep/s  
:
Continuou  
s beep  
**-  
** 1)  
Recording Recording  
error stops.  
Turn off the power  
and consult your  
Sony representative.  
E
2)  
2)  
2)  
2)  
2)  
2)  
MEM Full  
ILL.REC!  
Shockproo Recording  
f memory continuous but shocks and vibration.  
Protect the unit from  
overflow  
may be  
substandard.  
Input sync Recording  
Turn off the power  
error  
continuous but and contact your  
may be  
Sony service  
substandard.  
representative. (This  
indication may be  
given momentarily  
when a GENLOCK  
signal is connected or  
disconnected, but this  
does not indicate a  
problem.)  
2)  
2)  
2)  
2)  
Disc Error!  
HUMID!  
Before  
A disc  
defect was continues,  
detected.  
Recording  
If defects are  
detected repeatedly,  
exchange the disc.  
avoiding the  
defect, but  
may be  
substandard.  
2)  
2)  
3)  
Continuous  
Condensa- Recording/  
tion on the playback  
optical  
pickup.  
Stop recording/  
playback, turn off the  
continues but power, then turn it on  
stops when an again, and wait until  
error occurs  
on the drive.  
the HUMID indicator  
disappears.  
4)  
2)  
2)  
2)  
6)  
7)  
DISC  
Disc  
Operation  
Be prepared to  
change the disc.  
Flashing  
8)  
almost full. continues.  
Full  
5)  
6)  
6)  
DISC  
FULL!  
DISC and  
E
Disc full.  
Recording  
stops.  
Change the disc.  
Flashing  
6)  
4)  
7)  
LOW  
BATT  
Battery  
almost  
exhausted.  
Operation  
continues.  
Change the battery.  
Flashing  
8)  
5)  
BATT!  
5)  
BATT  
EMPTY!  
BATT and  
E
Battery  
exhausted. stops.  
Operation  
Change the battery.  
Flashing  
High  
TEMP!  
Internal  
temperatur continues.  
e high.  
Operation  
Power the unit off and  
move it to a cool  
place.  
168  
10-3 Operation Warnings  
     
Alarm  
Indicators on color/ Indicators in viewfinder/  
Warning  
sounds  
Problem VDR  
operation  
Action to take  
Message monochrome LCDs on camcorder body  
Warning/ Flashing/  
:
:Continuous  
:4 flashes/s  
:1 flash/s  
Battery  
status  
indication  
continuous  
4 beeps/s  
:
WARNING REC/tally BATT  
1 beep/s  
:
Continuou  
s beep  
ACC  
Sensor!  
Internal  
drive  
sensor  
error  
Operation  
continues.  
Protect the unit from  
shock and vibrations,  
turn off the power,  
and contact a Sony  
service  
Skew!  
Sensor  
representative.  
1) Asterisks (*) are replaced by digits in the display.  
2) During recording  
3) During playback, fast forward, fast reverse, or stop  
4) 1 flash/second  
5) 4 flashes/second  
6) During recording pause  
7) During recording or pause.  
8) Color LCD only  
Operation/error messages  
An operation or error message is displayed in the  
operation/error message display area (see page 112) in the  
viewfinder.  
Message  
Meaning and action to take  
No Support!  
A recorded clip cannot be handled by this  
unit. Exchange or format the disc.  
FORMAT NG! The disc cannot be used by this unit.  
Exchange the disc.  
Operation/error  
message  
Meaning  
Disc Damage  
The disc cannot be recorded. To record,  
exchange the disc.  
AUTO INTERVAL  
**M**S  
Indicates the camera is in the Auto  
Interval Rec mode. **M**S indicates  
the shooting interval.  
Non AV Full  
MAX # Files  
The disc is full. Exchange or format the  
disc.  
MANU INTERVAL Indicates the camera is in the single  
*FRAME  
shot mode of the Manual Interval Rec  
mode. *FRAME indicates the number  
of frames.  
DI read err  
Read err  
DRV ADJ err  
The disc was not recognized. Try ejecting  
the disc and inserting it again. Or  
exchange the disc.  
INTERVAL **S(M/ Indicates the camera is in the  
Run Salvage  
Salvage NG  
REC INHI.!  
Salvage processing needs to be done on  
the disc. To record on the disc, eject the  
disc, insert it again, and execute salvage  
processing.  
H)*FRAME  
consecutive mode of the Manual  
Interval Rec mode. **S(M/H) indicates  
the trigger interval and *FRAME  
indicates the number of frames.  
Salvage processing failed. For details, see  
3-1-6 “Handling of Discs When Recording  
LOW LIGHT  
Appears, depending on the setting, to  
indicate the subject illumination is  
inadequate.  
ON-BOARD  
Appears when the backup battery for  
The write-protect tab of the disc is in the  
recording disabled position, or salvage  
processing needs to be done on the  
loaded disc. Set the tab to the recording  
enabled position. Or eject the disc, insert it  
again, and perform salvage processing.  
1)  
BATTERY EMPTY  
the internal clock has been used up.  
HIGH  
TEMPERATURE  
Indicates that temperatures have risen  
inside the unit. Avoid continued use in  
this state.  
1) To replace the backup battery, contact your nearest Sony dealer.  
1)  
The loaded disc has a different recording  
format. Exchange the disc, or change the  
recording format.  
IMX** Clip  
DVCAM Clip  
4CH/24 Clip  
8CH/16 Clip  
A message for DVR operation is displayed in the setting  
change and adjustment progress message display area in  
the viewfinder (see page 115).  
2)  
Disc operations are not possible when the  
DC IN connector is not connected and the  
CA-755 is being used.  
KEY INHI.!  
Message  
Meaning and action to take  
ILL. Disc!  
The disc cannot be used by this unit. Insert  
another Professional Disc.  
ILL. PLAY  
An A/V phase error occurred during  
playback. Stop the disc.  
ILL. Index!  
No FS!  
Unknown FS!  
Index file or file system error. Exchange or  
format the disc.  
Lid Closed!  
The lid of the disc compartment does not  
open. Check the lid.  
10-3 Operation Warnings  
169  
 
Aliasing  
Message  
Meaning and action to take  
When patterns of stripes or lines are shot, they may appear  
jagged.  
Lid Open!  
The lid of the disc compartment is not  
closed. Close it securely.  
No Clip!  
No Disc!  
There are no clips recorded on the disc.  
Exchange for a recorded disc.  
There is no disc loaded. Insert a disc and  
try the operation again.  
STOP ONCE! The operation is not possible while the disc  
REC mode!  
is being played or recorded. Stop the disc.  
Disc Top!  
Disc End!  
The operation is not possible because the  
disc is at the top or end.  
Formatting!  
The disc is being automatically formatted.  
Wait until the format ends.  
Recording  
The unit is writing to the file system. Wait  
until writing finishes.  
No EM Space Essence marks cannot be inserted. For  
EM Full!  
SB CLP mode Try the operation again after pressing the  
SUB CLIP button to turn off the sub clip  
indicator.  
No SEL List  
No clip list is selected. Create a new clip  
list, or load a clip list from the disc.  
No List!  
There is no clip list. Create a clip list.  
No SUB Clip  
There are no sub clips in the clip list.  
Register a sub clip, or load another clip list.  
SUB Clip NG  
The In and Out point positions are invalid.  
Set correct In and Out points.  
MAX# SB CLP The total number of sub clips is over the  
upper limit (300).  
CL OVER DUR The total duration of sub clips in the current  
clip list is over the upper limit (24 hours).  
FAN Stopped! The main unit or drive fan has stopped.  
DR-FAN Stop  
Avoid use under high temperatures, turn  
off the power, and contact a Sony service  
representative.  
1) “**” indicates the bit rate (50/40/30).  
2) REC INHI.! appears if you attempt to start recording.  
Notes on CCD image sensors  
Vertical smear  
Smear tends to be produced when an extremely bright  
object is being shot; it is more likely to occur with a faster  
electronic shutter speed.  
Vertical tails show on the  
image.  
Bright object (mercury lamp,  
the sun, reflections, etc.)  
Monitor screen  
Vertical smear  
170  
10-3 Operation Warnings  
Appendixes  
Dimensions in mm (inches)  
Specifications  
General  
Power voltage  
12 V DC +5.0/–1.0 V  
Power consumption  
Approx. 36 W (with 12 V DC supply, when  
recording with the color LCD off)  
Operating temperature  
–5°C to +40°C (32°F to 104°F)  
Operating humidity  
10% to 90% (relative humidity)  
Storage temperature  
–20°C to +60°C (–4°F to +140°F)  
Recording format  
Video: MPEG IMX (50/40/30 Mbps), DVCAM (25  
332 (13 1/8)  
Supplied accessories  
Shoulder strap (1)  
Monaural microphone (super cardioid directional,  
external power supply type) (1)  
Operation manuals  
Mbps)  
Proxy video: MPEG-4  
Audio:  
English version (1)  
Japanese version (1)  
CD-ROM manual (1)  
1)  
MPEG IMX: 16 bits or 24 bits, 48 kHz,  
4 channels  
PDZ-1 Proxy Browsing Software (1)  
DVCAM: 16 bits/48 kHz  
Proxy audio: A-law (8/4 channels, 8 bits, 8 kHz)  
Video Camera Section  
1) The MPEG-4 CODEC is a product of Ingenient Technologies, Inc.  
General  
Imager  
2
/ -inch type 16:9 widescreen Power HAD EX  
3
Continuous operating time  
CCD  
Approx. 120 min. (with BP-GL95)  
Mass Approx. 4.1 kg (9 lb) (main body only)  
Approx. 5.7 kg (12 lb 9 oz) (with microphone,  
viewfinder, disc and BP-GL95 Battery  
Pack)  
Total picture elements  
1038 (H) × 1008 (V) for PDW-510/530  
1038 (H) × 1188 (V) for PDW-510P/530P  
Effective picture elements  
980 (H) × 988 (V) for PDW-510/530  
980 (H) × 1164(V) for PDW-510P/530P  
Imager Configuration  
RGB 3 CCDs  
Spectral system  
F1.4 prism system (with quartz filter)  
Specifications  
171  
           
Built-in filters  
PDW-510/510P  
Optical Disc Drive Section  
CC + ND filter  
1: 3200K  
General  
Usable disc  
Data transfer rate  
Recording/playback time  
MPEG IMX 50Mbps: 45 minutes  
1
2: 5600K + / ND  
3: 5600K  
4: 5600K + / ND  
8
PFD23 Professional Disc  
1
Max. 72Mbps (per optical head)  
64  
PDW-530/530P  
CC filter  
A: Cross filter  
40Mbps: 55 minutes  
30Mbps: 68 minutes  
B: 3200K  
C: 4300K  
D: 6300K  
DVCAM: 85 minutes  
ND filter  
1: Clear  
Digital video  
Sampling frequency  
1
2: / ND  
4
Y: 13.5 MHz  
R–Y/B–Y: 6.75 MHz  
1
3: / ND  
16  
1
4: / ND  
64  
Quantization  
10 bits/sample (8 bits/sample for  
compression processing)  
2
Lens mount  
Sensitivity  
/ -inch 48 bayonet mount  
3
Compression MPEG-2 4:2:2P@ML 50/40/30 Mbps or  
DVCAM  
F11 standard (89.9% reflection chart, 2000 lx)  
Minimum illumination  
0.13 1x (at F1.4, +48 dB gain)  
Video S/N ratio  
65 dB (Y typical) (for PDW-510/530)  
63 dB (Y typical) (for PDW-510P/530P)  
Modulation (at screen center)  
Audio (with standard playback machine)  
Frequency response 20 Hz to 20 kHz –1.0 dB  
Dynamic range  
Distortion (THD)  
Cross talk  
85 dB min.  
0.08% max.  
–70 dB max.  
Below measurable limit  
4:3 mode: 55%  
16:9 mode: 70%  
Wow and flutter  
Registration  
Input/output connectors  
0.05% or less for entire screen area (excluding  
distortion due to lens)  
Geometric distortion  
Signal inputs  
AUDIO IN CH1/CH2  
None identified (excluding distortion due to  
XLR type, 3-pin, female  
–60 dBu/+4 dBu  
(0 dBu = 0.775 Vrms.)  
lens)  
Smear  
LCD panel  
6.3 cm (2.5 inches)  
–140 dB (Y-typical)  
MIC IN  
GENLOCK IN  
XLR type, 3-pin, female –60 dBu  
BNC type  
Pixel resolution: 211,200 pixels (960 wide ×  
220 high)  
1.0 Vp-p, 75 , unbalanced  
BNC type  
Effective picture elements: more than 99.99%  
TC IN  
0.5 V to 18 Vp-p, 10 k Ω  
Viewfinder  
Signal outputs  
TEST OUT  
CRT  
Horizontal resolution  
4:3 mode: 600 TV lines (at screen center)  
16:9 mode: 450 TV lines (at screen center)  
2-inch monochrome, quick start type  
BNC type  
1.0 Vp-p, 75 , unbalanced  
VIDEO OUT  
BNC type, 75 , unbalanced  
VBS OUT: 1.0 Vp-p  
SDI OUT: 0.8 Vp-p (only when the CBK-SD01 is  
installed)  
AUDIO OUT  
TC OUT  
EARPHONE (minijack)  
XLR type, 5-pin, male, 0 dBm  
BNC type, 1.0 Vp-p, 75 Ω  
8 , –to –18 dBs variable  
Others  
DC IN  
XLR type, 4-pin, male, 11 to 17 V DC  
172  
Specifications  
   
DC OUT  
4-pin, 11 to 17 V DC, maximum rated  
Audio equipment  
ECM-672 Microphone  
CAC-12 Microphone Holder  
CCXA-53 Audio Cable (for converting 5-pin connector to  
two 3-pin connectors)  
current 0.2 A  
12-pin  
8-pin  
2-pin  
6-pin  
LENS  
REMOTE  
LIGHT  
i.LINK  
WRR-855A/855B UHF Synthesized Tuner Unit  
WRR-862 UHF Portable Tuner  
WRT-8T UHF Transmitter  
Recommended Additional  
Equipment  
WRR Tuner Fitting (service part number: A-8278-057-A)  
STEREO MIC IN connector (MA-126A board)  
(service part number: A-1053-453-A)  
DMX-P01 Portable Digital Mixer  
Power supply and related equipment  
BP- GL65/GL95/L60S Battery Pack  
BP-M100 Battery Pack  
BC-M50/M150 Battery Charger  
AC-550/550CE AC Adaptor  
AC-DN10 AC Adaptor  
For Audio equipment described above, confirm whether  
the connector is male or female and the number of pins on  
the connector.  
The audio input connectors of the camcorder are female  
and 3-pin and the audio output connectors are male and 5-  
pin. A converting adaptor may be required depending on  
the audio equipment to be connected to the camcorder.  
CA-701/702/702P Camera Adaptor  
Viewfinder and related equipment  
BKW-401 Viewfinder Rotation Bracket  
Fog-proof filter (Part No. 1-547-341-11)  
Lens assembly (farsighted) (Part No. A-8262-537-A)  
Lens assembly (low magnification) (Part No. A-8262-538-  
A)  
Lens assembly (standard magnification with special  
compensation for aberrations) (Part  
No. A-8267-737-A)  
Extension boards  
CBK-SD01 SDI Output Board  
CBK-SC01 Composite Input Board  
CBK-FC01 Pull Down Board (for the PDW-510/530 only)  
CBK-NC01 Network Adaptor  
Equipment for maintenance and easier  
handling  
LC-777 Hard Carrying Case  
LC-DS300SFT Soft Carrying Case  
Tripod Adaptor VCT-14  
Rain cover  
Optical attachments  
1
ND filter ( / ND) (Part No. 3-174-685-01)  
8
1
ND filter ( / ND) (Part No. 3-174-683-01)  
32  
Consult your Sony representative for more information  
about these filters.  
Maintenance Manual  
Design and specifications are subject to change without  
notice.  
Equipment for remote control  
RM-B150/B750 Remote Control Unit  
“Memory Stick”  
MSH-32 (32 MB)  
MSH-64 (64 MB)  
MSH-128 (128 MB)  
Specifications  
173  
     
Menu List  
This section briefly explains menus that the camcorder  
provides for adjustments and settings using tables.  
This manual also explains some adjustments and settings  
to be made using the OPERATION menu, PAINT menu,  
MAINTENANCE menu, FILE menu and DIAGNOSIS  
menu.  
For the menu organization and the USER menu, see  
Chapter 6.  
For details of these menus, refer to the Maintenance  
Manual.  
OPERATION Menu List  
The following table lists and describes the items in the  
OPERATION menu. Some pages of the OPERATION  
menu have been registered in the USER menu at the  
factory. These pages are indicated by a circle (a) in the  
USER menu column. The USER MENU CUSTOMIZE  
menu allows you to add and delete pages in the USER  
menu to suit your requirements.  
When the setting range in the Settings column is  
surrounded by parentheses ( ), the setup value is a relative  
value. The setting range shown on the menu screen may  
differ from what is shown in the manual.  
USER  
menu  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
a
01  
OUTPUT  
LCD BRIGHT <L>  
LCD BRIGHT <H>  
LCD COLOR  
(–32 to +31)  
(–32 to +31)  
(–32 to +31)  
ENABL/DSABL  
VBS/SDI  
0
0
0
PC REMOTE  
DSABL  
VBS  
REAR BNC OUT SEL  
(when option board is  
connected)  
174  
Menu List  
         
USER  
menu  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
a
02  
TEST OUT  
TEST OUT MARKER  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
Selects whether or not the  
marker signal is mixed to the  
output signal from the TEST  
OUT connector.  
TEST OUT VFDISP  
TEST OUT MENU  
TEST OUT DISP SEL  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
VF/LCD  
OFF  
OFF  
VF  
Selects whether or not the VF  
DISP display signal is mixed  
to the output signal from the  
TEST OUT connector.  
Selects whether or not the  
MENU display signal is mixed  
to the output signal from the  
TEST OUT connector.  
Selects VF (viewfinder) or  
LCD for the text information  
mixed to the output signal  
from the TEST OUT  
connector. (to be supported  
shortly)  
TEST OUT ZEBRA  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
Selects whether or not the  
ZEBRA display signal is  
mixed to the output signal  
from the TEST OUT  
connector.  
TEST OUT TC  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
ENC  
Selects whether or not a time  
code signal is mixed to the  
output signal from the TEST  
OUT connector.  
TEST OUT SELECT  
ENC/R/G/B  
Selects the output signal of  
TEST OUT.  
Menu List  
175  
 
USER  
menu  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
a
03  
FUNCTION 1 ASSIGN SW <1>  
OFF/CACHE/  
ATW  
See 7-3-5 “Assigning  
CHARA/MARKR/  
RTAKE/ATW/RET.V/  
RET/REC/TURBO/  
D5600/ZEBRA/  
FREZE/M.FRZ etc.  
ASSIGN SW <2>  
OFF/CACHE/  
OFF  
CHARA/MARKR/  
V.SRC/ZEBRA/  
FREZE/5600 etc.  
ASSIGN SW <3>  
ASSIGN SW <4>  
OFF/CACHE/  
OFF  
OFF  
CHARA/MARKR/  
RTAKE/ATW/RET.V/  
RET/REC/TURBO/  
ZEBRA/ZOOMW/  
ZOOMT/FREZE/  
M.FRZ etc.  
TURBO SW  
OFF/CACHE/  
TURBO  
CHARA/MARKR/  
RTAKE/ATW/RET.V/  
RET/REC/TURBO/  
D5600/ZEBRA/  
FREZE/M.FRZ etc.  
DF/NDF  
(PDW-510/530 only)  
DF/NDF  
DF  
Switches between drop frame  
(DF) mode and non-drop  
frame (NDF) mode.  
CACHE/INTVAL REC  
OFF/CACHE/A.INT/ OFF  
M.INT  
See 3-2-4 “Starting a Shoot  
Stored Picture Data (Picture  
(CACHE)  
CACHE REC TIME  
0-2/2-4/4-6/6-8/8-10/ 0-2s  
10-12s  
(A.INT)  
TAKE TOTAL TIME  
5/10/15/20/30/40/50 5MIN  
MIN,  
1/2/3/4/5/7/10/15/20/  
30/40/50/70/100 H  
See 3-2-5 “Time-Lapse Video  
(A.INT)  
REC TIME  
5/10/15/20/30/40/50 5SEC  
SEC,  
1 to 85 MIN  
(A.INT or M.INT except  
TRIGGER MODE:M)  
PRE-LIGHTING  
OFF/2SEC/5SEC/  
10SEC  
OFF  
1
(M.INT)  
1/2/4/8  
NUMBER OF FRAME  
(M.INT)  
TRIGGER INTERVAL  
M, 1 to 10/15/20/30/ 1SEC  
40/50 SEC,  
1 to 10/15/20/30/40/  
50 MIN,  
1/2/3/4/6/12/24H  
176  
Menu List  
 
USER  
menu  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
04  
FUNCTION 2 D5600  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
Turns on and off the function  
which electrically applies a  
5600K color temperature  
filter.  
WIDE AWB  
OFF/ON  
ON  
Turns on and off the function  
which widens the range  
adjustable by Auto White  
Balance.  
WHITE SWTCH <B>  
SHOCKLESS WHITE  
MEM/ATW  
OFF/1/2/3  
MEM  
1
Sets the function of the  
WHITE BAL B switch.  
Changes the white gain  
smoothly when operating the  
WHITE BAL switch.  
ATW SPEED  
1/2/3/4/5  
4
Sets the convergence speed  
for Auto Tracing White  
balance.  
ZOOM SPEED  
LOW LIGHT  
0 to 99  
20  
Sets the zoom speed when a  
serial lens is connected  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
Turns the warning display on  
or off when the video average  
level is less than the preset  
value.  
LOW LIGHT LEVEL  
VF BATT WARNING  
–99 to +99  
10/20%  
16  
Sets the level at which the  
LOW LIGHT function  
becomes effective.  
10%  
Sets the threshold value of  
remaining battery capacity to  
make the remaining capacity  
indication flash.  
05  
06  
POWER  
SAVE  
i.LINK OUT  
ENABL/DSABL  
EE/SAVE  
STBY/SAVE  
OFF/ON  
1/2/3  
DSABL  
EE  
REC AUDIO OUT  
NETWORK/THUMB  
VF DISP  
STBY  
OFF  
3
a
VF DISP 1  
VF DISPLAY MODE  
DISP EXTENDER  
DISP FILTER  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
INT/VOLT/AUTO  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
ON  
ON  
DISP WHITE  
ON  
DISP GAIN  
ON  
DISP SHUTTER  
DISP AUDIO  
ON  
ON  
DISP DISC  
ON  
DISP IRIS  
ON  
a
07  
VF DISP 2  
DISP ZOOM  
ON  
DISP COLOR TEMP  
DISP BATT REMAIN  
DISP DC IN  
OFF  
INT  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
DISP 16:9/4:3 ID  
DISP WRR RF LVL  
DISP TIME CODE  
DISP REC FORMAT  
Menu List  
177  
     
USER  
menu  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
a
08  
'!'LED  
GAIN  
<!>  
<!>  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
80/90/92.5/95%  
OFF/ON  
16:9/13:9/4:3  
OFF/ON  
1/2, 1/4, 1/8  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
1 to 465  
ON  
SHUTTER  
ON  
WHT PRESET<!>  
ATW RUN <!>  
EXTENDER <!>  
FILTER <!>  
ON  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OVERRIDE <!>  
MARKER  
a
09  
MARKER 1  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
90%  
OFF  
4:3  
CENTER  
SAFETY ZONE  
SAFETY AREA  
ASPECT  
ASPECT SELECT  
ASPECT MASK  
ASPECT MASK LVL  
100% MARKER  
USER BOX  
OFF  
1/4  
OFF  
OFF  
245  
10  
MARKER 2  
Turns the box cursor on or off.  
USER BOX WIDTH  
Width (from the center to right  
or left side)  
USER BOX HEIGHT  
1 to 120  
72  
Height (from the center to top  
or bottom)  
USER BOX H POS.  
USER BOX V POS.  
CENTER H POS.  
–461 to +461  
–118 to +118  
–48 to +47  
0
0
0
H position of the center  
V position of the center  
H position of the center  
marker  
CENTER V POS.  
–15 to +14  
0
V position of the center  
marker  
a
a
11  
12  
GAIN SW  
GAIN LOW  
–3/0/3/6/9/12/18/24/  
30/36/42/48  
0
See 7-3-1 “Setting Gain  
GAIN MID  
9
GAIN HIGH  
GAIN TURBO  
TURBO SW IND.  
18  
42  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
1/2/BOTH  
20 to 107  
1 to 20  
OFF  
OFF  
1
VF SETTING ZEBRA  
ZEBRA SELECT  
ZEBRA1 DET.LEVEL  
ZEBRA1 APT.LEVEL  
ZEBRA2 DET.LEVEL  
VF DETAIL LEVEL  
VF ASPECT  
70  
10  
52 to 109  
–99 to +99  
AUTO/16:9  
100  
0
AUTO  
178  
Menu List  
         
USER  
menu  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
a
13  
AUTO IRIS  
IRIS OVERRIDE  
IRIS SPEED  
CLIP HIGH LIGHT  
IRIS WINDOW  
IRIS WINDOW IND.  
IRIS VAR WIDTH  
IRIS VAR HEIGHT  
IRIS VAR H POS.  
IRIS VAR V POS.  
ID-1  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
0
See 5-4 “Changing the  
Automatic Iris Adjustment” on  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
1
1/2/3/4/5/6/VAR  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
245  
85/72  
0
20 to 465  
20 to 120  
–447 to +446  
–104 to +104  
12 characters  
0
a
a
14  
15  
SHOT ID  
ID-2  
ID-3  
ID-4  
SHOT DISP  
SHOT DATE  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
See 7-2-6 “Recording Shot  
SHOT TIME  
SHOT MODEL NAME  
SHOT SERIAL NO  
SHOT ID SEL  
OFF/ID-1/ID-2/ID-3/ OFF  
ID-4  
SHOT 16:9 ID  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
SHOT BLINK CHARA  
a
16  
17  
SET STATUS STATUS ABNORMAL  
STATUS FUNTION  
See 7-2-8 “Displaying the  
ON  
STATUS AUDIO  
ON  
OFFSET  
WHT  
OFFSET WHITE <A>  
WARM COOL <A>  
OFF  
3200  
See 7-3-4 “Specifying an  
Balance Setting” on page  
124.  
Display color  
temperature  
COLOR FINE <A>  
OFFSET WHITE <B>  
WARM COOL <B>  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
0
OFF  
3200  
Display color  
temperature  
COLOR FINE <B>  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
1 to 16  
0
18  
SHT ENABLE SHUTTER SLS  
SHUTTER ECS  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
1
See 5-3 “Setting the  
81.  
SHUTTER 1/60  
The items which can be set  
differ depending on the CCD  
scan mode setting (see page  
130).  
SHUTTER 1/100  
SHUTTER 1/125  
SHUTTER 1/250  
SHUTTER 1/500  
SHUTTER 1/1000  
SHUTTER 1/2000  
a
19  
LENS FILE  
LENS FILE SELECT  
F.ID  
(Display only)  
Menu List  
179  
             
USER  
menu  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
20  
FORMAT  
16:9/4:3 SELECT  
SCAN MODE  
16:9/4:3  
16:9  
I
I/PsF/24P  
(24P only when  
option board  
installed)  
UC/J SELECT  
UC/J  
UC  
Selects the signal format.  
(PDW-510/530 only)  
21  
SOURCE  
SEL  
REC VIDEO SOURCE  
EXT REC CONTROL  
PC REMOTE  
CAM/EXT  
CAM  
See 3-4 “Recording Video  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
ENABL/DSABL  
MONO/STREO  
DSABL  
STREO  
FRONT MIC SELECT  
(when stereo microphone  
is connected)  
EXT VIDEO SOURCE  
(when option board is  
connected)  
i.LINK/CMPST  
SYNC/VIDEO  
0.0/7.5  
i.LINK  
SYNC  
EXT OUTPUT DELAY  
(when option board is  
connected)  
SETUP REMOVE  
(PDW-510/530 only)  
7.5  
00  
22  
UMID SET  
COUNTRY CODE  
ORGANIZATION  
USER CODE  
4-byte alphanumeric  
strings  
4-byte alphanumeric  
strings  
4-byte alphanumeric  
strings  
TIME ZONE : 00  
00 to xx  
180  
Menu List  
   
PAINT Menu List  
The following table lists and describes the items in the  
PAINT menu.  
value. The setting range shown on the menu screen may  
differ from what is shown in the manual.  
When the setting range in the Settings column is  
surrounded by parentheses ( ), the setup value is a relative  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
Default Description  
01  
SW STATUS  
GAMMA  
CHROMA  
ON  
ON  
Turns the gamma correction on or off.  
Turns the chroma of the composite signal on  
or off.  
MATRIX  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
ON/OFF  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
Turns the linear matrix correction on or off.  
Turns the knee correction on or off.  
Turns the white clipping correction on or off.  
Turns the detail signal on or off.  
KNEE  
WHITE CLIP  
DETAIL  
APERTURE  
FLARE  
Turns the aperture function on or off.  
Turns the flare function on or off.  
Turns the EVS shutter on or off.  
EVS  
TEST SAW  
COLOR TEMP <A>  
OFF/REC/SAW OFF  
Selects the test signal.  
02  
WHITE  
Display color  
temperature  
3200  
Sets the color temperature of WHITE A.  
COLOR FINE <A>  
(–99 to +99)  
0
Adjusts the value more precisely when the  
color temperature adjustment through  
COLOR TEMP is not satisfactory.  
R GAIN <A>  
B GAIN <A>  
D5600 <A>  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
0
Only the value of R GAIN is changed.  
Only the value of B GAIN is changed.  
0
OFF  
Turns the WHITE A electronic 5600K filter on  
or off.  
COLOR TEMP <B>  
COLOR FINE <B>  
Display color  
temperature  
3200  
0
Sets the color temperature of WHITE B.  
(–99 to +99)  
Adjusts the value more precisely when the  
color temperature adjustment through  
COLOR TEMP is not satisfactory.  
R GAIN <B>  
B GAIN <B>  
D5600 <B>  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
0
Only the value of R GAIN is changed.  
Only the value of B GAIN is changed.  
0
OFF  
Turns the WHITE B electronic 5600K filter on  
or off.  
03  
BLACK/FLARE MASTER BLACK  
R BLACK  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
0
Adjusts the master black level.  
Adjusts the R black level.  
0
B BLACK  
0
Adjusts the B black level.  
MASTER FLARE  
R FLARE  
0
Adjusts the flare level of the master.  
Adjusts the R flare level.  
0
G FLARE  
0
Adjusts the G flare level.  
B FLARE  
0
Adjusts the B flare level.  
FLARE  
ON  
ENC  
Turns the flare correction circuit on or off.  
TEST OUT SELECT  
ENC/R/G/B  
Selects the output signal of TEST OUT  
connector.  
Menu List  
181  
         
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default Description  
04  
GAMMA  
GAMMA  
OFF/ON  
ON  
Turns the gamma correction function on or  
off.  
STEP GAMMA  
0.35 to 0.90  
0.45  
Sets the master gamma correction curve in  
steps.  
MASTER GAMMA  
R GAMMA  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
ENC/R/G/B  
0
Sets the master gamma correction curve.  
Sets the R gamma correction curve.  
Sets the G gamma correction curve.  
Sets the B gamma correction curve.  
0
G GAMMA  
0
B GAMMA  
0
TEST OUT SELECT  
ENC  
Selects the output signal of TEST OUT  
connector.  
GAMMA SELECT  
GAMMA SEL (STD)  
GAMMA SEL (FILM)  
BLACK GAMMA  
STD/FILM  
1 to 6  
STD  
3
Selects the gamma table.  
Selects the gamma table of STD.  
Selects the gamma table of FILM.  
Turns the black gamma correction on or off.  
Sets the range affected by black gamma.  
1 to 5  
1
05  
BLK GAMMA  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
HIGH  
BLK GAMMA RANGE LOW/L.MID/  
H.MID/HIGH  
MASTER BLK  
GAMMA  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
ENC/R/G/B  
0
Adjusts the master black gamma.  
R BLACK GAMMA  
G BLACK GAMMA  
B BLACK GAMMA  
TEST OUT SELECT  
0
Sets the correction curve of the R black  
gamma.  
0
Sets the correction curve of the G black  
gamma.  
0
Sets the correction curve of the B black  
gamma.  
ENC  
Selects the output signal of TEST OUT  
connector.  
06  
KNEE  
KNEE  
OFF/ON  
ON  
85.0  
0
Turns the knee correction circuit on or off.  
Sets the knee point level.  
KNEE POINT  
KNEE SLOPE  
KNEE SATURATION  
KNEE SAT LEVEL  
WHITE CLIP  
WHITE CLIP LEVEL  
DETAIL  
50 to 109%  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
Set the knee slope level.  
ON  
0
Turns the knee saturation function on or off.  
Sets the knee saturation level.  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
ON  
Turns the white clipping function on or off.  
Adjusts the white clipping level.  
100.0 to 109.5% 109.0  
07  
DETAIL 1  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
ON  
ON  
Sets the detail correction function on or off.  
APERTURE  
Turns the aperture correction function on or  
off.  
DETAIL LEVEL  
APERTURE LVL  
DTL H/V RATIO  
CRISPENING  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
0
Sets the general level of the detail signal.  
Sets the aperture level.  
0
0
Sets the level of the V detail signal.  
Sets the crispening level.  
0
LEVEL DEPEND  
LV. DEPEND LVL  
DETAIL FREQ.  
ON  
0
Turns the level depend function on or off.  
Sets the level of the level depend.  
Sets the frequency of the H detail signal.  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
0
182  
Menu List  
       
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
OFF/ON  
Default Description  
08  
DETAIL 2  
KNEE APERTURE  
KNEE APT LVL  
DETAIL COMB  
OFF  
Turns the knee aperture function on or off.  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to 0)  
0
0
Sets the knee aperture level.  
Sets the level at which the comb filter  
becomes effective.  
CROSS COLOR  
CROSS COLOR LVL  
DETAIL LIMIT  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
0
Turns the cross color component on or off.  
Sets the suppression level of the cross color.  
Sets the both detail black and white limiters.  
Sets the detail white limiter.  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
DTL WHT LIMIT  
DTL BLK LIMIT  
DTL V-BLK LMT  
FINE DTL  
0
0
Sets the detail black limiter.  
0
Sets the V detail black limiter.  
09  
10  
DETAIL 3  
OFF  
0
Turns the fine detail function on or off.  
FINE DTL LVL  
(–99 to +99)  
Sets the level at which the fine detail function  
becomes effective.  
V DTL CREATION  
NAM/G/R+G/Y  
R+G  
V
Selects the source signal of the V DTL signal.  
H/V CONTROL MODE H/V / V  
Select the operation mode of DETAIL H/V  
RATIO on the DETAIL 1 page. (H/V: H and V  
both enabled, V: V DTL only enabled)  
SKIN DETAIL  
SKIN DETAIL  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
Turns on all of 1, 2 and 3 of the color detail  
function.  
SKIN DETECT  
SKIN AREA IND.  
Moves to color  
detection page.  
EXEC  
OFF  
Executes the color detail function.  
OFF/ON  
Turns the zebra indication on or off in the area  
of the currently selected type of the color  
detail function.  
SKIN DTL SELECT  
SKIN DETAIL  
1/2/3  
1
Selects the type of the color detail function.  
The following items depend on the selected  
type of the color detail function.  
OFF/ON  
ON  
Turns the color detail function on or off for the  
type selected in the above item.  
SKIN DETAIL LVL  
SKIN DTL SAT.  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
Sets the level of the color detail signal.  
Adjusts the saturation level of the hue  
possessed by the color detail function.  
SKIN DTL HUE  
(0 to 359)  
(0 to 359)  
Adjusts the center phase of the hue  
possessed by the color detail function.  
SKIN DTL WIDTH  
Adjusts the width of the hue possessed by the  
color detail function.  
Menu List  
183  
     
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default Description  
11  
MTX LINEAR  
MATRIX  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
0
Turns the linear matrix correction and user-  
set matrix correction functions on or off.  
MATRIX (USER)  
OFF/ON  
Turns the user-set matrix correction function  
on or off.  
MATRIX (PRESET)  
OFF/ON  
Turns the preset matrix correction function on  
or off.  
MATRIX (USER)  
R-G  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
Sets the arbitrary G-R user-set matrix  
coefficients.  
MATRIX (USER)  
R-B  
0
Sets the arbitrary B-R user-set matrix  
coefficients.  
MATRIX (USER)  
G-R  
0
Sets the arbitrary R-G user-set matrix  
coefficients.  
MATRIX (USER)  
G-B  
0
Sets the arbitrary B-G user-set matrix  
coefficients.  
MATRIX (USER)  
B-R  
0
Sets the arbitrary R-B user-set matrix  
coefficients.  
MATRIX (USER)  
B-G  
0
Sets the arbitrary G-B user-set matrix  
coefficients.  
12  
MTX MULTI  
MATRIX  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
Turns the linear matrix correction and multi  
matrix correction functions on or off.  
MATRIX (MULTI)  
MATRIX AREA IND.  
OFF/ON  
Turns the multi matrix correction function on  
or off.  
OFF/ON  
Turns the zebra indication on or off in the area  
corresponding to the currently selected  
setting.  
MATRIX COLOR DET Moves to color  
detection page.  
EXEC  
B
Detects color.  
MTX (MULTI) AXIS  
B/B+/MG–/MG/  
MG+/R/R+/YL–/  
YL/YL+/G–/G/  
G+/CY/CY+/B–  
Sets the region in which the multi matrix  
correction function can be changed. (sixteen-  
axis mode)  
MTX (MULTI) HUE  
MTX (MULTI) SAT  
(–99 to +99)  
0
0
Adjusts the color phase affected by the multi  
matrix correction function in every sixteen-  
axis mode.  
(–99 to +99)  
Adjusts the saturation level affected by the  
multi matrix correction function in every  
sixteen-axis mode.  
13  
V
V MOD  
OFF/ON  
ON  
0
Turns the V modulation function on or off.  
MODULATION  
MASTER VMOD EX  
(–99 to +99)  
Turns the master V modulation function on or  
off.  
R VMOD  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
ENC/R/G/B  
0
Turns the R V modulation function on or off.  
Turns the G V modulation function on or off.  
Turns the B V modulation function on or off.  
Selects the output signal of TEST OUT.  
G VMOD  
0
B VMOD  
0
TEST OUT SELECT  
ENC  
184  
Menu List  
     
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default Description  
14  
LOW KEY SAT. LOW KEY SAT.  
L.KEY SAT. LEVEL  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
0
Turns the low key saturation function on or off.  
(–99 to +99)  
Sets the saturation level of the low luminance  
part.  
L.KEY SAT. RANGE  
LOW/L.MID/  
H.MID/HIGH  
HIGH  
Sets the luminance level at which the low key  
saturation function becomes effective.  
Y BLACK GAMMA  
Y BLK GAM LEVEL  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
0
Turns the Y black gamma function on or off.  
(–99 to +99)  
Sets the gamma curve in the low luminance  
part.  
Y BLK GAM RANGE  
LOW/L.MID/  
H.MID/HIGH  
HIGH  
Sets the luminance level at which the Y black  
gamma becomes effective.  
15  
SCENE FILE  
1
Recalls the scene file saved in the memory of  
the camcorder.  
2
3
4
5
STANDARD  
Clears all current detail-adjusted settings and  
switch settings and returns the settings to the  
standard settings saved in the reference file.  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
F.ID  
Recalls the scene file from the memory of the  
camcorder or the “Memory Stick”.  
Stores the scene file in the memory of the  
camcorder or the “Memory Stick”.  
16 characters  
Sets the File ID.  
Menu List  
185  
   
MAINTENANCE Menu List  
The following table lists and describes the items in the  
MAINTENANCE menu.  
When the setting range in the Settings column is  
surrounded by parentheses ( ), the setup value is a relative  
value. The setting range shown on the menu screen may  
differ from what is shown in the manual.  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
01  
WHT SHADING SHADING CH SEL R/G/B/TEST  
R
Selects the channel adjusted by this menu. If  
TEST is selected, the setting is the same as  
the setting of TEST OUT SELECT.  
TEST OUT SELECT ENC/R/G/B  
ENC  
Selects the signal output to the TEST OUT  
connector.  
R/G/B WHT H SAW (–99 to +99)  
R/G/B WHT H PARA (–99 to +99)  
R/G/B WHT V SAW (–99 to +99)  
R/G/B WHT V PARA (–99 to +99)  
WHITE SAW/PARA OFF/ON  
0
0
0
0
0
H Saw white shading compensation  
H Parabola white shading compensation  
V Saw white shading compensation  
V Parabola white shading compensation  
Turns white shading Saw and Parabola  
compensation on and off.  
02  
BLK SHADING SHADING CH SEL R/G/B/TEST  
TEST OUT SELECT ENC/R/G/B  
R
Selects the channel adjusted by this menu. If  
TEST is selected, the setting is the same as  
the setting of TEST OUT SELECT.  
ENC  
Selects the signal output to the TEST OUT  
connector.  
R/G/B BLK H SAW (–99 to +99)  
R/G/B BLK H PARA (–99 to +99)  
R/G/B BLK V SAW (–99 to +99)  
R/G/B BLK V PARA (–99 to +99)  
BLACK SAW/PARA OFF/ON  
0
H Saw black shading compensation  
H Parabola black shading compensation  
V Saw black shading compensation  
V Parabola black shading compensation  
0
0
0
ON  
Turns black shading Saw and Parabola  
compensation on and off.  
MASTER BLACK  
(–99 to +99)  
0
Master black level adjustment  
MASTER  
GAIN(TMP)  
–3/0/3/6/9/12/18/  
24/30/36/42/48 dB  
0 db  
Temporarily adjusts the master gain value.  
03  
LEVEL ADJ  
ENC VIDEO LEVEL (–99 to +99)  
RGB LEVEL (–99 to +99)  
TEST OUT SELECT ENC/R/G/B  
0
Encoder video level adjustment  
R/G/B video level adjustment  
0
ENC  
Selects the signal output to the TEST OUT  
connector.  
H BLANKING  
WIDTH  
(–99 to +99)  
0
H blanking width adjustment  
186  
Menu List  
       
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
04  
BATTERY  
BEFORE END 1  
5/10 to 95/100%  
5%  
Used when a BP-GL65/GL95/M100 Battery  
Pack is used. Sets the voltage warning level  
just before the battery ends.  
END 1  
0/1/2/3/4/5%  
0%  
Used when a BP-GL65/GL95/M100 Battery  
Pack is used. Sets the voltage level at which  
the battery ends and the camcorder stops  
operation, just before the battery ends.  
BEFORE END 2  
END 2  
11.5 to 17.0V  
(in 0.1V steps)  
11.5  
11.0  
Used when a BP-L60S Battery Pack is used.  
Sets the voltage warning level just before the  
battery ends.  
11.0 to 11.5 V  
(in 0.1V steps)  
Used when a BP-L60S Battery Pack is used.  
Sets the voltage level at which the battery  
ends and the camcorder stops operation, just  
before the battery ends.  
BEFORE END 3  
END3  
11.5 to 17.0V  
(in 0.1V steps)  
11.8  
11.0  
Used when a battery pack other than a BP-  
GL65/GL95/L60S/M100 or an external power  
connected to the DC IN connector is used.  
Sets the voltage warning level just before the  
battery ends.  
11.0 to 11.5 V  
(in 0.1V steps)  
Used when a battery pack other than a BP-  
GL65/GL95/L60S/M100 or an external power  
connected to the DC IN connector is used.  
Sets the voltage level at which the battery  
ends and the camcorder stops operation, just  
before the battery ends.  
05  
AUDIO-1  
CA-701 AUDIO IN  
ENABL/DSABL  
ENABL  
SW  
When a CA-701 camera adaptor is  
connected, selects whether or not to enable  
input of audio channels 3 and 4 from the  
camera adaptor.  
ENABL: Camera adaptor can be used.  
DSABL: Camera adaptor cannot be used.  
AUDIO CH3/4  
MODE  
CH1/2/SW  
OFF/ON  
Selects the sources to be recorded to  
channels CH-3/4.  
CH1/2: Same sources as CH-1/2.  
SW: Signals selected by the AUDIO IN CH-3/  
CH-4 switches.  
REAR XLR AUTO  
FRONT MIC REF  
REAR MIC REF  
MIN ALARM VOL  
OFF  
Turns the XLR connection automatic  
detection on or off .  
–60 dB/–50 dB/  
–40 dB  
–60 dB  
–60 dB  
OFF  
Sets the reference level of the front  
microphone.  
–60 dB/–50 dB/  
–40 dB  
Sets the reference level when the AUDIO IN  
CH1 connector is set to MIC.  
OFF/SET  
Volume of the monitor speaker alarm tone  
when it is turned all the way down.  
OFF: Almost inaudible.  
SET: Faintly audible.  
SP ATT LEVEL  
OFF/3/6/9 dB  
OFF  
Lowers the volume of the monitor speaker.  
Has no effect on earphone volume.  
HEADPHONE OUT STREO/MONO  
MONO  
Selects whether to make the rear earphone  
monaural or stereo.  
Menu List  
187  
   
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
06  
AUDIO-2  
AU DATA LEN (IMX) 16 bit//24 bit  
(PDW-530/530P  
only)  
16bit  
Sets the bit length of the digital audio  
recording.  
AU REF LEVEL  
–20 dB/–18 dB/  
–16 dB/–12 dB/  
EBUL  
–20 dB  
Sets the reference level (Head Room).  
Sets the output reference level.  
AU REF OUT  
0 dB/+4 dB/–3 dB/ 0 dB  
EBUL  
AU CH12 AGC  
MODE  
MONO/STREO  
MONO  
Selects whether to perform automatic input  
level adjustment of analog audio signals to be  
recorded on channels 1 and 2 independently  
for each channel, or in stereo mode.  
AU CH34 AGC  
MODE  
OFF/MONO/  
STREO  
MONO  
Selects whether to perform automatic input  
level adjustment of analog audio signals to be  
recorded on channels 3 and 4 independently  
for each channel, or in stereo mode, or not at  
all (OFF).  
AU AGC SPEC  
–6/–9/–12/–15 dB  
–6 dB  
AGC saturation level setting  
AU LIMITER MODE OFF/–6/–9/–12/–15 OFF  
dB  
For manual audio input level adjustment,  
selects the limiter saturation level for loud  
input signals.  
AU OUT LIMITER  
OFF/ON  
ON  
Turns the audio output limiter on or off.  
i.LINK AUDIO OUT 2CH/4CH  
2CH  
2CH: Output channels 1 and 2 (16 bits, 48  
ksps)  
4CH: Output channels 1 to 4 (12 bits, 32  
ksps)  
188  
Menu List  
 
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
07  
AUDIO-3  
AU SG (1kHz)  
ON/OFF/AUTO  
OFF  
Sets whether to output a 1 kHz test tone  
during the Color Bar mode or not.  
ON: a 1 kHz test tone is output during the  
Color Bar mode.  
OFF: a 1 kHz test tone is not output during  
the Color Bar mode.  
AUTO: a 1 kHz test tone is output only when  
the CH 1 AUDIO SELECT switch on the  
inside panel is in the AUTO position.  
MIC CH1 LEVEL  
SIDE1/FRONT/  
F+S1  
FRONT  
FRONT  
SIDE 1  
When recording the front microphone sound  
on CH 1, selects which control is to be used  
for the level adjustment.  
SIDE 1: Adjust it with the LEVEL control (left  
side) on the side panel.  
FRONT: Adjust it with the MIC LEVEL control  
on the front panel.  
F + S1: It can be adjusted using either the  
LEVEL control (left side) or the MIC  
LEVEL control. (The two controls are  
linked to each other.)  
MIC CH2 LEVEL  
SIDE2/FRONT/  
F+S2  
When recording the front microphone sound  
on CH 2, selects which control is to be used  
for the level adjustment.  
SIDE 2: Adjust it with the LEVEL control (right  
side) on the side panel.  
FRONT: Adjust it with the MIC LEVEL control  
on the front panel.  
F + S2: It can be adjusted using either the  
LEVEL control (right side) or the MIC  
LEVEL control. (The two controls are  
linked to each other.)  
REAR1/WRR  
LEVEL  
SIDE1/FRONT/  
F+S1  
Selects any of these controls to adjust the  
audio level of the equipment that is connected  
to the wireless microphone and whatever is  
connected to the AUDIO IN CH1 connector  
on the rear panel.  
SIDE 1: Adjust it with the LEVEL control (left  
side) on the side panel.  
FRONT: Adjust it with the MIC LEVEL control  
on the front panel.  
F + S1: It can be adjusted using either the  
LEVEL control (left side) or the MIC  
LEVEL control. (The two controls are  
linked to each other.)  
REAR2/WRR  
LEVEL  
SIDE2/FRONT/  
F+S2  
SIDE 2  
Selects any of these controls to adjust the  
audio level of the equipment that is connected  
to the wireless microphone and whatever is  
connected to the AUDIO IN CH2 connector  
on the rear panel.  
SIDE 2: Adjust it with the LEVEL control (right  
side) on the side panel.  
FRONT: Adjust it with the MIC LEVEL control  
on the front panel.  
F + S2: It can be adjusted using either the  
LEVEL control (right side) or the MIC  
LEVEL control. (The two controls are  
linked to each other.)  
Menu List  
189  
 
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
08  
TIMECODE  
TC OUT  
AUTO/GENE  
AUTO  
Selects the time code signal output.  
AUTO: Outputs the time code generator  
output during recording and outputs the  
time code reader output during playback.  
GENE: Outputs the time code generator  
output during recording and playback.  
DF/NDF  
(PDW-510/530 only)  
DF/NDF  
INT/EXT  
DF  
Sets DF or NDF mode.  
DF: Drop frame mode  
NDF: Non-drop frame mode  
EXT-LK DF/NDF  
(PDW-510/530 only)  
INT  
Selects either internal setting or external  
setting for DF/NDF.  
INT: Internal  
EXT: External  
EXT-LK UBIT  
INT/EXT  
INT  
Sets whether the LTC UBIT setup value locks  
to an INT or an EXT source when the time  
code is locked to an external source.  
INT: Internal lock  
EXT: External lock  
LTC UBIT  
FIX/TIME  
FIX/TIME  
FIX  
FIX  
ON  
Sets the data to be recorded in UBIT of LTC.  
FIX: Records the data that is set by the user.  
TIME: Records the present time.  
VITC UBIT  
Sets the data to be recorded in UBIT of VITC.  
FIX: Records the data that is set by the user.  
TIME: Records the present time.  
WATCH AUTO ADJ OFF/ON  
Matches the time of the built-in clock with the  
time data of the user bits of an external time  
code. Turns the automatic time correction  
function of the built-in clock on or off .  
UBIT GROUP ID  
VITC INS LINE 1  
000/101  
000  
Selects the UBIT GROUP ID.  
12 to 19 H (PDW-  
510/530)  
16H  
Selects the line into which VITC is to be  
inserted.  
9 to 22 H (PDW-  
510P/530P)  
19h  
18h  
21H  
ON  
VITC INS LINE 2  
12 to 19 H (PDW-  
510/530)  
Selects the line into which VITC is to be  
inserted.  
9 to 22 H (PDW-  
510P/530P)  
09  
VDR MODE  
REC TALLY BLINK OFF/ON  
Turns the tally illumination control on or off in  
the event of BATTERY BEFORE END/DISC  
BEFORE END.  
REC START BEEP OFF/ON  
OFF  
Turns on or off the alarm sound at REC  
START/STOP.  
SUB LCD MODE  
SEL  
TIMER/OFF/CONT TIMER  
Sets the time code (TC) display after power-  
off as follows.  
TIMER: The TC display turns off after the  
elapse of the time set by the SUB LCD  
TIMER below.  
OFF: Not displayed.  
CONT: Displayed.  
SUB LCD TIMER  
1H/3H/8H  
1H  
Sets the duration of time after which the TC  
display is to be turned off after power-off,  
when the SUB LCD MODE SEL item, above,  
is set to TIMER (H: hours).  
REC FORMAT  
(PDW-530/530P  
only)  
IMX50/IMX40/  
IMX30/DVCAM  
IMX50  
Selects the type of video codec. Multiple  
codecs cannot be mixed on one disc.  
190  
Menu List  
   
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
Default  
OFF  
Description  
10  
ESSENCE  
MARK  
SHOT MARK 1  
SHOT MARK 2  
OFF  
OVER AUDIO  
MARK  
OFF  
GAIN CHG. MARK OFF/ON  
OFF  
OFF  
FILTER CHG.  
MARK  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
SHUTTER CHG.  
MARK  
OFF  
OFF  
WHITE CHG.  
MARK  
FLASH MARK  
OFF/ON  
1 to 20  
OFF  
10  
FLASH MARK  
LEVEL  
INDEX PIC. POS.  
0/1/2/3/4/5/6/7/8/9/  
10 SEC  
0
11  
PRESET WHT  
COLOR TEMP. <P> Display color  
temperature.  
3200  
White balance preset value  
COLOR FINE <P> (–99 to +99)  
0
R GAIN  
G GAIN  
D5600  
<P> (–99 to +99)  
<P> (–99 to +99)  
<P> OFF/ON  
0
R gain preset value  
G gain preset value  
0
OFF  
Selects whether to electrically apply 5600K  
filter to white balance preset value.  
AWB ENABLE <P> OFF/ON  
OFF  
DCC  
Turns on and off the function which  
automatically acquires the preset value for  
automatic white balance adjustment.  
12  
DCC ADJUST  
DCC FUNCTION  
SEL  
DCC/Adaptive  
KNEE/FIX  
Selects the function assigned to the DCC  
switch.  
ADP.K is Adaptive Knee and FIX is fixed  
value.  
DCC D RANGE  
400/450/500/550/  
600%  
600%  
Sets the timing range when the DCC switch is  
set to the ON position.  
DCC POINT  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
0
0
0
DCC minimum knee point adjustment  
Gain adjustment to DCC detected value  
DCC reaction speed adjustment  
DCC GAIN  
DCC DELAY TIME  
Menu List  
191  
     
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
13  
AUTO IRIS 2  
IRIS WINDOW  
1/2/3/4/5/6/VAR  
1
Selects the auto iris detection window. VAR is  
variable.  
IRIS WINDOW IND OFF/ON  
OFF  
Turns on and off the function which displays a  
frame marker for the auto iris detection  
window.  
IRIS LEVEL  
(–99 to +99)  
0
0
Level adjustment of the auto iris target value  
IRIS APL RATIO  
(–99 to +99)  
Mix ratio of auto iris detection peak value and  
average value  
IRIS VAR WIDTH  
IRIS VAR HEIGHT  
IRIS VAR H POS.  
20 to 465  
245  
Width and height of detection frame when the  
auto iris detection window is set to VAR  
20 to 172  
85/72  
Height of detection frame when the auto iris  
detection window is set to VAR  
–447 to +446  
(PDW-510/530)  
0
0
0
0
Horizontal position of detection frame when  
the auto iris detection window is set to VAR  
–447 to +446  
(PDW-510P/530P)  
IRIS VAR V POS.  
–104 to +104  
(PDW-510/530)  
Vertical position of detection frame when the  
auto iris detection window is set to VAR  
–124 to +123  
(PDW-510P/530P)  
IRIS SPEED  
(–99 to +99)  
OFF/ON  
0
Auto iris speed adjustment  
CLIP HIGH LIGHT  
OFF  
Turns on and off the function which, during  
auto iris adjustment, ignores very bright areas  
by dulling the reaction to high luminescence.  
14  
FUNCTION 3  
WHT FILTER INH  
COLOR BAR SEL  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
Turns on and off the function which inhibits  
independent white memory for each filter  
position.  
SMPTE/EBU/SNG SMPTE  
Color bar type  
(PDW-  
510/530)  
EBU  
(PDW-  
510P/  
530P)  
REC TALLY  
UPPER/BOTH  
UPPER  
Selects whether to light the upper tally  
indicator only, or both upper and lower tally  
indicators.  
COLOR VF INPUT COMP/VBS/BOTH COMP  
Video input selection when a color viewfinder  
is used  
USER & ALL ONLY OFF/ON  
OFF  
OFF  
Show only USER menu in the top menu.  
RM COMMON  
MEMORY  
OFF/ON  
Selects whether or not to share settings for  
when an RM remote control unit is connected  
and when the unit is used alone.  
RM REC START/  
STOP  
RM/CAM/PARA  
RM  
When an RM remote control unit is  
connected, selects which REC START/STOP  
buttons are enabled. RM/camera/both.  
15  
GENLOCK  
GENLOCK  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
ON  
OFF  
0
Turns genlock on and off.  
Turns return video on and off.  
Genlock H phase setting.  
RETURN VIDEO  
GL H PHASE  
(–60 to +139)  
(PDW-510/530)  
(–59 to +142)  
0
(PDW-510P/530P)  
GL SC PHASE  
(–99 to +99)  
0/180  
0
Genlock subcarrier phase setting  
Genlock subcarrier phase setting  
GL SC 0/180 SEL  
180  
192  
Menu List  
     
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
Description  
16  
ND COMP  
ND OFFSET  
ADJUST  
OFF/ON  
Turns on and off the mode which sets ND  
(neutral density) filter color compensation  
values.  
CLEAR ND  
OFFSET  
EXEC  
EXEC  
Clears ND filter color compensation values.  
Execute the auto black shooting function.  
Clears black shooting compensation values.  
17  
AUTO SHADING AUTO BLK  
SHADING  
EXEC  
RESET BLK SHD  
EXEC  
EXEC  
ENC  
TEST OUT SELECT ENC/R/G/B  
Selects the signal output to the TEST OUT  
connector.  
MASTER GAIN  
(TMP)  
–3/0/3/6/9/12/18/  
24/30/36/42/48 dB  
0 dB  
Temporarily sets the master gain value.  
18  
20  
DISC  
DELETE LAST CLIP EXEC  
DELETE ALL CLIPS EXEC  
EXEC  
EXEC  
EXEC  
Delete the last clip.  
Delete all clips on the disc.  
QUICK FORMAT  
EXEC  
Formats the disc. All the recorded data is  
deleted.  
NETWORK  
DHCP  
ENABL/DSABL  
DSABL  
Selects whether to enable automatic  
acquisition of the IP address from a DHCP  
server.  
IP ADDRESS  
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx  
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx  
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx  
192.168.1 Sets the IP address.  
.10  
SUBNET MASK  
255.255.2 Sets the subnet mask.  
55.0  
DEF. GATEWAY  
LINK SPEED  
0.0.0.0  
AUTO  
Sets the default gateway.  
AUTO/10 Mbps/  
100 Mbps  
Sets the communications speed.  
DUPLEX  
AUTO/FULL/HALF AUTO  
Sets the duplex mode.  
Menu List  
193  
     
FILE Menu List  
The following table lists and describes the items in the  
FILE menu.  
value. The setting range shown on the menu screen may  
differ from what is shown in the manual.  
When the setting range in the Settings column is  
surrounded by parentheses ( ), the setup value is a relative  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
EXEC  
EXEC  
Description  
01  
USER FILE  
USER FILE LOAD  
USER FILE SAVE  
F. ID  
16 characters  
USER PRESET  
EXEC  
02  
USER FILE2 STORE USR PRESET  
CLEAR USR PRESET  
EXEC  
EXEC  
EXEC  
OFF  
Sets the pages registered in the USER menu  
to the standard setting.  
Clears the standard setting of pages registered  
in the USER menu.  
CUSTOMIZE RESET  
Returns the pages registered in the USER  
menu to the factory default state.  
LOAD CUSTOM DATA OFF/ON  
Selects whether to include pages registered by  
the user in user files to be loaded by USER  
FILE LOAD.  
LOAD OUT OF USER  
BEFORE FILE PAGE  
USER LOAD WHITE  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
Selects whether to include pages not  
registered by the user in user files loaded by  
USER FILE LOAD.  
Selects whether to include data after USER  
FILE pages in user files to be loaded by USER  
FILE LOAD.  
Selects whether to include white balance data  
in user files to be loaded by USER FILE LOAD.  
03  
ALL FILE  
ALL FILE LOAD  
ALL FILE SAVE  
F. ID  
EXEC  
EXEC  
Load ALL file.  
Save ALL file.  
16 characters  
Name ALL file.  
ALL PRESET  
EXEC  
EXEC  
EXEC  
OFF  
Return items in ALL file to preset values.  
Set preset values of items in ALL file.  
Clear preset values of items in ALL file.  
STORE ALL PRESET  
CLEAR ALL PRESET  
3SEC CLR PRESET  
OFF/ON  
Turns on and off the function which returns  
menu items to the preset values when the  
MENU knob is kept pressed for 3 seconds.  
NETWORK DATA  
OFF/ON  
OFF  
Selects whether or not to read in the network-  
related data.  
04  
SCENE FILE  
1
2
3
4
5
STANDARD  
SCENE RECALL  
SCENE STORE  
F. ID  
EXEC  
EXEC  
16 characters  
194  
Menu List  
           
No.  
Page  
Item  
Settings  
Default  
EXEC  
EXEC  
EXEC  
EXEC  
Description  
05  
REFERENCE REFERENCE STORE  
REFERENCE CLEAR  
REFERENCE LOAD  
REFERENCE SAVE  
F. ID  
Save reference file in internal memory.  
Clear reference file.  
Load reference file.  
Save reference file to “Memory Stick”.  
Name reference file.  
16 characters  
OFF/ON  
SCENE WHITE DATA  
OFF  
06  
07  
LENS FILE 1 LENS FILE RECALL  
EXEC  
EXEC  
Load lens file.  
Save lens file.  
Name lens file.  
Clear lens file.  
LENS FILE STORE  
F. ID  
16 characters  
LENS NO OFFSET  
SOURCE  
MEMORY1 Number of selected lens file  
IRIS GAIN  
1)  
0
Iris gain value of lens file  
Lens file V Saw seed  
LENS FILE 2  
(–99 to +99)  
LENS M VMOD  
1)  
1)  
–466 to +465  
0
Horizontal position compensation of lens file  
center marker  
LENS CENTER H  
–121 to +120  
0
Vertical position compensation of lens file  
center marker  
LENS CENTER V  
TEST OUT SELECT  
ENC/R/G/B  
(–99 to +99)  
ENC  
0
Selects signal output to TEST OUT connector.  
Adjustment of lens file flare (R)  
1)  
LENS R FLARE  
1)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
0
0
0
Adjustment of lens file flare (G)  
Adjustment of lens file flare (B)  
LENS G FLARE  
1)  
LENS B FLARE  
1)  
R compensation value when extender and  
shrinker used.  
LENS W-R OFST  
1)  
(–99 to +99)  
R/G/B/TEST  
0
B compensation value when extender and  
shrinker used.  
LENS W-B OFST  
08  
LENS FILE 3 SHADING CH SEL  
R
Selects the channel adjusted by this menu. If  
TEST is selected, the setting is the same as  
the setting of TEST OUT SELECT.  
TEST OUT SELECT  
LENS R/G/B H SAW  
ENC/R/G/B  
ENC  
Selects the signal output to the TEST OUT  
connector.  
1)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
(–99 to +99)  
0
0
0
0
H Saw white shading compensation  
H Parabola white shading compensation  
V Saw white shading compensation  
V Parabola white shading compensation  
Format “Memory Stick”.  
1)  
LENS R/G/B H PARA  
1)  
LENS R/G/B V SAW  
1)  
LENS R/G/B V PARA  
FORMAT  
09  
MEMORY  
STICK  
MS IN > JUMP TO  
OFF/USER/  
ALL/SCENE/  
LENS/REFER/  
USER1  
1) “EX” is displayed when the extender is on, and “0.8” is displayed when  
the shrinker is on.  
Menu List  
195  
           
DIAGNOSIS Menu List  
The following table lists and describes the items in the  
DIAGNOSIS menu.  
No.  
Page  
Item  
Description  
01  
HOURS METER  
OPERATION  
Displays the total time that this unit has been powered on,  
in units of hours.  
OPERATION (rst)  
SPINDLE (rst)  
LASER (rst)  
Displays the total time that this unit has been powered on,  
in units of hours (reset possible).  
Displays the total time that the spindle has been rotating,  
in units of hours (reset possible).  
Displays the total number of output parameters to the  
optical heads (reset possible).  
LOADING (rst)  
SEEK (rst)  
Displays the number of times that discs have been loaded  
(reset possible).  
Displays the total seek time by the optical heads, in units of  
hours (reset possible).  
02  
TIME/DATE  
ADJUST  
HOUR  
MIN  
SEC  
YEAR  
MONTH  
DAY  
03  
04  
ROM VERSION 1  
ROM VERSION 2  
AT  
Displays ROM version.  
PACKAGE  
SY1: Ver X.XX  
PIER: Ver X.XX  
VAIN: Ver X.XX  
SYS2K: Ver X.XX  
SYS2U: Ver X.XX  
DRIVE: Ver X.XX  
FP: Ver X.XX  
DSP.A: Ver X.XX  
PRX.A: Ver X.XX  
PRX.V: Ver X.XX  
05  
DEV STATUS  
I/O  
EEPROM  
CN:  
LSI  
PX:  
Display only.  
IFA :  
FP :  
CN :  
FRAM  
AT:  
DCP:  
PA:  
BCS:  
SCI  
SS:  
RM:  
196  
Menu List  
             
No.  
Page  
Item  
Description  
07  
DISC STATUS  
USER ID:  
TITLE:  
Displays the user ID of the disc itself.  
Displays the title of the disc itself.  
REMAIN  
Displays the remaining capacity of the disc.  
Displays the number of times the disc has been rewritten.  
Displays “required” when salvage is required.  
REWRITE  
SALVAGE  
FILE SYSTEM: UDF2.5  
Displays “unknown” when the file system cannot be  
identified, or when there is an error.  
08  
CLIP STATUS  
CLIP LIST MODE  
CURRENT ID  
NORMAL MODE or CLIP LIST MODE  
NORMAL MODE: Number of current clip, total number of  
clips  
CLIP LIST MODE: Clip list number  
TITLE  
NORMAL MODE: Title of current clip  
CLIP LIST MODE: Title of clip list  
RECORD DEVIDE  
NORMAL MODE: Name of device which recorded current  
clip  
CLIP LIST MODE: Displays “-----”.  
SERIAL  
NORMAL MODE: Serial number of device which recorded  
current clip  
CLIP LIST MODE: Displays “-----”.  
DATE  
TIME  
NORMAL MODE: Date when current clip was recorded  
CLIP LIST MODE: Date when clip list was created  
NORMAL MODE: Time when current clip was recorded  
CLIP LIST MODE: Time when clip list was created  
09  
OPTION BOARD  
SDI OUTPUT  
Displays installed options.  
COMPOSITE VIDEO INPUT  
PULL DOWN (24P)  
Menu List  
197  
Before using a “Memory Stick”  
About a “Memory Stick”  
Terminal  
What is “Memory Stick”?  
Write-protect tab  
“Memory Stick” is a new compact, portable and versatile  
IC (Integrated Circuit) recording medium with a data  
capacity that exceeds a floppy disk. “Memory Stick” is  
specially designed for exchanging and sharing digital data  
among “Memory Stick” compatible products. Because it is  
removable, “Memory Stick” can also be used for external  
data storage.  
“Memory Stick” is available in two sizes: standard size  
and compact “Memory Stick Duo” size. Once attached to  
a “Memory Stick Duo” adapter, “Memory Stick Duo”  
turns to the same size as standard “Memory Stick” and thus  
can be used with products compliant with standard  
“Memory Stick”.”  
Labelling position  
• When you set the “Memory Stick” erasure prevention  
switch to “LOCK,” data cannot be recorded, edited, or  
erased.  
• Data may be damaged if:  
-You remove the “Memory Stick” or turn off the unit  
while it is reading or writing data.  
-You use the “Memory Stick” in a location subject to the  
effects of static electricity or electric noise.  
• We recommend that you make a backup copy of  
important data that you record on the “Memory Stick”.  
Types of “Memory Stick”  
“Memory Stick” is available in the following four types to  
meet various requirements in functions.  
Notes  
“Memory Stick-R”  
• Do not attach anything other than the supplied label to  
the “Memory Stick” labeling position.  
• Attach the label so that it does not stick out beyond the  
labeling position.  
• Carry and store the “Memory Stick” in its case.  
• Do not touch the connector of the “Memory Stick” with  
anything, including your finger or metallic objects.  
• Do not strike, bend, or drop the “Memory Stick”.  
• Do not disassemble or modify the “Memory Stick”.  
• Do not allow the “Memory Stick” to get wet.  
• Do not use or store the “Memory Stick” in a location that  
is:  
Stored data are not overwritten. You can write data to  
“Memory Stick-R” with “Memory Stick-R” compatible  
products only. Copyright protected data that requires  
MagicGate copyright protection technology cannot be  
written to “Memory Stick-R.”  
“Memory Stick”  
Stores any type of data except copyright-protected data  
that requires the MagicGate copyright protection  
technology.  
“MagicGate Memory Stick”  
Equipped with the MagicGate copyright protection  
technology.  
- Extremely hot, such as in a car parked in the sun  
- Under direct sunlight  
- Very humid or subject to corrosive substances  
“Memory Stick-ROM”  
Stores pre-recorded, read-only data. You cannot record on  
“Memory Stick-ROM” or erase the pre-recorded data.  
“Memory Stick” Access Indicator  
If the access indicator is turned on or is flashing, data is  
being read from or written to the “Memory Stick”. At this  
time, do not shake the computer or product or subject them  
to shock. Do not turn off the power of the computer and  
product or remove the “Memory Stick”. This may damage  
the data.  
Available types of “Memory Stick”  
You can use a “Memory Stick” with your product.  
Note  
You can not use a “Memory Stick Duo” with your product.  
Note on data read/write speed  
Data read/write speed may vary depending on the  
combination of the “Memory Stick” and “Memory Stick”  
compliant product you use.  
What is MagicGate ?  
MagicGate is copyright protection technology that uses  
encryption technology.  
198  
About a “Memory Stick”  
     
Precautions  
• To prevent data loss, make backups of data frequently. In  
no event will Sony be liable for any loss of data.  
• Unauthorized recording may be contrary to the  
provisions of copyright law. When you use a “Memory  
Stick” that has been pre-recorded, be sure that the  
material has been recorded in accordance with copyright  
and other applicable laws.  
• The “Memory Stick” application software may be  
modified or changed by Sony without prior notice.  
• Note that there are certain restrictions on recording stage  
performances and other entertainment events, even if  
they are recorded for personal use only.  
• “Memory Stick”,  
and “MagicGate Memory Stick”  
are trademarks of Sony Corporation.  
• “Memory Stick Duo” and  
trademarks of Sony Corporation.  
• “Memory Stick PRO” and  
trademarks of Sony Corporation.  
• “MagicGate” and  
are  
are  
are trademarks  
of Sony Corporation.  
About a “Memory Stick”  
199  
the scene selection function of this  
unit, and with the supplied PDZ-1  
Proxy Browsing Software.  
time code value and actual time by  
dropping two frames from the time  
code value at the beginning of each  
minute except every tenth minute.  
Glossary  
Color bar signal  
AES/EBU  
A test signal which can be displayed  
as vertical bars of different colors on  
a color video monitor. This signal is  
used to check chrominance functions  
of color television and video systems  
such as cameras and monitors.  
E-E mode  
A standard established jointly by the  
AES (Audio Engineering Society)  
and EBU (European Broadcasting  
Union) for serial transmission of  
digital audio. Two channels of audio  
can be transmitted via a single  
connector.  
Electric-to-Electric mode. When you  
operate a VDR in E-E mode, input  
video and/or audio signals pass  
through electric circuits only and  
then come out from the output  
connectors, without passing through  
electromagnetic conversion circuits  
such as recording heads.  
Color subcarrier  
In a composite video signal, a signal  
superimposed upon the picture  
(luminance) information for the  
purpose of conveying the associated  
color information. Color and  
saturation information is conveyed  
by the phase and amplitude of the  
color subcarrier. Also called  
subcarrier.  
Aliasing  
Distortion which occurs during  
sampling to convert analog signals to  
digital.  
EFP  
Electronic Field Production. The use  
of electronic equipment such as  
portable video cameras, VTRs, and  
sound equipment for television  
production outside studios.  
ATW  
Auto Tracing White balance. The  
white balance is automatically  
adjusted for the lighting conditions  
during shooting.  
ENG  
Color temperature  
Electronic News Gathering. The use  
of electronic equipment such as  
portable video cameras, VTRs, and  
sound equipment for the production  
of daily news stories and short  
documentaries.  
The temperature in Kelvins (K) to  
represent the color of a light source,  
determined by heating a perfectly  
black body until its color matches  
that of the light source. Color  
temperature is higher when the color  
is bluish and lower when reddish.  
Bayonet mount  
A type of lens mount. The lens can be  
inserted into the lens mount and  
quickly locked in place by simply  
rotating the lens locking ring.  
Essence mark  
A type of metadata that may be set for  
a specified frame.  
Black balance adjustment  
To balance the black levels of the R,  
G, and B channels of a video camera  
so that black has no color.  
Composite video signal  
A video signal in which luminance  
and chrominance are combined along  
with timing reference “sync”  
information to make composite  
video.  
Flare  
Dark or colored flashes caused by  
signal overload through extreme light  
reflections of polished objects or very  
bright lights.  
Black set  
A reference level for black balance  
adjustment.  
CRT  
CCD  
Flange focal length  
Cathode-Ray Tube. Video camera  
viewfinders are equipped with a CRT  
image display, so you can monitor  
what you are shooting.  
Charge-Coupled Device. A solid  
state imager used in most video  
cameras in place of a pickup tube.  
The device converts input light levels  
into electrical charges that are first  
stored and then output in the form of  
voltage variations.  
The distance from the plane of lens  
mounting flange to the image focal  
plane. Abbreviated to Ff.  
Flicker  
DCC  
Repeated change of brightness on the  
screen, caused by light sources such  
as fluorescent light flashing at the  
frequency of alternating current.  
Dynamic Contrast Control. A DCC  
circuit automatically adjusts the knee  
point according to the amount of  
incident light. A video camera  
containing a DCC circuit can handle  
a wide dynamic range of luminance.  
Center marker  
A cross which indicates the center of  
the image on the viewfinder screen.  
Genlock  
Generator lock. To synchronize the  
pulse generator built into video  
equipment to an external reference  
(master) sync signal.  
Clip  
Drop frame mode  
A recording unit. Clips are created  
every time recording starts and stops.  
SMPTE time code runs at 30 frames/  
second, while the NTSC color  
television system runs at about 29.97  
frames/second. Drop frame mode  
adjusts the running of time code to  
eliminate the discrepancy between  
Clip list  
HAD  
A list of locations in the material  
recorded on the disc, arranged in any  
order. Clips lists can be created with  
Hole-Accumulated Diode. A CCD  
sensor structure designed to suppress  
200  
Glossary  
 
certain types of noise inherent to  
CCDs. See also CCD.  
XDCAM can record non-audio as an  
input signal.  
Shutter speed  
The time that the shutter is open.  
Slow shutter speeds give bright  
images, but motion resolution is  
lower.  
Hunting  
1) Dolby is a trademark of Dolby Laboratories.  
Repeated brightening and darkening  
of an image resulting from repeated  
response to automatic iris control.  
Non-drop frame mode  
A mode of advancing time code  
which ignores the difference in frame  
values between real time and the time  
code. Using this mode produces a  
difference of approximately 86  
seconds per day between real time  
and time code, which causes  
problems when editing programs in  
units of seconds using the number of  
frames as a reference.  
SMPTE  
Society of Motion Picture and  
Television Engineers, a professional  
association established in the U.S.A.  
mainly for the purpose of setting  
forth motion picture and television  
engineering standards.  
i.LINK  
Another name for the IEEE1394-  
1995 standards and their revisions.  
XDCAM uses the i.LINK interface to  
transfer DV streams by the AV/C  
protocol, and to read and write  
MPEG IMX and DVCAM data files  
by FAM (File Access Mode).  
S/N  
Signal-to-Noise ratio. The relation of  
the strength of the desired signal to  
the accompanying electronic  
interference, the noise. If S/N is high,  
sounds are reproduced with less noise  
and pictures are reproduced clearly  
without snow.  
Interlaced scan mode (CCD  
output)  
A scanning method in which odd  
rows fields are read alternately with  
even rows. (Odd-row fields and even-  
row fields contain images from  
different times.)  
Progressive scan mode (CCD  
output)  
A scanning method in which odd  
rows and even rows are read at the  
same time. Also called full-screen  
scanning.  
SNMP  
Proxy AV data  
Simple Network Management  
Protocol. XDCAM uses this protocol  
to monitor equipment operating  
status via network connectors.  
IRE scale  
Low-resolution data with a video  
bandwidth of 1.5 Mbps and an audio  
bandwidth of 64 Kbps per channel.  
This unit records proxy AV data  
automatically whenever high-  
resolution MPEG IMX or DVCAM  
data is recorded.  
International Radio Engineers scale.  
A scale of values that defines the  
brightness level of a video signal.  
The IRE is now the IEEE (Institute of  
Electrical and Electronic Engineers).  
Sub clip  
One of the sections which make up a  
clip list. A sub clip may be part of a  
clip or an entire clip.  
Metadata  
Information about the properties of  
video and audio content. XDCAM  
records metadata such as UMIDs and  
essence marks, and the supplied  
PDZ-1 Proxy Browsing Software  
PDZ-1 can be used to record  
information such as titles and  
comments.  
Reference video signal  
Thumbnail image  
A video signal that contains a sync  
signal or sync and burst signals, used  
as a reference for synchronization of  
video equipment.  
A reduced still picture of video for  
display on a GUI screen. XDCAM  
creates thumbnail images from proxy  
video, and displays them as index  
pictures on GUI screens.  
Return video  
A video signal returned to a camera  
from a VTR, or a video signal  
selected from among several camera  
angles in a control room and returned  
to a camera so the cameraman can  
check the video.  
Time code  
MXF  
A digitally encoded signal which is  
recorded with video data to identify  
each frame of the video by hour,  
minute, second and frame number.  
SMPTE time code is applied to  
NTSC system, and EBU time code to  
PAL and SECAM systems.  
Material eXchange Format. A file  
exchange format developed by the  
Pro-MPEG Forum. Equipment from  
different manufacturers can  
exchange files in this format.  
SDI  
Serial Digital Interface. An interface  
standardized as SMPTE 259M which  
enables the transmission of an  
uncompressed digital component  
stream.  
ND filter  
Neutral Density filter. ND filters  
reduce the amount of incident light  
equally across the entire visible  
wavelength range without affecting  
color.  
Time code synchronization  
To synchronize the built-in time code  
generator of video equipment to an  
external time code.  
Shot data  
Turbo gain  
Data recorded, while shooting, in the  
color bars, the user bits data of VITC,  
and so forth. Includes the model  
name, serial number, date, time, shot  
number, and ID1 to ID4.  
Non-audio  
Video amplifier gain increased from  
30 dB by 6 to 18 dB by combining  
adjacent pixels of the CCD.  
General term for audio signals other  
than linear PCM, such as Dolby E  
1)  
and Dolby Digital (AC-3).  
Glossary  
201  
UMID  
of the camera lens. This is called  
white shading.  
Unique Material Identifier. A  
standard (SMPTE 330M) for video  
and audio metadata. The Basic  
section of a UMID contains a  
globally unique number and a  
material number for the identification  
of recorded material. An optional  
section called the “Source Pack”  
contains information such as the time  
and location of recording. A UMID  
with the Basic section only is called a  
Basic UMID. A UMID with the  
Source Pack is called an Extended  
UMID.  
Zebra pattern  
In a video camera, striped patterns  
which appear in the viewfinder  
screen to indicate areas of the image  
where the video level is higher than a  
certain value. If a zebra pattern  
appears on the skin when the object is  
a human being, that is a correct  
exposure.  
Zoom  
To gradually change the field of view  
of a camera lens from wide to narrow  
angle (zoom in) or narrow to wide  
angle (zoom out).  
User bits  
A total of 32 bits are provided in the  
time code which the user can use to  
record such information as date,  
scene number, or reel number on  
video tape. Also called user’s bits.  
VBS  
A composite signal consisting of  
video signal, burst signal and sync  
signal.  
Vertical smear  
A bright vertical line which appears  
on the screen when shooting a very  
bright object with a CCD camera.  
Also called smear.  
Video gain  
Amount of amplification for video  
signals, expressed in decibels (dB).  
VITC  
Vertical Interval Time Code. A time  
code recorded in two horizontal lines  
during each vertical blanking period  
of a video signal.  
White balance adjustment  
In the light of a particular color  
temperature, to adjust the white  
levels of the R, G, and B channels of  
a color video camera so that any  
white object shot in that light is  
reproduced as a truly white image.  
See also Color temperature.  
White shading  
When shooting a white object, the  
upper and lower portions of the  
screen may appear magenta or green  
while the central portion appears  
white, depending on the performance  
202  
Glossary  
Index  
B
A
Basic procedures  
Access indicator(forMemoryStick”)  
33  
Adjusting  
D
Battery status  
BKW-401 Viewfinder Rotation  
Disc  
Adjustments and settings  
Assigning functions to ASSIGN 1/2/3/  
4 switches 125  
Black balance  
used for recording and playback  
attaching a UHF portable tuner  
155  
Disc status  
display on the monochrome LCD  
C
connecting line input audio  
equipment 157  
using the supplied microphone  
153  
Checking  
E
adjustment for input from the front  
microphone 87  
the last two seconds of the  
recording 60  
the recording on the color video  
monitor 60  
adjustment for inputs from the  
connectors 86  
F
AUDIO SELECT CH-1/CH-2  
switches 23  
File ID  
Index  
203  
 
Loading  
user files from a “Memory Stick”  
136  
Locations and functions of parts and  
controls 19  
N
O
M
Optical disc drive section,  
specifications 172  
“Memory Stick”  
G
Optional board  
jumping to a file-related menu  
H
P
assigning functions to ASSIGN 1/  
resetting USER menu settings  
I
i.LINK DV IN/OUT S400 connector  
28  
PLAY/PAUSE button and indicator  
29  
setting the color temperature  
manually 124  
specifying an offset for the auto  
124  
K
using the Anton Bauer Ultralight  
system 148  
L
Proxy Browsing Software (See also  
“PDZ-1”) 74  
UHF potrable tuner for wireless  
system 155  
using the supplied microphone  
153  
Q
204  
Index  
Time code  
R
Shooting  
basic procedure (from adjusting  
the black balance and  
white balance to stopping  
recording) 46  
basic procedure (from turning on  
a disc) 46  
Recommended additional equipment  
173  
video signals from external  
equipment 63  
Time code display  
testing the camcorder before  
shooting 163  
Recording format  
Shooting and recording/playback  
functions 24  
Shoulder pad, adjusting the position  
159  
Statusdisplayontheviewfinderscreen  
112  
setting the audio recording format  
76  
setting the video recording format  
75  
Resetting USER menu settings to the  
standard settings 135  
U
USER menu  
V
Video camera section, specifications  
171  
S
Saving and loading  
user files to and from a “Memory  
Stick” 136  
Scene file  
resetting the settings to the  
standard settings 144  
Selecting  
adjusting the focus and screen  
149  
T
Testing  
moving the viewfinder shoe up  
150  
Setting  
using the BKW-401 Viewfinder  
Rotation Bracket 150  
Viewfinderfront-rearpositioninglever  
25  
date/time of the internal clock  
127  
Viewfinder screen  
Index  
205  
The material contained in this manual consists of information  
that is the property of Sony Corporation and is intended solely  
for use by the purchasers of the equipment described in this  
manual.  
Sony Corporation expressly prohibits the duplication of any  
portion of this manual or the use thereof for any purpose other  
than the operation or maintenance of the equipment described  
in this manual without the express written permission of Sony  
Corporation.  
Sony Corporation  
PDW-510/510P/530/530P  
(SYL)  
B& PCompany  
3-805-941-02 (1)  
http://www.sony.net/  
© 2004  

Whistler BT2200 User Manual
Whirlpool Cable Box ET4WSKXKZ02 User Manual
Sony Handycam DCR TRV210E User Manual
Sony Cyber shot DSC HX30 User Manual
Sony CDX GT41UW User Manual
Sony Camcorder CCD TR33 User Manual
Sony Blu ray Player BDP S190 User Manual
Seagate CompactFlash 2336 User Manual
Samsung SC D975 User Manual
Samsung D250(i) User Manual